Ge 101
Ge 101
Ge 101
GE-101
DEPARTMENT OF GEOGRAPHY
AND NATURAL RESOURCE MANAGEMENT
SCHOOL OF EARTH AND ENVIRONMENT SCIENCES
UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
(Teenpani Bypass, Behind Transport Nagar, Haldwani (Nainital), Uttarakhand, India)
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 Uttarakhand Open University
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101
FUNDAMENTALS OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
DEPARTMENT OF GEOGRAPHY
AND NATURAL RESOURCE MANAGEMENT
SCHOOL OF EARTH AND ENVIRONMENT SCIENCE
UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101
FUNDAMENTALS OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 Uttarakhand Open University
Board of Studies
Chairman Convener
Vice Chancellor Professor P.D. Pant
Uttarakhand Open University, Haldwani School of Earth and Environment Science
Uttarakhand Open University, Haldwani
Course Coordinator
Editorial Board
CONTENTS
BLOCK-2 ATMOSPHERE
UNIT: 5 Composition and Structure of Atmosphere 111-121
UNIT: 6 Insolation & Heat Budget, Vertical & Horizontal Distribution of
Temperature 122-137
UNIT: 7 Atmospheric Pressure, Winds, Humidity& Rainfall 138-152
UNIT: 8 Climate& Its Classification- Koppen & Thornthweit 153-168
BLOCK-3 HYDROSPHERE
UNIT: 9 Surface Configuration of Ocean Bottoms 169-182
UNIT:10 Oceanic-Temperature & Salinity 183-197
UNIT:11 Circulation of Ocean Water, Currents & Tides 198-220
UNIT:12Ocean Deposits & Corals Reefs 221-224
BLOCK-4 BIOSPHERE
UNIT:13 Elements of Biosphere, Habitat & Plant- Animal Association 225-242
UNIT:14 Ecology & Ecosystem 243-261
UNIT:15 Bio-Diversity & Its Depletion 262-295
UNIT:16 Conservation of Biotic Resources 296-313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
1.1 OBJECTIVES
1.2 INTRODUCTION
1.3 MEANING AND DEFINITION OF PHYSICAL
GEOGRAPHY
1.4 NATURE AND SCOPE OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
1.4.1 NATURE OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
1.4.2 SCOPE OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
1.5 RECENT TRENDS IN PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY
1.6 CONCLUSION
1.7 SUMMARY
1.8 GLOSSARY
1.9 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
1.10 REFERENCES
1.11 SUGGESTED READINGS
1.12 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
1.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, will help the students in clearing their concepts as regards the
following:
Understanding the definition of Geography.
Comprehending the development and growth of the subject.
Learning the scope of Geography as a scientific discipline.
Gaining knowledge of recent trends in physical geography.
Discussing the relevance of physical geography.
1.2 INTRODUCTION
The major aim of this chapter is to introduce the students to a new perspective of the world of
physical geography. Geography is amongst the oldest earth science and much of the
geographical work is actually the contribution made by different Greek scholars. The word
geography was coined by Eratosthenes, a famous Greek scholar in third century B.C.
Geography is actually a combination of two words ‘Geo’ means earth and ‘Graphy’ means to
describe, hence if we look at the literal meaning of term geography then it stands for
description of the earth surface. Geography as a discipline concentrates largely on interaction
of all human and physical phenomena and the resultant features. Geography is mainly
divided into two major branches, Physical and Human geography (Figure1).
PHYSICAL
GEOGRAPHY
Out of the two major branches of geography, Physical Geography is the most
important branch of geography as it forms the basis of all geographical studies.
Greeks contributed to physical geography through their works on change of climates, winds,
rainfall, mountains, delta buildings, earthquake, floods along with their causes, volcanoes and
transformation of topographic features. Aristotle discussed phenomena of expansion of land
in the shallow seas and the formation of the delta. Herodotus talked about tides in the red sea.
The Greeks said that the world can basically be divided into three temperature zones called
torrid, temperate and frigid zone.
Strabo was the most outstanding out of all Roman scholars and focused on the fact, earth is
spherical and divided it into different zones and the circles upon the sphere i.e equator, the
zodiac, the tropics and the arctic circle. He discussed the changes that have occurred over the
face of the earth owing to transgression and regression of the sea as well as due to
earthquakes and volcanoes.
Indian scholars focused on accurate knowledge of the topography of an area along with its,
flora and fauna, natural resources etc of India and adjoining countries. A great deal of
geographical information is available in Vedas and Puranas. With fall of the Roman Empire
cam the Dark Age were practically no scientific development had taken place. During the
medieval period Arabs did made some contribution especially in field of mathematical
geography. In present time, American and European Scholars are making a good contribution
to the modern physical geography.
Over the years especially by 1950s man realized that, natural resources are highly limited and
are being used haphazardly which is ultimately leading to an extinction of many important
life forms on this earth. This can lead to an emergence of a great devastating situation
including pollution and depletion of essential resources. Such situations have led to a great
resurgence in studies in physical geography by researchers worldwide.
By the end of twenty-first century, physical geography developed as a more balanced,
integrated and comprehensive discipline. Thus, we can say from the above discussion that,
geography has really evolved through various stages of development as regards to the
content, methodology and approach to study.
In the beginning physical geography has been usually defined as the study of only the
physical environment (namely reliefs, air and water) of the earth e.g. ‘The study of physical
environment by itself is Physical Geography, which includes consideration of surface relief
of the globe (Geomorphology), of the seas and oceans (Oceanography) and of air
(Meteorology and Climatology)’ (Arthur Holmes).
Physical geography is interdisciplinary in nature and is a mixture of different branches of
earth and natural sciences (Figure 2). It has been realized that, physical geography is very
vast. Arthus Holmes has further elaborated in 1960 that ‘physical geography is simply the
study of unification of a number of earth sciences which give us a general insight into the
nature of man’s environment. Not in itself a distinct branch of science physical geography is
a body of basic principles of earth sciences selected with a view to include primarily the
environmental influences that vary from place to place over the earth surface’.
Remote Sensing
Biogeography Economic
Geography
HUMAN PHYSICAL
Marine Cultural
Geography Geography
Geomorphology Historical
Geography
It studies the patterns and interactions between human activities and physical
environment analyze the spatial pattern and relationships of environmental components of
the globe in a regional context and studies the causes of regional patterns of such
relationships. It takes into view both the spatial and temporal aspects of environmental
components and their causes.
The main concern of physical geography is biosphere which the layer of the life
around the globe which supports the life of all biota (plants and animals) on the earth surface.
The quality of biosphere is determined by the immediate physical environment which
consequently is dependent on interactions between the endogentic and exogentic forces.
Endogenetic forces are the forces coming from within the earth and exogenetic forces are
originating from the atmosphere i.e denudational processes which include the processes of
erosion and weathering).
The earth crust is a habitat to a variety of living organisms in the biospheric
ecosystem. Different reliefs like mountains, hills plains etc are created on the earth surface by
endogenetic forces which introduce diversity in the habitats.
The exogenetic forces originates from the atmosphere in form of carbon, hydrogen,
oxygen and nitrogen etc giving rise to different kind of climate’s on earth surface. These
forces also help in circulation and exchange of heat between the atmosphere and earth
surface and on formation of different landforms by various denudational works on one hand
and diversity in the habitats formed by endogenetic forces on the other. Thus, physical
environment affects the life forms (plants and animals) of the biosphere while man produces
a change in the physical environmental conditions through economic activities.
Physical geography has evolved during four periods i.e. ancient, medieval, modern and
recent.
In recent times, it has emerged as a more balanced and comprehensive field of study.
INTEXT QUESTION 1.3
1. Which are the two distinct traditions or methodologies followed by the Greeks?
2. Which are the two major forces in Geomorphological studies?
GEOLOGY
PHYSICS
GEOPHYSICS
OCEANO-
GRAPHY
METEOR-
ZOOLOGY
OLOGY
And
BOTANY
CHEMISTRY
The major branches of physical geography can be classified in the following categories:
Relief features of the first order: under this category we have features like continents
which accounts for 29.2 percent and ocean basins which accounts for 70.8 percent of the
earth surface. These relief features are fairly stable but have shown signs of change in form if
there geological history is analyzed. There are evidences of large scale changes in their form,
extension and geographical location when we look at their long geological history. As much
as 70.8 percent of the earth’s surface is covered by water (seas and oceans) and the
continents account for only 29.2 percent of the earth’s surface.
Relief features of the second order: are called as structural landforms usually super-
imposed on continents and ocean basins like mountains, plateaus and plains on the
continents, and mid-oceanic ridges, oceanic plains and trenches on the ocean floor along with
major features on the continental margins. These relief features are the result of interaction of
endogenetic forces (forces working in the interior of the earth) and exogenetic forces (forces
acting on the surface of the earth). Relief features of the second order prepare the base for the
development of relief features of third order.
Relief features of the third order: Relief features of the third order are formed on the
relief features of the second order. These are an outcome of the actions of exogenetic forces
like work of running water (river), moving ice (glacier), and wind and sea waves. These
forces basically acts as an agents of erosion as well as deposition.On the other hand relief
features formed as a result of the erosional work of exogenetic forces are valleys, hanging
valleys, roche mountonnees, mushroom or gara, cliffs, bays, promonotaries etc.Relief
features formed by the depositional work of the exogenetic forces are alluvial cones and
alluvial fans, overflow lakes, natural levees and flood plains, deltas, morains, eskers, kames,
drumlins, sand dunes, barkhans, beaches etc. All these features hold an important place as
they give the description of the landforms formed on the surface of the earth.
B. Growth of structural Geomorphology: The subject has gained a lot of importance in the
recent years, the laws and agents of denudation are gaining importance. There has been a
greater trend towards the study of different landform structures created by activities like
vulcanicity and tectonic activity, crustal behavior and deformation are becoming highly
visible. Since the concepts of sea-floor spreading and plate tectonics have gained
popularity; physiography of ocean basins has developed as an important part of
geomorphological studies hence, a lot of research is being pursued in this field all across
the world.
1. Climatology: covers the study of Atmosphere (Climate and weather). Weather refers to
the sum total of the atmospheric conditions in terms of temperature, pressure, direction
and speed of winds, humidity, cloudiness, precipitation, visibility etc of a particular place
at a given time. It varies greatly over the entire face of the earth, and hence is a subject of
great geographical significance. The term ‘climate’ is closely related to weather because
the indicators of both weather and climate like temperature, rainfall, pressure, humidity,
wind etc are the same. However, climate differs from weather with respect to time and
space. Weather studies are part of a science called Metreology which
The Science of weather is called Meteorology which scientifically studies the atmosphere
and different kinds of atmospheric phenomena. The science of metreology can be classified
under following five categories:
Aerology: Deals with the study of the structure of the atmosphere.
Dynamic or theoretical Meteorology: studies the motions of the atmosphere by analyzing
the physical variables of pressure, density, temperature and velocity in order to protect the
future state of the atmosphere.
Physical Meteorology: covers all physical atmospheric phenomena and amongst which
electrical, optical and thermodynamic processes are highly important. It systematically
describes the working of different kind of forces in the atmosphere. As a part of natural
science, it analyzes concepts of physics, chemistry and dynamics of the entire atmosphere. It
also helps in predicting weather accurately along with an understanding of artificial control
of the atmospheric phenomena.
Synoptic Metreology: focuses on specific region with a highly analytical and comparative
approach. Synoptic charts are usually preferred for weather forecasting. It studies the
metrological conditions spread over a wide area and is based on the principle that, certain
atmospheric conditions results in a particular type of weather.
Aeronautical Meteorology: It is a category of natural-cum applied science which analyzes the
weather conditions suitable for aviation purposes. It has gained a lot of importance over the
years especially with the development of aviation industry.
2. Oceanography: deals with the water bodies such as oceans and seas. According to
H.A.Marmer, “Ocenaography, the science of the sea, embraces primarily the study of the
form and nature of the oceanic basins, the characteristics of the waters in these basins and
the movements to which these waters are subjected to.” oceanography has also always
been an integral part of the studies of physical geography.
Since these water bodies have become a matter of great economic and strategic
significance therefore, study of oceanography has gained a lot of importance in recent times
with special relevance to applied oceanography. Applied oceanography focuses on
delineation, exploitation, mapping utilization and management of marine resources. Marine
ecology and marine ecosystem have become the focal theme of oceanography.
‘Oceanography’ covers all the studies pertaining to seas and oceans. The vastness of the
scope of oceanography can be obtained from the studies of many past voyages as well as
recent studies in the field of Oceanography which describes the entire complexity of the
oceanic system. It is again interdisciplinary in nature and interacts with several other
disciplines for a thorough knowledge of oceans and seas. Both deductive and inductive
approaches are being followed in order to understand the vast domain oceanic environment.
Animal Geography : also popular as Zoogeography, deals with animals below the level of
acculturated man. Geographers usually studies zoogeogeography both in terms of region and
taxonomy.
Physical geography can be subdivided into four major branches i.e geomorphology,
climatology, oceanography and biogeography.
Over the years, the Davisian tradition has lost its importance.
Emergence of new fields like Applied geomorphology has further enhance the
status of this field.
1.6 CONCLUSION
Geography has been an important subject as it is very essential in person’s everyday
life. It not only deals with the study of earth but, where on this earth different activities are
located. Physical geography gains much importance here as it describes the distribution of
landforms, learning of environmental processes as all these helps in describing different
human activities and social, cultural, economic and demographic factors also produce
changes in our physical landscape and brings out new and altered landscapes by human
interference. Today, our world is full of different problems like food security, environmental
pollution, disasters and hazards and so on. All these problems can be tackled with a better
understanding of the physical landscape and solving such problems. This will ultimately help
in bringing sustainable development.
1.7 SUMMARY
It can be summarized that, geography is an old and important science and a lot of
contribution to this subject has been done by ancient scholars during different time periods. It
is divided into two major branches physical and human geography. Both these branches can
further be subdivided into a number of categories. Physical geography can be classified into
four major categories geomorphology, oceanography, climatology and biogeography.
Physical geography studies have vast scope and its development over the years has made it
more quantitative and applicable in modern world. Thus, thus there is continuous growth in
this subject especially in the field of applied physical geography. There has been an increase
in overall popularity of this subject because of its increase relevance in different fields.
1.8 GLOSSARY
Disasters: A sudden incident or a natural calamity which causes a great damage or loss to
life and property.
Food Security: The condition of having reliable access to a sufficient quantity of, nutritious
and reasonable food.
Energy: The strength and vivacity required for performing a sustained physical or mental
activity.
Environmental Conservation: It is the act of conserving or preserving the natural resources
through proper management. It calls for rational use of the resources wisely and responsibly.
Sustainable Development: Sustainable development means meeting the needs of the present
without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs.
Natural Hazards: Those elements of the physical environment which are harmful to man
and are caused by forces external to him.
Interdisciplinary: Involving an amalgamation of academic, scientific, or artistic areas
of knowledge.
Natural Resources: Natural Resources are naturally occurring substances that are
considered valuable for human beings in their unmodified forms.
Quantitative : Relates to measuring, the quantity of something rather than its quality.
Taxonomy : The branch of science concerned with systematic classification especially of
organisms.
Hydrodynamics : The branch of science concerned with forces acting on or exerted by fluids
(especially liquids).
Thermodynamics : The branch of physical science that deals with the relations between heat
and other forms of energy (such as mechanical, electrical, or chemical energy), and, by
extension, of the relationships between all forms of energy.
1.10 REFERENCES
Singh. S, “Nature, Scope and Development of Physical Geography” in Physical
Geography,
Gutierrez. M, Geomorphology, CRC Press, London, UK, 2013, 1-17.
Savindra. S, “Nature of Physical Geography” in Physical Geography, Prayag Pustak
Bhawan, Allahabad, 2012, 1-15.
“Introduction to physical geography” in Discovering Physical Geography, Wiley
Press, 2-11.
Tarr.R.S and Engeln.O.D, New Physical Geography, MacMillan Co, New York,
1926.
Holmes.A, Principles of Physical Geology, Thomas Nelson and Sons Limited, 1945.
2.1 OBJECTIVES
2.2 INTRODUCTION
2.3 THE EARTH: A MEMBER OF OUR SOLAR SYSTEM
2.4 EVOLUTIONARY THEORIES
2.4.1 GASEOUS HYPOTHESIS OF EMMANUEL KANT
2.4.2 NABULAR HYPOTHESIS OF LAPLACE
2.4.3 ELECTRO-MAGNETIC THEORY OF ALFVEN
2.5 CATACLYSMIC OR CATASTROPHIC THEORIES
2.5.1 TIDAL THEORIES OF JEANS AND JEFFREY
2.5.2 NOVA STAR HYPOTHESIS OF HOYLE AND
LYTTLETON
2.5.3 INTERSTELLAR DUST HYPOTHESIS OF OTTO
SCHIMIDT
2.5.4 BIG BANG THEORY
2.6 EVIDENCES OF THE EARTH’S INTERIOR
2.7 CHEMICAL COMPOSITION AND LAYERING SYSTEM
OF THE EARTH
2.8 THICKNESS OF THE LAYERS
2.9 MODERN VIEW
2.9.1 CRUST
2.9.2 MANTLE
2.9.3 CORE
2.10 CLASSIFICATION OF ROCKS
2.10.1 IGNEOUS ROCKS
2.10.2 SEDIMENTARY ROCKS
2.10.3 METAMORPHIC ROCKS
2.11 ISOSTASY: THE CONCEPTS
2.11.1 MODEL OF AIRY-HEISKANEN
2.11.2 MODEL OF PRATT-HAYFORD
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 21 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
2.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit you will be able to understand the following:
Our solar system.
Evolutionary theories.
Earth interior.
Rocks and types of rocks.
Concepts of Isostasy.
2.2 INTRODUCTION
In the first unit we have studied about meaning, definition, nature, scope and recent
trends in physical Geography. I hope you understood well. As you know about Geography is
the oldest earth science. In this unit our major aim is to introduce students with the formation
of solar system & the different types of evolutionary theories provided through different
Geographers. How did the earth originate? This chapter also explains about interior of earth.
How rocks are formed. What is the concept of Isostasy, What is Airy- Heiskanen, Pratt-
Hayford concepts?
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 22 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
diameter of whole solar system is nearly 1,173 core kilometres. The distance between sun and
the earth is about 149, 600,000 km (1.496x108 km). The diameter of the earth is 12,742 km.
The average density of the earth is 5.52 respectively. The ninth planet of the solar system is
Pluto and discovered in 1930, but IAU (International Astronomical Union) relegated Pluto
and recognised it as a “dwarf planet” as 134340 Pluto in month of September, year 2006. The
planets of our solar system are divided in two groups:
1-The inner circle planets or the ‘terrestrial planets’ for example Mercury, Venus, Earth and
Mars
2-‘Giant planets’ or the planets of the outer circle for example Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus and
Neptune
Our solar system is a small part of the system of stars, known as the galaxy. The diameter of
our galaxy or the Milky Way is about 105 light years. The average distance from the sun, are
shown in following table and period of orbital revolution, period of rotation, diameter,
average density and number of satellites of the member planets of our solar system is also
shown in this table
Table: 2.1 Characteristics of Solar System
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 23 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 24 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 25 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Or
Orbit
Sun
Star Filament
Sun Sun
Orbit
Filament
Or
bi
Star
Primitive incandescent gaseous planets rate of cooling was dependent upon the
planet’s size. There was a very slow cooling in the planets of grater mass while the planets in
smaller size and satellites condensed to liquid and then to solid forms within very short span
of period. This may be the possible reason:
Larger number of planets satellites which are big.
Few numbers of satellites of planets are smaller.
Modification by Jeffreys:
‘Collision hypotheses’ a concept of British scientist Harold Jeffrey presented by the
modification of the original tidal hypothesis of James Jeans in 1929. He said that, before the
origin of the solar system there were 3 stars in the Universe. The 3 stars namely of which
Harold Jeffrey was talking about are:
1-Primitive sun
2-Companion star
3-Intruding star (moving towards the companion star)
As a result, the intruding star collided against the ‘companion star’. Companion star was
completely smashed and shattered due to head-on collision. Some shattered portions were
scattered in the sky. Remaining debris started revolving around the primitive sun. From the
remaining debris of the companion star the planets were formed of our solar system.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 26 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
explanation for such unusual situation. Jeans was not able to elaborate the process and
mechanism of the condensation of matter ejected from the primitive sun.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 27 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
matter started revolving around the sun and under the combined impacts of 3 types of
motions:
(i) Gravitational force exerted by the sun on the dark matter disc.
(ii) The rotational motion of the sun itself
(iii) The angular momentum of dark matter of the disc.
So, under the combined impact of these 3 types of motions, dark matters of the
universe each and every particle of started redistributing itself on the basis of mass, density
dimension and the existing amount of centrifugal force tending to push the particles away
from the sun and the centripetal force tending to push the particles towards the sun. Heavy
particles are formed through intense heat which remained in the inner bands of the disc.
Collision among the dust particles started the process of aggregation and accretion around the
bigger particles. Which became the embryos of the future planets but the gas particles could
not condense as they could not be recognised due to their continued motion. As time passes
away, more and more matter is captured by these embryos and thus grew in size to become
asteroids. These asteroids further grew in size due to continuous accretion of matter nearly
around them and thus they became planets. The outer bands planets of the disc were of low
density because they were formed by the ‘freezing out’ process of the gaseous matter.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 28 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
between the galaxies so the universe was much small. In one instant at a fixed moment in
time all of the matter in universe was created. “For fifteen billion years as universe expanded,
the hot radiation in the original fireball also expanded with it, and cooled as a result.” Some
15 billion years ago it was summarised that there was a single fireball. ‘Wispy clouds of
matter were already there stretching across vast distances, upwards five hundred million light
years across. As by collapse of those clouds collapsed in upon themselves, pulled together by
their own gravity, they would have broken up and formed clusters of galaxies with the
galaxies themselves breaking up into stars like those in Milky Way’. The stars must have
been broken up to form their planets as our earth.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 29 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Evidences from the theories of the origin of the earth, of the Earth’s interior:
Different hypotheses and theories of the origin of the earth have assumed that the
original form of the earth is to be solid or liquid or gaseous. Laplace’s ‘Nebular Hypothesis’,
‘Tidal Hypothesis’ and ‘Planetesimal Hypothesis’ are some examples of these theories.
The primary waves are also popularly known as longitudinal or compression waves or
simply ‘P’ waves are parallel to sound waves in which particles move both to and fro in the
line of the propagation of the ray. Through solid materials it travels in fastest speed. As
passing by liquid material speed get’s slow down.
Transverse or distortional or simply S waves are secondary waves. Transverse waves cannot
pass through liquid materials.
Long Period waves or simply L wave’s are different names of surface waves. Of all
seismic waves these waves cover longest distances. Though their speed is lower than P and S
waves but these are most violent and destructive.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 30 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Crust
SIAL
zzz
SIMA
NIFE
Source: Google
2) SIMA is just located below the sialic layer. SIMA is composed of basalt and is the source
of magma and lava during volcanic eruptions. (SI+MA=SIMA) Silica and magnesium are the
dominant constituents. Between 2.9 to 4.7 the average density ranges. Thickness varies from
1,000 km to 2,000 km. Basic matter is in plenty amount. Silicates of magnesium, iron and
calcium are found richly.
3) NIFE is located below the ‘sima’ layer. (NI+FE = NIFE) is the composition of this layer.
Ni= nickel
Fe=ferrium
This layer is formed from heavy metals. It is responsible for very high density (11) of this
layer. 6880 km is the diameter of this zone. The presence of iron (ferrium) indicates the
magnetic property of the earth’s interior. Rigidity of the earth is also indicated by this
property.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 31 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
2.9.1 Crust
The solid outer layer of the Earth is called crust. In relative terms, crust is equivalent
to the skin of an apple. Usually its depth is never more than 1 per cent of the Earth’s radius,
or an average 40–50 km, but around the globe this varies considerably. Two different types of
crust:
1- Continental
2- Oceanic crust
1 Known as SIAL and rich in silica and Known as SIMA and rich in silica, and
aluminium magnesium
3 Its average thickness of 35–40 km, Its average thickness of 6–10 km.
but under mountain ranges it can be
up to 70 km thick
4 Less dense than oceanic crust its Denser than continental crust its average
average density is 2.7–2.8 density is = 3
5 Occurs only under large land masses Occurs under the oceans and forms
or continental shelves and forms 30– 60–70 per cent of the total crust
40 per cent of the total crust
‘Moho’ or Mohovoriãiç discontinuity is the boundary between the crust and the mantle. At
this point, shockwaves initiate to travel faster, indicating a structure change.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 32 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Source: Google
2.9.2 Mantle
This zone ranges 25 to 70 km below the surface within the Earth’s interior to a depth
of 2,900 km. It is mainly composed of silicate rocks, rich in magnesium and iron. Mantle has
two types; upper and lower mantle. In a semi-molten state the lower mantle remains, apart
from the rigid top layer. At the mantles, temperatures may reach up to 5,000°C. High
temperatures help to generate convection currents which drive plate tectonics. Weichert-
Gutenberg discontinuity at the depth of 2900 km is the boundary between the mantle and
core.
2.9.3 Core
It is composed of iron and nickel and is the very centre of the Earth. It consists outer
core and inner core. Temperature at the very centre of the Earth (6,300 km below surface)
may reach 5,500°C. 10.5 are the density of the outer core and up to 16 is inner core.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 33 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 34 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Agents of Metamorphism:
Three agents played a vital role in metamorphism.
1- The most important factor for the development of metamorphic rocks from pre-
existing parent rock is heat.
2- Compression is resulting from convergent horizontal movement cause by endogenic
forces causes rock beds folding.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 35 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
3- Solution is chemically active hot gases and water while passing through the rocks
change their composition of chemical.
Classification of Metamorphism:
Metamorphism processes may be classified on the basis of:
(i) Metamorphism agents nature i.e. Thermal, Dynamic, Hydro-metamorphic and Hydro-
thermal metamorphism
(ii) Place and area involved i.e. Contact and regional metamorphism
(iii) Composite classification i.e. Contact and thermal metamorphism, Dynamic and
regional metamorphism, Hydro-thermal metamorphism.
Marbles, Schist, Slate, Gneiss and Quartzite are the examples of metamorphic rocks.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 36 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
2.12 CONCLUSION
By thoroughly going to this unit, you must have understood about our solar system
and evolutionary theories. Studying this chapter, you might have also known about the
evidences of earth its interior, rocks, classification of rocks and Isostasy.
2.13 SUMMARY
In the first part of this unit, we tried to understand about Solar system & evolutionary
theories. How did the earth originated? After studying the objectives of this unit you have
known the evidences of earth interior, classification of rocks, Isostasy. Studying these
features, you will be able to understand that structure of earth interior, rocks and Isostasy
balance.
2.14 GLOSSARY
1- Barysphere: The innermost zone of the interior of the earth and extends from
2800 km with average density ranges between 8 and 11 is represented by Barysphere.
2- Core: The deepest and most inaccessible zone of the interior of the earth.
3- Crust: The outermost layer of the earth.
4- Density: Density is mass per unit volume of substance, measured in gram per cubic
centimetre (g/cm3).
5- Lithosphere: Rock sphere (lithos-rocks) means lithosphere. Represents the solid portion
of the continents. It is composed of mostly silicate minerals.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 37 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
6- Mantle: The second zone of the interior of the earth and extends from 30 km to
2900 km.
7- Pyrosphere: The middle zone of the earth with a thickness of 2780 km. having an
average density of 5.6.
8- Seismic waves: Waves generated by the occurrence of earthquakes are called seismic
waves.
9- Seismology: The science that deals with different aspects of seismic waves.
10- Seismograph: An instrument which records the seismic waves generated by the
occurrence of earthquakes.
11- Sills: The solidified form of thick sheet of magma parallel to the beds of sedimentary
rocks.
2.16 REFERENCES
1. Singh Savindra, 2011, Physical Geography, Prayag Pustak Bhavan, Allahabad, ISBN: 81-
86539-29-8.
2. Ettwein V, Maslin M, 2011, Physical geography: fundamentals of the physical environment,
University of London, International Studies Guide.
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 38 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
3. http:// knowledgegeo.blogspot.in/2016/09/global-isostatic-adjustment
4. Draft version of Suresh V.Madha, department of geography, university of madras, Chennai.
5. All books of Physical Geography and all internet articles/blogs/Wikipedia/each and
everything.
6. http://www.preservearticles.com/2011103116345/what-is-isostasy.html
7. http://officersiasacademy.blogspot.in/2016/04/concept-of-isostasy.html
8. https://www.revolvy.com/topic/Isostasy&item_type=topic
UNIT 2 - ORIGIN OF THE EARTH, EARTH INTERIOR, ISOSTASY Page 39 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 Uttarakhand Open University
3.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, will help the students in clearing their concepts as regards the following:
Understanding the Earth’s movement concept.
Learning the volcanism, volcanism features & hazardous effects of volcanism eruptions.
Gaining knowledge of seismicity.
Discussing the concepts of India’s seismic zone mapping & prediction of earthquake and
preparedness.
3.2 INTRODUCTION
As we have studied in the previous unit that the Earth is a member of our solar system. We
studied about various evolutionary theories, interior of earth and we also studied about rocks and
isostasy. In this unit we will be discussing about Earth’s movements, volcanoes & seismicity.
3.3.1Epeirogenetic movements
Epeirogenic movements are movements which involv forces acting along a radius from the
Earth's centre to the surface, and are characterized by large-scale upliftment or submergence of
land areas. The movements involved are often so slow and widespread that no obvious folding or
fracturing is produced in the rocks. Epeirogenetic movements can be divided into two types.
(1) Upward movement.
(2) Downward movement.
3.3.2Orogenetic movements
Orogenic or the mountain-forming movements act tangentially to the earth surface, as
plate tectonics. Tensions produce fissures (this type of force acts away from a point in two
directions) and compression produces folds (because this type of force acts towards a point from
two or more directions). In the landforms so produced, the structurally identifiable units are
difficult to recognize.
Diastrophic forces have uplifted lands which have predominated forces that lowered them.
Orogenetic movements are caused due to endogenetic forces working in horizontal manner.
Orogenetic or horizontal forces work in two ways:-
(a) In opposite directions and
(b) Towards each other.
This is called tensional force therefore, when this force operates in opposite directions
tensional forces creates rupture, cracks, fracture and faults in the crustal parts of the earth.
3.4.1Components of volcanoes
Magma - Molten rock beneath Earth's surface.
Parasitic Cone - A small cone-shaped volcano formed by an accumulation of volcanic debris.
Sill - A flat piece of rock formed when magma hardens in a crack in volcano.
Vent - An opening in Earth's surface through which volcanic materials escape’s.
Flank - The side of a volcano.
Lava - Molten rocks that erupts from volcanoes and therefore solidifies as it cools.
Crater - Mouth of a volcano [ surrounds a volcanic vent].
Conduit - An underground passage through which magma travels.
Summit - Highest point, i.e. (apex).
Throat - Entrance of a volcano. The part of the conduit that ejects lava and volcanic ash.
Ash - Fragments of lava or rock smaller than 2 mm in size that are blasted into the air by
volcanic explosions.
Ash Cloud - A cloud of ash formed by volcanic explosions.
3.4.2Erupted materials
Three basic kinds of materials may erupt from a volcano. They are:
(1) Lava,
(3) Gases.
1-Lava is the name for magma that has reached the earth's surface. When lava comes to the
surface, it is red hot and may have a temperature of more than 1100 C. Therefore, highly fluid
lava flows rapidly down through volcano's slopes. Sticky lava flows more slowly. As the lava
cools, it hardens into many different forms. Highly fluid lava hardens into smooth, folded sheets
of rock called pahoehoe. Stickier lava cools into rough, jagged sheets of rock called aa. Pahoehoe
and aa cover large areas of Hawaii, where the terms originated. The stickiest lava forms flows of
boulders and rubble called block flows. It may also form mounds of lava called domes.
2-Rock fragments, generally called tephra, are formed from sticky magma. Such magma is so
sticky that its gas cannot easily escape when the magma approaches the surface or central vent.
Finally, the trapped gas builds up so much pressure that it blasts the magma into fragments.
Tephra includes, from smallest to largest, volcanic dust, volcanic ash and volcanic bombs.
Volcanic dust consists of particles less than 0.25 millimeter in diameter. Volcanic dust can be
carried great distances. In 1883, the eruption of Krakatau in Indonesia shot dust 27 kilometers
into the air. The dust was carried around the earth several times and produced brilliant red
sunsets in many parts of the world. It is likely that large quantities of volcanic dust can affect the
climate by reducing the amount of sunlight that reaches the earth.
Volcanic ash is made up of fragments less than 0.5 centimeters in diameter. Most volcanic ash
falls to the surface and becomes welded together as rock called volcanic tuff. Sometimes,
volcanic ash combines with water in a stream and forms a boiling mudflow. Mudflows may
reach speeds of 97 kilometers per hour and can be highly destructive.
Volcanic bombs are large fragments. Most of them range from the size of a baseball to that of a
basketball. The largest bombs may measure more than 1.2 meters across and weigh up to 91
metric tons. Small volcanic bombs are generally called cinders.
3-Gas discharges out of volcanoes in large quantities during most eruptions. The gas is mainly
made up steam. But it also includes carbon dioxide, nitrogen, sulfur dioxide, and other gases.
Most of the steam comes from a volcano's magma.
Hawaiin type of volcanoes erupts quietly due to less viscous lavas and non-violent
nature of gases. Rounded blisters of hot and glowing boll of lavas when caught by a
strong wind glide in the air like red and glowing hairs.
(b) Strombolian type
Strambolian type of volcanoes , named after Stromboli volcano of Lipari island in
the Mediterranean sea, erupt with moderate intensity. Other volcanic materials like
pumice, scoria, bombs are also ejected upto greater height in the sky. These
materials again fall down in the volcanic craters.
(c) Vulcanian type
Predicting eruptions
Understanding how volcanoes work and how their eruptions can be predicted is essential
for the well-being and preservation of people who inhabit volcanically vulnerable areas.
Eruptions can occur without any preceding signals, making them extremely difficult to predict.
However, sometimes there are useful clues for judging when a volcano is likely to erupt.
A volcano's eruptive history may provide some clues. However, because only a small number of
the world's volcanoes have a known history it is extremely difficult to predict future eruptions,
particularly for certain types of volcanoes. This problem is typified by using the repose period, or
the time between eruptions to indicate the expected size and strength of an eruption. Consistently
long repose periods may indicate that a volcano's eruptions are usually large and explosive.
However, sometimes there is no clear relationship in the length of time between eruptions and
the nature of the eruptions.
Earthquake activity around a volcano can provide valuable information. An eruption can be
preceded by hundreds of small earthquakes know as earthquake swarms. Earthquakes also can
indicate that magma is moving beneath a volcano. However, eruptions can occur with no
perceivable change in seismic activity.
Small changes in the shape of a volcano such as bulging may indicate that magma is rising.
Accurately measuring the summit and slopes of a volcano is one of the most important tools used
for forecasting an eruption. Temperature changes in surface lakes or the groundwater near a
volcano also can be a valuable early detection tool, although not all large changes in temperature
are related to volcanic eruptions.
Gases emitted at, or near a volcano may show that a magma chamber is refilling or that a new
composition of magma is rising from depth. Changes in the volume or type of volcanic gases
produced also may be an indicator of magma activity.
3.4.5.1Circum-pacific belt
The Pacific "Ring of Fire" is a string of volcanoes and sites located on most of the Earth's
subduction zones having high seismic activity, around the edges of the Pacific Ocean.
The Pacific Plate hits other plates nearby and that causes them to sink because of O-O or O-C
convergence. The crust melts producing the magma that feeds the different volcanoes in the
Pacific Ring of Fire or it will help produce new volcanoes. The Ring of Fire is the result of plate
tectonics. Most tectonic activity in the Ring of Fire occurs in these geologically active zones.
It is believed that the Pacific Ring of Fire has a total of 452 volcanoes. Most of the active
volcanoes on The Ring of Fire are found on its western edge, from the Kamchatka Peninsula in
Russia, through the islands of Japan and Southeast Asia, to New Zealand.
3.4.5.2Mid-continental belt
This volcanic belt extends along the Alpine mountain system of Europe, north America,
through Asia Minor, Caucasia, Iran, afganistan and Pakistan to the Himalayan mountain system,
including Tibet, the pamir, Tien-Shan, altai, and the mountains of China, Myammar and eastern
Siberia. This zone is characterized by larger volcanoes & earthquakes of shallow origin and
some of intermediate origin. Deep focus earthquakes are almost absent in this belt. About 21 per
cent of the total earthquakes of the world are recorded in this belt.
This belt includes the volcanoes of Alps mountains, Mediterranean Sea (Stromboli, Vesuvius,
Etna, etc.), volcanoes of Aegean Sea, Mt. Ararat (Turkey), Elburz, Hindukush and Himalayas.
3.4.5.3Mid-Atlantic belt
The Mid-Atlantic Ridge is composed of discrete spreading segments that are tens of
kilometers long, and offset by transform faults and non transform offsets. The axis of the Mid-
Atlantic Ridge is marked by a major rift valley 1 to 1.5 kilometers deep, a central floor 4 to 15
kilometers across, and ranges of crestal mountains on each side of the valley separated by 20 to
40 kilometers. The median valley walls are composed of large faults that move the crust upwards
to form the crestal mountains. The central valley floor is the primary site of ocean crust
construction, and most segments contain an axial volcanic ridge that runs down the center of the
median valley floor. The axial volcanic ridges are themselves made up of smaller ridges, round
domes, and a variety of topographic features that all amalgamate into a single larger ridge. Axial
volcanic ridges may be 2 to 4 kilometers across and 100 to 600 meters high, and represent a very
much larger scale of volcanic relief than found on fast-spreading ridges, which are characterized
mainly by flat-lying flows. There are two types of volcanic features: Some are composed of lava
hummocks 50 to 200 meters in diameter and at most 10 to 20 meters high, while other features
are coated with smooth lava flows that cover most of the median valley floor.
3.4.5.4Intra-plate volcanoes
3.5VOLCANIC FEATURES
Volcanic landforms are divided into extrusive and intrusive landforms based on weather
magma cools within the crust or above the crust.
A conical vent is a narrow cylindrical vent through which magma flows out violently.
Conical vents are common in andesitic (composite or stratovolcano) volcanism.
A fissure vent, also known as a volcanic fissure or eruption fissure, is a narrow, linear
volcanic vent through which lava erupts, usually without any explosive activity.
The vent is often a few meters wide and may be many kilometers long. Fissure vents are
common in basaltic volcanism.
2-Mid-Ocean Ridges
These volcanoes occur in the oceanic areas. There is a system of mid-ocean ridges more
than 70,000 km long that stretches through all the ocean basins. The central portion of
this ridge experiences frequent eruptions.
The lava is basaltic in nature (Less silica and hence less viscous).
Cools slowly and flows through longer distances.
The lava here is responsible for sea floor spreading.
Source: Google
Source: Google
Sometimes, a very thin magma escapes through cracks and fissures in the earth’s surface
and flows after intervals for a long time, spreading over a vast area, finally producing a
layered, undulating (wave like), flat surface.
Example: Deccan traps (peninsular India), Snake Basin, U.S.A, Icelandic Shield,
Canadian Shield etc.
6-Caldera Lake
After the eruption of magma has ceased, the crater frequently turns into a lake at a later
time. This lake is called a ‘caldera’. Examples: Lonar in Maharashtra and Krakatao in
Indonesia.
Source: Google
7-Cinder cone
A cinder cone is a steep conical hill of loose pyroclastic fragments, such as volcanic
clinkers, cinders, volcanic ash, or scoria that has been built around a volcanic vent.
Source: Google
Intrusive landforms are formed when magma cools within the crust [Plutonic rocks
(intrusive igneous rock)].
The intrusive activity of volcanoes gives rise to various forms.
Source: Google
Batholiths
These are large rock masses formed due to cooling down and solidification of hot magma
inside the earth.
They appear on the surface only after the denudation processes remove the overlying
materials.
Batholiths form the core of huge mountains and may be exposed on surface after erosion.
These are granitic
Laccoliths
These are large dome-shaped intrusive bodies connected by a pipe-like conduit from
below.
Lapolith
As and when the lava moves upwards, a portion of the same may tend to move in a
horizontal direction wherever it finds a weak plane. It may get rested in different forms.
In case it develops into a saucer shape, concave to the sky body, it is called Lapolith.
Phacolith
A wavy mass of intrusive rocks, at times, is found at the base of synclines or at the top of
anticline in folded igneous country.
Such wavy materials have a definite conduit to source beneath in the form of magma
chambers (subsequently developed as batholiths). These are called the Phacoliths.
Sills
Dykes
When the lava makes its way through cracks and the fissures developed in the land, it
solidifies almost perpendicular to the ground.
It gets cooled in the same position to develop a wall-like structure. Such structures are
called dykes.
These are the most commonly found intrusive forms in the western Maharashtra area.
These are considered the feeders for the eruptions that led to the development of the
Deccan traps.
Primary Hazards: Hazards that are a direct result of the eruption and are caused by the released
of substances during the eruption.
Lava Flow: The most commonly associated hazard with volcanoes. Lava flows are simply rivers
of molten rock. Viscous (thick) lava flows are very slow, which means most lava flows can be
avoided by humans. However, they can cause massive damage to land and property and trigger
fires.
Tephra (Lava Bombs): Any material that is ejected from a volcano during an eruption. As long
as you are standing a safe distance, humans should not be effected by tephra although they can
damage buildings and start secondary fires.
Pyroclastic Flow: Probably the most dangerous of all volcanic hazards are pyroclastic flows
(sometimes called nuee ardentes) which are superheated clouds of ash, gas and small tephra.
They can travel at speeds up to 500km/hr and incinerate anything in their path.
Ash Cloud: Ash clouds are normally released into the atmosphere. Although they don't pose
much immediate danger they can disrupt air travel and when the ash falls to ground it can crush
buildings and bury farmland and also cause the secondary hazard of acid rain.
Poisonous Gases: Often released before a major eruption these gases can be deadly to animals
and humans if inhaled in sufficient quantities.
Lahar (mudslide): Volcanoes ash and/or lava can cause snow to melt or they can mix with
river/rain water and create mudslides, commonly known as lahars.
Acid Rain: Gases released during an eruption e.g. sulphur dioxide can mix with water vapour in
the atmosphere and create acid rain which can damage buildings and change the pH of soils and
lakes killing plant and animal life.
Climate Change: Gases released into the atmosphere e.g. sulphur dioxide can enhance the
greenhouse effect causing global warming. However, ash released into the atmosphere can also
absorb or reflect incoming solar radiation and reduce global temperatures.
Fires: Tephra and lava flows can start fires which can cause widespread damage to buildings and
land.
3.8.1Causes of earthquakes
Earthquakes are usually caused when rock underground suddenly breaks along a fault. This
sudden release of energy causes the seismic waves that make the ground shake. When two blocks
of rock or two plates are rubbing against each other, they stick a little. They don't just slide
smoothly; the rocks catch on each other. The rocks are still pushing against each other, but not
moving. After a while, the rocks break because of all the pressure that's built up. When the rocks
break, the earthquake occurs. During the earthquake and afterward, the plates or blocks of rock
start moving, and they continue to move until they get stuck again. The spot underground where
the rock breaks is called the focus of the earthquake. The place right above the focus (on top of
the ground) is called the epicenter of the earthquake.
Different types of waves have different ways of travel, different intensity, and different speeds.
The medium for seismic waves is almost always solid rock, but occasionally can include water.
P-waves
S-waves
P-waves (pressure waves) are longitudinal waves. That means that they occur by compression.
All waves move energy in a certain direction, but the particles that carry the wave may move
those particles in either the direction of wave travel or in a different direction. S-waves (shear
waves) have particle motion at right angles to the wave's travel direction. Seismic waves are
measured using a machine called a seismograph.
The first major scale used to measure seismic waves was the Richter Scale. This is the name
most commonly known among non-geologists. The Richter scale measures the maximum
intensity of wave measured by a seismograph located 100 km from the epicenter of an
earthquake. It is a logarithmic scale. This means that 4 is not 1 more than 3, 4 is 10 more than 3.
Each whole number is ten times as strong as the one below. there are problems with the Richter
scale. There is not always a seismograph located 100 km from the epicenter. Strong earthquakes
all tend to measure around 7 to 8 on the scale because it loses the ability to measure much past
that point. It is very useful for designing safe buildings locally, but not very useful at any
particular distance past 100 km from the epicenter. It also doesn't tell how long an earthquake
lasts, or how much damage it causes, or how far the ground may have shifted.
First, determine the distance to the epicenter. This is done by comparing the P-wave and S-waves
in a seismogram. Because p-waves travel faster than s-waves, and we know how fast they
generally do travel in crustal rocks, if you know the amount of time between when they get
arrive, you can calculate distance.
3.7.3Classification of earthquakes
BASED ON LOCATION:
Interplate Intraplate
An interplate earthquake is one that occurs at a An intraplate earthquake is
plate boundary an earthquake that occurs in the interior of
a tectonic plate
Recurrence time is less Recurrence time is longer
Interplate Earthquakes are recognized at Intraplate earthquakes are rarely recognized
surface at the surface. This is because the faults are
buried under several kilometers of surface
materials & the longer recurrence intervals
allow any surface expression of faulting to
be eroded.
Interplate earthquakes release less stress & are Intraplate earthquakes release more stress.
dissipated quickly because of weaker rocks The ground motion caused by intraplate
near plate boundaries. earthquake seismic waves dissipates more
slowly. The strong, coherent rocks that
make up the interiors of plates transmit
seismic energy more efficiently over longer
distances than the less coherent, weaker
rocks near plate boundaries.
Non Tectonic Earthquakes: These are due to volcanic activities and manmade reasons e.g,
nuclear testing, blasts, construction of large dams, deforestation etc
Tectonic Earthquakes: These are due to sudden slip in the fault of the tectonic plates of the
earth.
Class Magnitude
Great 8 or more
Major 7 – 7.9
Strong 6 – 6.9
Moderate 5 – 5.9
Light 4 – 4.9
Minor 3 -3.9
This belt is located around the coast of the Pacific Ocean. In this belt the earthquakes originate
mostly beneath the ocean floor near the coast. The Circum- Pacific Belt represents the
convergent plate boundaries where the most widespread and intense earthquakes occur.
This belt runs from Alaska to Kurile, Japan, Mariana and the Philippine trenches. Beyond this, it
bifurcates into two branches. One branch going towards the Indonesian trench and the other
towards the Kermac-Tonga trench to the northwest of New Zealand.
This belt is located on the western side of the Pacific Ocean. On the eastern side of the Pacific
Ocean, the earthquake belt runs parallel to the west coast of North America and moves on
towards the South along the Peru and Chile trench lying on the west coast of South America.
This belt has about 66 percent of the total earthquake that are recorded in the world. Most of the
earthquakes occurring in this belt are shallow ones with their focus about 25 km deep.
This belt is characterized by the sea floor spreading which is the main cause of the occurrence of
earthquakes in it. This earthquake belt runs along the mid- oceanic ridges and the other ridges in
the Atlantic Ocean.
In this belt most of the earthquakes are of moderate to mild intensity. Their foci are generally
less than 70 km deep. Since the divergent plates in this belt move in opposite directions and there
is splitting as well, transform faults and fractures are created.
All this becomes the causative factor for the occurrence of shallow focus earthquakes of
moderate intensity. The sea floor spreading is the main cause for the occurrence of earthquakes
in this belt.
This belt extends along the young folded Alpine mountain system of Europe, North Africa,
through Asia Minor, Caucasia, Iran, Afghanistan and Pakistan to the Himalayan mountain
system. This belt continues further to include Tibet, the Pamirs and the mountains of Tien Shan
etc.
The young folded mountain systems of Myanmar, China and eastern Siberia fall in this belt. This
belt happens to be the subduction zone of continental plates. It is in this belt that the African as
well as Indian plates sub-duct below the Eurasian plate.
This Mid- Continental belt is characterized by experiencing about 20 per cent of the earthquakes
in the world. This belt records earthquakes of shallow and intermediate origin. However, it is
true that sometimes earthquakes of great violence occur in this belt.
This belt forms a great circle approximately east and west around the earth, through the
Mediterranean, Southern Asia, Indonesia and the East Indies, where the great majority of
recorded shocks occur.
It may be pointed out that more than 50 percent of all earthquakes are associated with the young
folded mountains which are said to be still growing.
(2) Landslides-The shocks produced by earthquakes particularly in hilly areas and mountains
which are tectonically sensitive cause’s landslides and debris fall on human settlements and
transport system on the lower slope segments, inflicting damage to them.
(3) Fires- The strong vibrations caused by severe earthquakes strongly shake the buildings and
thus causing severe fires in houses, mines and factories because of overturning of cooking gas,
contact of live electric wires, churning of blast furnaces, displacement of other fire related and
electric appliances.
(4) Flash Floods- Strong seismic waves cause damage to dams thereby causing severe flash
floods. Severe floods are also caused because of blocking of water flow of rivers due to rock
blocks and debris produced by severe tremors in the hill slopes facing the river valleys.
Sometimes the blockage is so severe that rivers change their main course.
(5) Deformation of Ground surface- severe tremors and resultant vibrations caused by
earthquakes result in the deformation of ground surface because of rise and subsidence of ground
surface and faulting activity( formation of faults).
(6) Tsunamis- The seismic waves caused by earthquake( measuring more than 7 on Richter
scale) travelling through sea water generate high sea waves and cause great loss of life and
property.
Medium and short range predictions are very useful because they can help in saving the
largest population from disaster in terms of life and property. Scientists believe that it is possible
to predict major earthquakes by monitoring the seismicity caused by natural earthquakes, mining
blasts, nuclear tests, etc.
However, no flawless technique has been developed to predict the earthquakes till date.
Most of the methods and models are beyond the scope of the present work and only a few simple
methods and models will be discussed here.9 Methods to Predict Earthquake are:
Preparedness
Preparedness can consist of survival measures, preparation that will improve survival in the
event of an earthquake, or mitigating measures, that seek to minimize the effect of an earthquake.
The basic theme behind preparedness is to be ready for an earthquake.
3.8 CONCLUSION
Going thoroughly through this unit, you must have understood about earth’s movement
concept and eperogenetic & orogenetic movements. Studying this chapter, you might have also
known about the volcanism and seismicity.
3.9 SUMMARY
In the first part of this unit, we tried to understand about earth’s movement & its
concepts. After studying the objectives of this unit you have known about the volcanism &
seismicity. Studying these features, you will be able to understand that how did volcanoes
formed? Types of volcanoes, features of volcanoes & how did earthquake occur?
3.10 GLOSSARY
Lava: Molten rock above the surface of the earth.
Magma Chamber: A store of magma found below the surface of the earth. When the pressure
becomes too great in the magma chamber, volcanoes occur.
Vent: The main passage by which magma travels from the magma chamber to the crater. You
can also get smaller secondary vents that often split off from the main vent.
Crater: A large hole or depression that has been created by a volcano. Lakes will often form in
the bottom of lakes, they are known as crater lakes.
3.12 REFERENCES
http://www.mindfeeders.org/harmful-effects-of-earthquakes/
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Earthquake_preparedness
http://www.jma.go.jp/jma/en/Activities/volcano_1.pdf
http://lorpub.gadoe.org/State%20of%20Georgia/GAVS%20Shared/Science/Geology_Earthquake
s_Shared/Geology_Earthquakes_Shared3.html
http://www.duhaime.org/LegalDictionary/E/EarthMovement.aspx
https://www.pmfias.com/volcanic-landforms-extrusive-intrusive-composite-shield-fissure-type-
volcano/
https://civildigital.com/classification-earthquakes/
http://www.ga.gov.au/scientific-topics/hazards/volcano/basics/causes
1. Singh Savindra, 2011, Physical Geography, Prayag Pustak Bhavan, Allahabad, ISBN: 81-
86539-29-8.
2. Ettwein V, Maslin M, 2011, Physical geography: fundamentals of the physical environment,
University of London, International Studies Guide.
Question 2- How are the volcanoes caused? Classify the main types and give their distribution?
Question 4- Analyses the causes of earthquakes and describe with illustrations the earthquake
regions of the world?
4.1 OBJECTIVES
4.2 INTRODUCTION
4.3 WEATHERING: MEANING AND CONCEPT
4.4 FACTORS CONTROLLING WEATHERING
4.4.1 ROCK COMPOSITION AND STRUCTURE
4.4.2 NATURE OF GROUND SLOPE
4.4.3 CLIMATIC VARIATIONS
4.4.4 FLORAL EFFECTS
4.5 TYPES OF WEATHERING
4.5.1 PHYSICAL WEATHERING
4.5.2 CHEMICAL WEATHERING
4.5.3 BIOLOGICAL WEATHERING
4.6 GEOMORPHIC IMPORTANCE OF WEATHERING
4.7 EROSION: MEANING AND CONCEPT
4.7.1 EROSIONAL PROCESSES
4.7.2 FACTOR EFFECTING EROSION RATE
4.7.3 EROSIONAL CYCLE, INTERRUPTION AND
REJUVENATION
4.8 ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS
4.8.1 GLACIAL LANDFORMS
4.8.2 WIND AND AEOLIAN LANDFORMS
4.8.3 FLUVIAL LANDFORMS
4.8.4 COASTAL LANDFORMS
4.8.5 KARST LANDFORMS
4.9 CONCLUSION
4.10 SUMMARY
4.11 GLOSSARY
4.12 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
4.13 REFERENCES
4.14 SUGGESTED READINGS
4.15 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
4.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, will help the students in clearing their concepts with regard to:
Understanding the meaning and types of weathering.
Learning the factors controlling of weathering.
Gaining knowledge of geomorphic importance of weathering.
Discussing the relevance of erosion, erosional cycle and associated landforms.
4.2 INTRODUCTION
The main function of the exogenetic forces on the surface of the earth is denudation which
includes the processes of weathering and erosion. Weathering is a static process, whereas
erosion is a dynamic one. Physical weathering results into disintegration of rocks materials,
whereas chemical weathering results into decomposition of rock materials. In the tropical
humid parts, chemical weathering is dominant whereas in tropical dry deserts physical
weathering dominates. All the activities involved in removing vertical irregularities on the
surface of the earth are termed as equilibrium process. The process of bringing down the
higher parts by erosion is called degradation and the reverse process of filling the low lying
areas is called aggradation.
In climates where the diurnal range of temperature is high, and freezing due to
nocturnal cooling is common, the freeze –thaw action expands the water in rock crevices
(freezing) and then contracts it (thawing). This succession of freeze-thaw action creates
forces that are strong enough to mechanically split the rocks.
The absence of vegetation cover in arid regions promotes erosion by wind and
running water and exposes the bed rocks to the action by the agents of weathering.
All these factors work in close co-operation and influence weathering to a large
extent. However, time is the crucial factor in weathering, for these processes require long
period of time to operate.
Although weathering occurs all over the earth’s surface it is not always easy to see,
especially in new towns. If there are very old stone or brick buildings near to where you live,
look at them closely next time you pass by. You will probably see that the surface of the
stone or brick is pitted, with bits flaking off. This breakdown of the surface may have been
caused by frost action, by rain and wind, by alternate heating and cooling between summer
and winter, by the exhaust fumes of cars, by smoke from industrial plants or by a
combination of these. This type of breakdown is the result of weathering. The tombstones in
old churchyards are sometimes so weathered that it is not possible to read the names of the
deceased.
away from the main rock body. When curved plates of rock peel off in this way, it is called
exfoliation (Fig. 4.1).
Fig. 4.1 Exfoliation causes thick layers of rock to peel off the sides of desert rocks in Mauritania.
The separated plates fall to the ground and are themselves broken into smaller pieces by
forces of alternate expansion and contraction. By unloadingA large mass of rock formed far
low the surface’ either as a result of mountain building or igneous intrusion, is compressed
by the great pressure of overlying rock. As denudation removes this rock, pressure is reduced
and the compressed rock slowly expands causing cracks to develop. This process is called
unloading. As denudation continues the rock expands further resulting in large sheets of rock
to split away from the main rock body. This process is called sheeting. Eventually a dome-
like landform called an exfoliation dome (Fig. 4.2) is produced.
Fig. 4.2 Mounds of rock fragments formed by physical weathering cover the lower slopes of these
exfoliation domes
Mechanical weathering takes place at the same time as unloading and sheeting operate and it
plays an important part in breaking down the sheets of exfoliation domes into mounds of
rock fragments. The mounds accumulate on the lower slopes of the domes. These mounds are
called talus, or sometimes scree, but the latter term is better used for angular rock fragments
produced by frost action (Fig. 4.4). The mound of rock fragments at the foot of a dome-
shaped volcanic plug in the Hoggar Mountains is shown in Fig. 4.1. This is a mound of talus.
There are examples of exfoliation domes in both hot deserts and humid temperate
regions. Excellent examples occur in granite masses of Yosemite National Park in the U.S.A.
Exfoliation domes also occur in monsoon regions where temperatures and rainfall are ‘high.
At one time, exfoliation domes were thought to be the product of rock breakdown through
temperature change. While temperature changes play an important part in rock breakdown, it
is the process of unloading through pressure release that is responsible for sheeting which is
the characteristic feature of exfoliation domes.
Note: A large mass of coarsely grained igneous rock can become dome-shaped by granular
disintegration. This is the break-up of a granular rock into its separate grains by the absorption
of water which causes various minerals to expand and contract at different rates. Because the
rock does not have well-developed joints, exfoliation plates do not form, and such a dome is
not a true exfoliation dome. Sugar Loaf Mountain of Rio de Janeiro has been formed by
granular disintegration.
By frost action when water freezes its volume increases. Most rocks contain cracks,
and joints. When water enters these and freezes, a tremendous pressure is applied to the sides
of the cracks. Repeated freezing and thawing (melting), causes the cracks to get wider and
deeper. In time, frost action breaks down rocky outcrops into angular blocks which later
break down into smaller fragments. These fragments pile up at the bottom of the slopes to
form fan-shaped mounds, called screes. Fig. 4.4 shows screes at the foot of a mountain in the
Lake District of England.
Frost action occurs in both arctic and cool temperate regions, but it is most marked
•in the latter. This is because repeated freezing and thawing is far more common in these
regions than it is in arctic regions where water in the rocks tends to be frozen for many
months of the year.
Frost action also takes place in some regions in the tropics which have sufficient altitude,
including hot deserts, and it is possible that it plays a part in the process of exfoliation.
Fig. 4.4 Mountain slopes in the mountainous country known as the Lake District, in north-west
England. Screes, consisting of angular rocks, litter the lower slopes. The screes result from frost
action on the higher slopes.
Some rocks, especially well-jointed rocks, break down into large rectangular-shaped
blocks under the action of mechanical weathering caused by alternate heating and cooling,
aided perhaps by frost action. When rocks break down in this manner, it is called block
disintegration (Fig. 4.5).
Fig. 4.6 The formation of a granite tor. Unweathered rounded lumps of granite called corestones form a
conspicuous feature of a tor
By alternate wetting and drying, all rocks absorb a certain amount of water, but some absorb
more conspicuous than others. The absorption of water by surface rocks causes them to
swell. When the rocks dry out (and they do this quickly in tropical regions), the outer surface
of the rocks shrinks. The alternate wetting and drying weakens the rocks and they begin to
crack. This type of physical weathering takes place along the coast, especially on coastal
rocks which are alternately wetted and dried with the rise and fall of the tide.
Do You Know?
Question: Explained Weathering with Example
Let’s say you have made your favourite chocolate cake and left it outside. What would
happen? May be it would dry up and crack in the hot sun. Or perhaps rain would wash it
away. If it froze, it might crake too. This process would probably take just a few days. The
earth- and the rocks on the earth is a bit like that cake. The surface of the earth is constantly
being changed due to weathering processes. This process can take millions of years or happen
relatively quickly.
Chemical reactions take place on the surface of exposed rocks but they tend to be
greater below the surface. They can operate to depths of 200 m or more where water is able
to enter via pores, joints and cracks. The upstanding granite masses of Dart- moor and
Bodmin Moor, known as tors (Fig. 4.6) have been formed in this way. The action of physical
weathering is to break up the surface rocks which results in an increase in the surface area
thus making it possible for chemical weathering to be more effective.
When water enters the soil it combines with various acids derived ‘from decomposing
organic matter in the soil. The amount of rock disintegration that soil water can effect
depends on the corn position and strength of the soil water; the temperature; the minerals
dissolved in the soil water and the presence of soil bacteria
Soil water in humid tropical regions often dissolves all minerals except the very stable
ones such as iron and aluminium hydroxides. Aluminium hydroxides (bauxite) and iron
hydroxides (laterite) get left behind in the top layers of the soil through the process of
leaching (downward movement of water containing dissolved minerals, in the soil). Laterites
develop best in regions which have a definite dry and wet season. Bauxite is the main source
of aluminium.
Hydration:
Some minerals absorb water and in doing so they give rise to new compounds. •For
example, haematite, an iron oxide, combines with water ‘to give limonite, another iron
compound.
Fig. 4.7 (a) The effects of weathering on the surface of limestone rock; (b) limestone pavement
showing grikes (grooves) and clints fridges) near Maiham in Yorkshire.
Another example is the absorption .of water by calcium sulphate to give gypsum. Some
hydrated minerals are soluble in water, whereas the minerals from which they are formed are
insoluble. Sometimes hydration produces new compounds which are of greater bulk; this
again weakens the structure of the rocks.
Hydrolysis:
In this process hydrogen (from water) combines with certain metal ions (from minerals)
to form different chemical compounds. Hydrolysis is therefore quite different to hydration
e.g. the hydrolysis of potassium feldspar produces kaolin. Hydrolysis causes some rocks to
decay to as much as 100 m below the surface, especially in warm humid climates. The tors of
Dartmoor experience sub-surface decay as does Bismarck Rock in Tanzania.
Hydrolysis may also produce a type of exfoliation called spheroidal weathering (Fig. 4.8)
in fine— grained rocks such as basalt. Weathering attacks the rocks from all sides and. under
some climatic conditions it occurs below ground level. In hot humid climates granite
weathers to depths of 80 m through spheroidal weathering. In time the granite is turned into a
mass of rock particles which contain unweathered, rounded lumps of granite called
corestones (Fig. 4.6). Eventually, these become exposed on the surface as the weathered rock
mass is removed by erosion.
Oxidation:
This happens when oxygen combines with a mineral. Oxidation takes place actively in
rocks which contain iron, .when the oxygen combines with the iron to form iron oxides.
Hydrolysis often precedes, and accompanies, oxidation. The new minerals formed by
oxidation are often easily attacked by other weathering processes. The structure of a rock in
which iron and a silicate are joined, is completely broken down by oxidation of the iron.
Note: Usually two or more chemical weathering processes take place at the same time.
Chemical weathering is most marked in hot, wet regions.
Fig. 4.9: The roots of plants, especially trees, can sometimes help to open the cracks and joints in
rocks
Burrowing animals such as the earthworm and rabbit also effect a considerable break-
up of surface rocks, while micro-organisms such as bacteria cause both physical and
chemical breakdown of rocks. The action of these organisms.overlaps with chemical
weathering because some organisms exclude chemicals during their digestion or as they
move about.
Weathering breakdown a rock into their mineral components. It also creates new
compounds through chemical changes. During the prolonged period of time, the weathering
processes produce concentrations of valuable mineral ores of iron, manganese, tin,
aluminium and uranium etc. for example, by chemical weathering soluble bases and even
silica are removed, leaving behind increasingly rich residual concentrations of metallic
oxides. This occurs under humid tropical climatic conditions as part of laterization process.
Project Work
Depending upon the topography and materials around you, observe and record climate,
possible weathering process and its landforms.
The main agents of erosion are; (i) running water, (ii) ground water, (iii) wind, (iv)
glaciers and (v) sea waves. These are also the agents of transportation and deposition. Each
of these agents does erosion by a distinctive process and gives rise to distinctive landforms.
4.7.1 Erosional Processes: Different activities which take part in the process of erosion
are.
1) Abrasion and Corrosion: when any agent of erosion moves ahead loaded with sand,
pebbles and fragments of rocks, the rocks coming in contact of these particles are
degraded by the friction. This process is known as Abrasion.
2) Attrition: when the particles flowing with an agent of degradation get reduced in their
sizes due to manual friction, the process is known as attrition.
3) Corrosion: when soluble rocks like dolomite, limestone, chalk etc. are separated from
the rocks by the action of water, the process is called corrosion. Corrosion occurs
mainly, by the action of underground and flowing water. The activity results into the
formation of Karst topography.
4) Hydraulic Action: when rocks are broken into pieces by the action of fast flowing
water, the pieces by the action of fast flowing water, the process is known as
hydraulic action. Hydraulic action is carried out by glaciers, rivers and sea waves.
5) Water Pressure: when any rock is eroded by the pressure exerted by water, it is called
water pressure activity. This is, mainly, carried out by sea waves.
6) Plucking: this occurs by the action of glaciers. In this process, the glacier drag aong
with in the rocks which come on its way, making them weak enough to disintegrated
into large fragments.
7) Deflation: this is process by which wind removes or blows away the unconsolidated
sand, silt and clay from the land surfaces, especially in arid and semi-arid regions.
2) Vegetation is probably the most important physical factor influencing erosion. A good
cover of vegetation shields the soil from the impact of raindrops. It also binds the soil
together, making it more resistant to runoff. A vegetative cover provides organic matter,
slows runoff, and filters sediment. On a graded slope, the condition of vegetative cover will
determine whether erosion will be stopped or only slightly halted. A dense, robust cover of
vegetation is one of the best protections against soil erosion.
4) Slope, length, steepness and roughness affect erodibility. Generally, the longer the slope,
the greater the potential for erosion.The greatest erosion potential is at the base of the slope,
where runoff velocity is greatest and runoff concentrates.Slope steepness, along with surface
roughness, and the amount and intensity of rainfall control the speed at which runoff flows
down a slope. The steeper the slope, the faster the water will flow. The faster it flows, the
more likely it will cause erosion and increase sedimentation.
5) Tectonic processes control rates and distributions of erosion at the Earth's surface. If
tectonic action causes part of the Earth's surface (e.g., a mountain range) to be raised or
lowered relative to surrounding areas, this must necessarily change the gradient of the land
surface. Because erosion rates are almost always sensitive to local slope, this will change the
rates of erosion in the uplifted area. Active tectonics also brings fresh, unweatherd rock
towards the surface, where it is exposed to the action of erosion.
However, erosion can also affect tectonic processes. The removal by erosion of large
amounts of rock from a particular region, and its deposition elsewhere, can result in a
lightening of the load on the lower crust and mantle. Because tectonic processes are driven
by gradients in the stress field developed in the crust, this unloading can in turn cause
tectonic or isostatic uplift in the region.
forces, such as- diastrophic forces, vulcanicity, earthquakes etc. creates vertical irregularities
on the surface of the earth. Mountain plateaus and hills are formed due to upliftment of the
surface, whereas due to the subduction of the surface, lakes, trenches etc. are created. As
soon as the endogenetic forces form vertical irregularities on the surface of the earth, the
exogentic forces starts working as levelling agents and during this process various specific
landforms are created.
The ‘Cycle of Erosion’ is the time required for streams to reduce a newly formed land
masses to base-level. The geomorphic cycle is the topography developed during the various
stages of a cycle of erosion.
The Scottish geologist James Hutton was the first told about uniformities in the
landforms. He told ‘present is the key to past’. He told that ‘there is no trace of the past as
well as endless future’. This concept of James Hutton was carried forward by his followers
John Playfair and Sir Charles Lyell.
Youth: streams are few during this stage with poor integration and flow over original
slopes showing shallow V-shaped valleys with no flood plains or with very narrow flood
plains along the streams. Streams divides are broad and flat with marshes, swamp and
lakes. Meanders if present develop over these broad upland surfaces. These meanders
may eventually entrench themselves into the uplands. Waterfalls and rapids may exists
where local hard rock bodies are exposed.
Mature: During this stage streams are plenty with good integration. The valleys are still
V-shaped but deep; trunk streams are broad enough to have wider flood plains within
which streams may flow in meanders confined within the valley. The flat and broad inter
stream areas and swamps and marshes of youth disappear and the stream divides turn
sharp. Waterfalls and rapids disappear.
Old: Smaller tributaries during old age are few with gentle gradients. Streams meander
freely over vast flood plains showing natural levees, oxbow lakes etc. divides are broad
and flat with lakes, swamps and marshes. Most of the landscape is at or slightly above sea
level.
Any type of obstacles in the normal process of cycle of erosion is called interruption
of cycle. The main cause of interruption of cycle may be either climatic or tectonic or both.
The interruption in cycle of erosion caused by positive movement of base level shortens the
cyclic time as it advances forward the stages of cycle of erosion. For example, if the cycle is
in the mature stage, it may advance to the youth stage and start on a new cycle. These
interruptions can be cause by volcanic, climatic or changes in base level.
Rejuvenation means increase in the erosion power of the fluvial processes river
action) caused by numerous factors. Rejuvenation takes place with the relative uplift with
respect to sea level of a region which has developed a mature drainage system. The
rejuvenation may be caused from a fall in base level, an increase in stream discharge and fall
in sea level or an upliftment of land.
The German scientist Walter Penck criticised the Davidian model of geographical
cycle based on time dependent series of landform development and presented his own model
of ‘morphological System’. He held that the landform are the result of the intensity of
endogenetic processes (the rate of upliftment) and the magnitude of displacement of
materials by the exogenetic processes (the rate of erosion and removal of materials). Penck
used the term Primarumpf for the upliftment landform. He called the final landform created
after the complete cycle of erosion endrumpf.
Landforms
Associated with
Erosion
Wind and
Fluvial Glaciers Coastal
Karst Landforms Aeolian
Landforms Landforms Landforms
Landforms
Table 4.1: The Exogenetic Forces and the Landforms Carved by them
S.
Agent Action Erosional Landforms Depositional Landforms
No
Attrition,
V- shaped Valley, I-Shaped
Running Abrasion, Valley (Gorge or Canyon),
Alluvial Fan, Alluvial Cones,
Water Waterfall and Rapids,
1. Hydraulic Natural Levees, Flood plains,
Meanders, River terraces,
(River) action, Delta, Sand Banks, Sand bars
Structural Benches, Peneplain,
Pot holes
Corrosion,
height above which these is a permanent snow cover and thus it corresponds to the level
where average temperature is always below freezing point even during the warmest month of
the years.
Glaciers are the snow moving rivers of snow or ice. They formed on high mountains
are long and narrow because they are formed in an abandoned river valley. These are known
as valley glaciers. When the ice mass spreads over a large are, it is called continental
glaciers.
The small ice-sheet covering the peaks of the mountain and from which glaciers
originates, is known as ice-cap. The dome shaped ice masses spreading generally over the
plateaus are known as ice-sheet. The floating ice masses are termed as ice-bergs.
Glaciation generally gives rise to erosional features in the highlands and depositional
features on the lowlands, though these processes are not mutually exclusive because a glacier
plays a combined role of erosional, transportation and deposition throughout its course. The
main features of glaciated highlands are as follows:
It has been suggested by some of the geomorphologists that cirques developed mainly
from pre-glacial fluvially created hollows in highland terrain. These were slowly enlarged by
snow-patch erosion (nivation) in which melt water removed the disintegrated rock. It is
suggested that the hollow became occupied by a small glacier, setting in motion the freeze-
thaw process along the backwall, which progressively retreated and became over-steepened
by basal sapping. The rotational slip of the glacier deepened the cirque floor by the process
of corrasion, leaving a rock bar or lip across the mouth of the cirque. Thus, the overall
dimensions of the glacially eroded hollows have tended to increase and although they vary
greatly in size, they generally maintain similar proportions with a length to height ratio of
3:1. Cirques are also called as coire, corrie, cwm, and lear.
Horns:Through headward erosion of the cirque walls, glaciers tend to remove
divides. If three or more glaciers cut headward until their cirques meet or almost
meet, it often happens that high, sharp-pointed, steep-sided peaks called horns, or
matterhorns (after the famous matterhorn In the southern Alps) remain as the only
remnants of the original broad highlands. Many such peaks still have glaciers at their
bases which remove the debris loosened and dropped onto them by frost action, and
thus perpetuate the steep cliff.
Cal:A mountain pass leading from one valley to another.
Aretes:A French term which has been widely accepted to describe a narrow, rocky
and often jagged ridge which divides the steep walls of two adjacent cirques.
Serrated Ridges: Another typical feature of glaciated regions is the serrated or saw-
toothed ridge, which stands between the heads of present glaciers or between the
heads of cirques once occupied by valley glaciers. These ridges, in many cases only
one or two metres wide at the top and of extremely irregular surface, are all that
remains of broad preglacial divides. Due to the headward sapping of their cirque
walls, the glaciers have nearly removed their divides. The narrow ridges continually
lose boulders through frost action and gravity. Uplifted sedimentary- and
metamorphic rocks may be so greatly eroded that it is impossible for a person to
travel over the ridge.
Nunataks:A nunatak is a rock mass surrounded by ice. It may separate two valley
glaciers or two lobes of ice sheets. It stands out as an island in the ice. Through lateral
erosion by the glaciers, accompanied by frost action, avalanches, etc., the nunatak is
soon worn away until a very narrow ridge, merely a remnant of its former size
remains.
Shifting Divides: When there is greater precipitation on one side of a mountain
range than on the other, or due to less melting and evaporation on the side that
receives heat from the morning sun, or due to snow-blown from the windward to the
leeward side of a range, a larger number of glaciers may form on one side, with few
or none on the other. Where this condition exists, divides will shift through headward
erosion towards the side of the range where there are the fewest number of glaciers.
This is known as shifting divide in the glacial topography. The crest of Karakoram
Range, Zanskar Range, and the Sierra Nevada Range have been shifted to the east.
Lateral Moraines: A ridge of glacial debris flanking a glacier side or lying along
the sides of a valley formerly occupied by a glacier is known as lateral moraine.
When ice is present, the lateral moraine may bury under the glacier edge, in which
case the debris may protect the ice from surface melting. In this instance the lateral
moraine may become ice covered. As a valley glacier downwastes, a series of lateral
moraines may be deposited at lower and lower levels down the valley sides. The
slopes towards the valley often are remarkably smooth and uniform. The lateral
moraines of maximum thickness (350 metres) have been identified in Alaska and
Siberia. In many places well-developed lateral moraines join a terminal moraine, thus
forming a huge horse shoe-shaped ridge. The composition and structure of the lateral
moraine consist of debris—a mixture of dirt, rock-flour and sub-angular boulders
which are heaped without stratification. The median moraines are only transient
feature of ice surface.
In fact, many valley glaciers melt and retreat rapidly after their last advance,
leaving an irregular sheet of drift over their valley floors. This debris is called as
ground moraine. The thickness and surface topography of the ground moraines varies
considerably. Small depressions, knolls, wavy thick belts with scattered boulders, and
alluvium deposited by glacial streams are typical features of ground moraines.
Sub-glacial Moraines:Beneath the ice, material which is carried at the base of the
glacier and which performs much of the scouring action is known as sub-glacial
moraine.
swarms in previously glaciated areas of low relief. They were probably formed by a
rhythmic moulding action of the ice sheet on newly deposited ground moraine,
although no explanation of their origin and occurrence has proved completely
satisfactory.
Eskers (Osar): Eskers are long, low, narrow ridges composed of stratified sand, silt
and gravel that are found occasionally parallel to the walls of glaciated valleys. They
are not to be confused with lateral moraines, which are usually much larger and are
always made up of typical till. Eskers are more a characteristic of the continental
glacier. Sometimes, a series of swellings are strung along the eskers at regular
intervals. Such eskers are called beaded eskers.
Kame: A steep-sided alluvial cone deposited against an ice front. Kames, in fact, are
small alluvial cones if deposited on the land or small alluvial deltas if deposited in the
lakes. So kames are classified into ‘cone kames’ and ‘delta kames’.
Erratics (Boulders): Erratic is a large rock fragment (boulder) that has been
transported by moving ice, away from its place of origin and deposited in an area of
dissimilar rock type. The tracing of such erratics back to their sources may yield
important information concerning the direction of movement of the ice. It has been
suggested that certain erratic blocks found in sediments in circumstances which
preclude direct transport by a glacier may have been transported by icebergs, by being
attached to giant seaweeds, or as the stomach stones of certain reptiles.
Eolian processes and landforms produced by them characterize the arid regions,
where the absence of vegetation not only helps wind erosion, transportation and deposition,
but also it enables the resultants landscape to be observed.
Blow out- Blow out depressions are a saucer or though-shaped hollow usually in a
sand dune terrain. It is formed by deflation of pre-existing dunes or other loose sand
deposits, especially when the protective vegetation cover has been removed or
destroyed. The accumulation of sand from the blow out depressions is referred to as a
blow-out dune.
Blow out depression range from small indentations of less than a meter upto
areas hundreds of meters wide and many meters deep. Chemical weathering is
important in the formation of a blow-out. The enormous Quattar depression in the
western part of Egypt covers 18000 km2, and is 130 m below sea level at its lowest
point.
Desert Pavement- It is formed by the pebble and gravel concentration left behind
after wind deflation and water washes away fine materials, and concentrates and
cements remaining rock pieces. Desert pavement protects underlying sediments from
further deflation. It has been given various names in other countries. For example,
Gibber plain in Australia, Gobi in China and log gravel in Africa.
Ventifacts- Ventifacts are loose stones or pebbles that have been polished and faceted
by wind-blown sand in deserts. Rock exposed to wind abrasion appear pitted,
grooved, or polished with such characteristics of wind erosion are called Ventifacts.
Ventifacts are also called Dreikanter in German, as term used to describe any pebbles
or rock boulders that have been shaped by eolian erosion displaying plane faces with
three sharp angles or edges bounding them.
Yardangs- Yardangs are sharp-crested elongated ridges aligned in the direction of
the prevailing winds in the deserts. The windward face of this feature is rounded, and
the leeward extension appears like a long and sharply crested ridge. Its size varies
from a few meters to 1 km in length, up to 6 m in height and 35 m in width. There are
some yardangs on the earth that are large enough to be detected on satellite imagery.
The ice valley of Southern Peru has yardangs reaching 100 m in height and several
kilometres in length.
Wind Bridges- when high velocity strong winds attack a rock again and again, the
continuous abrasion results is the formation of holes. Such holes are called wind
windows. Further, the combined action of deflation and abrasion makes the wind
windows larger and wider which assume an arch-like shape with solid roof over them.
Such landforms are called wind-bridges. The rainbow bridge of southern Utah in the
Western U.S.A presents a magnificent example of a wind-bridge.
Inselberg- Inselberg is a German term which means an island mountain. This name
has been given by German term which means an island mountain. This name has
been given by German Geologist to the resistant masses of rock standing above the
general surface in the Kalahari Desert. Now, this term has been widely accepted and
adopted to describe a prominent steep-sides hill of resistant solid rock rising abruptly
from a plain of low relief. It is characteristics of tropical landscape, particularly in the
Savanna zone.
Do You Know?
Question: Wind action is prominent in Desert area. Why?
Wind action can be best seen in the desert areas. Features like sand dunes, Mashroom rocks, etc. are formed by the wind
action. Wind acts as an agent of erosion and deposition which leads to the formations of different features.
In the deserts we don't find lot of vegetation due to which the wind flows without anydisturbance or obstruction. Also,
because of the lack of vegetation there is no moisture content in the soil and it is not able to hold itself and becomes very
loose (sand). In a wide areawith barren land the wind blows with great velocity creating new features especially in the
deserts.
Barchans Dunes: The Barchans are formed where the supply of sand is limited and
winds of moderate velocity blow in a constant direction. Typically, they are small,
isolated dunes from 1 to 50 m high. The tips ( horn) of a barchans point downwind,
and sand grains
Star dune Star The giant of dunes. Pyramidal or star-shaped with three
or more sinuous radiating arms extending outward from a
central peak. Slipfaces in multiple directions. Results
from effective winds shifting in all directions. Tends to
form isolated mounds in high effective winds and
connected sinuous arms in low effective winds.
Other Dome Reversing Circular or elliptical mound with no slipface. Can be
modified into barchanoid forms. Asymmetrical ridge
form intermediate between star dune and transverse dune.
Wind variability can alter shape between forms.
Source: Christopherson (1995).
Loess: Loess is a wind-blown deposit of fine silt and dust. It is unstratified, non-
indurated, calcareous, permeable, homogeneous and generally yellowish in colour. It
consists of angular to sub-angular particles of quartz, feldspar, calcite, dolomite and other
minerals held together with a montmorillonite hinder. Unweathered bess is usually gray
in colour but because of its permeability exposures of unweathered bess are uncommon.
The two important sources of bess are the weathered materials in deserts (hot bess) and
the very fine powder from regions of glacial outwash (cold bess). The bess deposits are
found away from the source regions and outside the deserts. The dust particles of bess are
so small that they hold together even when dry and once deposited cannot be easily lifted
by the wind. Loess is coherent (bound together) but not cemented and hence is
permeable. Lack of stratification is a clear proof of its aeolian origin.
Extensive deposits of bess are found in many parts of the world. Loess covers as
much as one-tenth of the world’s land surface and is particularly widespread in semi-arid
regions along the margins of great deserts. The bess of China is more than 60 m thick. It is
easily eroded and transported in suspension by running water and is responsible for the
yellow colour of Hwang Ho and Hwang Hai (The Yellow Sea). Other important areas
include East Sudan, North Africa, central U.S.A. and Argentina. The largest known bess
deposit is in China. There, caves and houses are carved out of the thick deposits. Much of the
bess in North America and Europe appears to have originated by glaciers and deposited as
outwash.
Pediments: A gentle slope, cut in bedrock occurring below a markedly steeper slope
and extending at a low gradient down towards a river or alluvial plain is known as
pediment. The pediment is separated from the steeper upper slope by a relatively
rapid change of slope angle in a transitional zone, termed the pediment zone. The
pediment is generally, concave in profile.
Bahada (Bajada): ‘Bahada’ is a term derived from the Spanish language. It is used
to describe the gentle, sloping surface leading down from a mountain front to inland
basin in an arid or semi-arid region. It is composed of unconsolidated materials, such
as sand, gravel and angular scree, which together mantle the under lyin rock-cut
(pediment).
Playas: ‘Playa’ is a Spanish term referring to a level or almost level area occupying
the centre of an enclosed basin in which a temporary lake forms periodically. It is
generally composed of stratified beds of clay or silt, deposited within the lake,
thatusually contain large amounts of soluble salts. The gentle Slopes running down
the lake are known as bahada. Lake Lap-Nor is a playa in the Tarim Basin (China).
Playa lakes may last for days, weeks or even months before theyare-completely dried
up by evaporation.
When rain falls, part of it sinks into the ground, some is evaporates back into the
atmosphere and the rest runs off as rivulets, brooks, streams and tributaries of river that flow
down to the sea. This running water forms a potent agent for denuding the earth’s surface.
The course of river may be divided into three distinct parts. (i) The Upper or mountain
course, (ii) The Middle or Valley course, (iii) The lower or Plain Course. Some of the major
outstanding features developed in these different course of river are as follows.
The upper part or mountain course begins at the source of river near the watershed, which
is basically the crest of mountain range. The river is very swift as it descends the steep
slopes, and the predominant action of the river is vertical corrosion.
River Capture: This is also known as river piracy or river beheading. Its development is
dependent on the different rate of back-cutting (headward erosion) into a divide. For
instance, if one side of the divide is of greater gradient or receives more precipitation than the
other. Its greater erosive power will succeed in enlarging its basin at the eventually break
through the divide and capture or pirate stream B. The bend at which the piracy occurred it
termed as the elbow of capture. The beheaded stream is called misfit. The valley below the
elbow is wind gap. Example of river capture by Irrawaddy in England.
Gorges: Gorges is a form of V-shaped valley which is deep and narrow with precipitous
rocky walls occupied by a river. It is more steep-sided and enclosed than a ravine. As stated
earlier, in the upper course of a river corrasion is greater than deposition. The river, therefore,
deepens its channel and forms a valley. If the rocks into which the valley is cut are hard and
resistant, the sides or valley walls will be steep and the valley will be narrow. The steepness
of the valley walls is also influenced by the amount of rain. It is partly on account of dryness
of the climate that the Colorado Canyon is very narrow and its walls are nearly vertical.
Rapids and Waterfalls: these are liable to occur at any part of the river course, but they are
most numerous in the mountain course where changes of gradient are more abrupt and also
more frequent. Due to the unequal resistance of hard and soft rocks traversed by a river, the
outcrop of a band of hard rocks traversed by a river, the outcome of a band of hard rock may
course a river to ‘jump’ or ‘fall’ downstream. Rapids are formed.
Pot holes: pot holes is a more or less circular holes in the rocky bed of stream formed
by the scouring and grinding effects of pebbles roatated in an eddy formed at the base of
waterfall. In rapids and at the base of waterfalls, potholes are formed in solids rocks through
the grinding action of sand and pebbles which lodge in slight initial depression and are
swirled around by the swift water. Their grater pressure and force usually wears out a plunge-
pool beneath.
In the middle part of its course, a river develops mature features, and the valley becomes
wider. After crossing the mountainous and hilly regions, the river debouches into the
plain. In the plain area the slope is gentle, owing to which the river is slackened. This
gently sloping accumulation of course alluvium deposited by braided streams in known
as alluvial fans or alluvial cones. In some cases, the neighbouring alluvial fans may meet
and coalesce with each other as they develop and form an extensive alluvial plain in the
foot hills or piedmont area. This type of landform is known as piedmont alluvial plains.
This type of landforms is known as piedmont alluvial plain. The alluvial fans are built
mostly during the rainy season, when the volume of water as well as the sediments are
enormous.
B
Exercise: Difference between River Alluvial plains and Glacial outwash plains.
Bajada is a landform with gentle and sloping surface leading down from a mountain
front to an inland basin, in an arid or semi-arid basin. It is composed of unconsolidated
materials, such as sand, gravel and angular scree which together mantle the underlying
piedmont.
The lateral corrosion tends to replace vertical corrosion. The volume of water
increases with the confluence of many tributaries and this increase the river’s load. The work
of the river is predominantly transportation with some deposition. Downstream, the
interlocking spurs that projects both sides of the valley are cut back into a line of bluffs. Rain
wash, soil creep, landslides and gullying gradually widen the valley, cutting back the sides.
The rivers treble task of valley cutting, bed smoothing and debris removal are being carried
out in a more tranquil manner than in the mountain course through the velocity does not
decreases.
As water flowing down under gravity seldom flows straight for any long distance, a
winding course soon develops. The irregularities of the ground force the river to swing in
loops, forming meanders, a term derived from the winding river meanderez in Asia minor.
The part of river valley having a flood plain but still having definite valley walls, is
called mature. The mature river’s course is zig-zag forming loops/meanders on the valley
floor. It starts eroding its bank on the outside of each meander loop and depositing materials
on the inside of each loop. The net result is that the size of the meanders is increased by this
act of the river. So flood plain becomes wider.
When the river flows of water, the lateral erosion continues and size of meander will
increase. As the water flows round a bend, the river tends to increase the curve, since current
acts more strongly on the concave side or outside of the curve, so that the maximum erosion
takes place. There is little erosion, and even some deposition on the inside of the bend. Thus
the original swing is transformed into a fully developed meander with river cliff overhanging
the under-cut bank and a sloping spur, called a slip off shore.
Exercise: What are the differences between incised meanders and meanders over flood delta
plains.
The lower alongside stream channels are relatively flat areas known as floodplains.
Floodplains develop when streams over-top their levees spreading discharge and
suspended sediments over the land surface during floods. Levees are ridges found along
the sides of the stream channel composed of sand or gravel. Levees are approximately
one half to four times the channel width in diameter. Upon retreat of the flood waters,
stream velocities are reduced causing the deposition of alluvium. Repeated flood cycles
over time can result in the deposition of many successive layers of alluvial material.
Floodplain deposits can raise the elevation of the stream bed. This process is called
aggradation.
Floodplains can also contain sediments deposited from the lateral migration of the
river channel. This process is common in both braided and meandering channels. Braided
channels produce horizontal deposits of sand during times of reduced discharge. In
meandering streams, channel migration leads to the vertical deposition of point bar deposits.
Both braided and meandering channel deposits are coarser than the materials laid down by
flooding.
Streams flowing into standing water normally create a delta. A delta is body of
sediment that contains numerous horizontal and vertical layers. Deltas are created when the
sediment load carried by a stream is deposited because of a sudden reduction in stream
velocity. The surface of most deltas is marked by small shifting channels that carry water and
sediments away from the main river channel. These small channels also act to distribute the
stream's sediment load over the surface of the delta. Some deltas, like the Nile, have a
triangular shape. Streams, like the Mississippi, that have a high sediment content and empty
into relatively calm waters cause the formation of a birdfoot shaped delta. In general, deltas
are triangular in shape. But on the basis of shape they may be classified into the following
five categories. (i) Arcuate delta, (ii) Bird’s foot delta, (iii) Estuarine delta, (iv) Cuspate or
tooth-shaped delta, and (v) Lacustraine delta.
The delta in which the outermost margin exhibits an arc-like form, convex towards
the sea, is known as arcuate delta. The delta of Nile river is the typical example of arcuate
delta. The deltas of the Ganga, Hwang-Ho, Po and Rhine river are also good example of
arcuate delta.
Bird’s foot delta is formed by the outgrowth of natural river levees into a body of
water to form a finger-like pattern, reflecting the number of distributary streams. The best
example is the delta of Mississippi river.
When the river enters the sea through a single mouth or estuary a long and narrow
delta is formed. Normally, the estuary is open and the river sediments are removed by the
waves and currents. But when the mouth of the river is submerged below the sea, a narrow
linear delta is formed. The deltas of the Amazon and Congo rovers are the typical examples
of estuarine delta.
A delta build in a lake by a heavily laden of stream is known as lacustrine delta. The
biggest lacustrine delta are those which are being built out into the Caspian Sea by Volga,
Ural and Kura rivers.
Do You Know?
Question: Why are Deltas so Fertile?
A river when approaches towards its last stage of its course before submerging into the seas and oceans becomes very
slow. Due to the load of sediments the river is carrying and because of the flat land, it is forced to deposit the
sediments near the mouth. The river starts breaking into number of small streams known distributaries. The network of
distributaries form a triangular shaped feature called delta. These deltas are most fertile areas in the course of a river.
The deposition of sediments in the deltas is a continuous process making these deltas the most fertile areas.
Sunderbans delta formed by the Ganga – Brahmaputra river is the biggest delta and also is very fertile
as they emerge from mountainous terrain to a nearly horizontal plain. The fan is created as
braided streams shift across the surface of this feature depositing sediment and adjusting their
course. The image below shows several alluvial fans that formed because of a sudden change
in elevation.
Alluvial terraces are formed as a result of the rejuvenation of streams. Streams which
have deposited thick alluvium on flood plains or stream whose valleys have become filled
with alluvium may be rejuvenated, thus giving rise to terraces. In fact these terraces are
different from normal terraces because they are carved out of alluvium instead of solid rocks.
Alluvial terraces are generally regarded as being synonymous with a river terrace. But this
interpretation is only possible if one regards the term ‘alluvium’ as including the course sand
and gravel as well as the fine-grained deposits.
Structural benches or terraces formed by the rivers due to differential erosion of the
hard and soft rocks which lie alternatively in a V-shaped valley in a horizontal manner are
called structural benches.
The unequal solar heating of the earth’s surface produces a system of permanent
global winds. This motion of air in the form of winds, produces sea waves. These waves then
expand their energy at coastline, eroding rock, transporting sediment, and depositing them to
form numerous erosional and depositional landforms. The world’s present shorelines,
however, are not the result of present day processes alone. Nearly all coasts were profoundly
affected by the rise in sea level, glaciation, volcanism, earth movements, weathering,
erosional processes and even the growth of organism.
Marine Erosion
Erosion along coasts results from the abrasive action of sand and gravel, moved by
the waves and currents and, to a lesser extent from solution and hydraulic action. The
undercutting action of waves and currents typically produces sea cliffs. As a sea cliff recedes,
a wave cut platform develops. Minor erosional forms associated with the development of sea
cliffs include sea-caves, sea-arches, and sea stacks. Waves, particularly storm waves and
tsunamis, are the most important agents of marine erosion. Smaller waves, such as those
associated with surf, may carry on attrition of material and minor amounts of abrasion, but,
just as a stream during a single flood may do more geological work than it will for months or
years at low water stage, so can storm waves during a short period affect more change than
ordinary waves will in months. Factors that affect the rate and magnitude of sea waves’
erosion are:
The most important agent shaping coastal landforms is wave action. The energy of
waves is expended primarily in the constant churning of mineral particles and water as waves
break at the shore. This churning erodes shoreline materials, moving the shoreline landward.
The processes involved in marine erosion are; (i) corrosion, (ii) abrasion, (iii) attrition, (iv)
hydraulic action, and (v) shock pressure of breaking waves.
The major landforms produced by marine erosion are sea cliffs, wave-cut benches,
notches, cave, arch, stack and stump.
Sea Cliffs: Sea cliff is a very distinctive feature of marine erosion. It is a steep coastal
declivity which may or flay not be precipitous, the slope angle being dependent partly on
the jointing, bedding and hardness of the rock and partly on the erosional processes at
work. Where the wave attack is dominant, the cliff foot will be rapidly eroded and cliff
retreat will take place, especially in unconsolidated materials such as clays, sands, etc.
Near vertical cliffs can also be formed in well-jointed rocks. For example, solid massive
rocks, granite, basalt and old sandstone are cut back slowly and form steep cliffs,
standing out boldly as headlands. Less resistant rocks are more rapidly eroded to form
bays.
Sea cliffs are formed with the erosion of coastal rocks through the mechanisms of
hydraulic actions and abrasion by breaker waves (swash or surf currents). This results in the
formation of notch and the coast becomes vertical. There is gradual extension of notch
landward due to Continuous wave attack, with the result the crest of the cliff overhangs the
notch. If the notch at the base of the cliff is extended landward to such an extent that the
support to the cliff crest is weakened, the overhanging head of the cliff breaks and falls down
resulting into gradual recession of the cliff landward. The rate of cliff recession varies both in
space and time depending on the rock structure, vulnerability to chemical erosion, height of
the cliff, and orientation of the coast and wave energy (Fig. 4.31).
deposits them after some distance. In areas of hard rocks the surface of the wave-cut
platform consists of bare rock and is relatively flat, but where there is a deposit of
shingles, gravels and sand, the slope is concave.
Sea Caves: Sea cave is a natural cavity, chamber or recess which develops along the
coast due to gradual erosion of weak and strongly jointed rocks by uprushing breaker
waves (surf Currents). Sea waves are more frequently formed in carbonate rocks
(limestone and chalks) because they are eroded more by solutional processes. Sea
caves are, however, not permanent as they are destroyed in due course of time.
Sea Arch: Sea arch is a natural opening through a mass of rock limestone or boulder
clay. It is most commonly seen on the sea coast where waves have cut through a
promontory. When the keystone of the marine arch collapses, the feature will become
a stack.
Stack (Needles, Columns, Pillars, Skerries): Stack is an isolated rock monolith or
pillar rising steeply from the sea. It was formerly part of the adjoining land but has
become isolated from it by wave erosion, probably after having formed part of a
marine arch. The Old Man of Hoy (137 metres) in the Orkney Island of Scotland is a
spectacular example of stack.
Goes and Gloups: The occasional splashing of the waves against the roof of a cave
may enlarge the joints when compressed air is trapped inside. A natural shaft is thus
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 100 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
formed which may eventually pierce through to the surface. Such a shaft is termed a
gloup (form noise made by the water gurgling inside) or blow-hole. The enlargement
of blow-holes and the continued action of waves weakens the cave roof. Such deep
clefts, which may be 100 feet deep are called goes.
Sediment transported along the shore is deposited in areas of low wave energy and
produces a variety of landforms, including beaches, spits, tombolos, bars and barrier islands.
Different types of sediments are deposited along the coast. Sometimes, in the form of an
accumulation of unconsolidated materials (silt, sand, shingle, etc.) lying between the lowest
level of spring tides and the highest level reached by storm waves, which is known as sea
beach. A beach is generally located on a wave-cut platform of solid rock and is generally of a
low gradient with a gently concave platform. Beaches may extend for hundreds of
kilometres. Beaches are generally classified into: (i) sand beach, (ii) shingle beach, and (iii)
boulder beach.
Bar:
Bar is an elongated deposit of sand, shingle or mud, occurring in the sea, more or less
parallel to the shoreline and sometimes linked to it. Bars may be of submerged or emergent
embankments of sand and gravel built along the shore by waves and currents. One of the
most common type of bars is that known as spit. Spit is a narrow and elongated accumulation
of sand and shingle projecting into a large body of water (sea). It is a ridge or embankment of
sediment attached to the land at one end and terminating in open water (sea) at the other. It
grows out from a coastline as a result of longshore drift, often at a location where the line 0f
the coast changes direction, as at the mouth of an estuary where spits are common.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 101 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Connecting bars are formed when bars are so extended that they either join two
headlands or islands. When a bar connects the mainland with an island, it is known as
tombolo 22.7).
Spits: A sand bar projecting from the mainland into open water. sediment moved by
longshore drift.
Beaches: A beach is a shore build of unconsolidated sediment. Sand is the most common
material, but some beaches are composed of cobbles and boulders and others of silt and
clay.
Tombolos: A beach or bar connecting an island to the mainland. It forms because the
island creates a wave shadow zone along the coast, in which longshore drift cannot occur.
Barrier Islands: Barrier islands are long, offshore islands of sediments, tending parallel
to the shore. Almost invariably, they form long shorelines adjacent to gently sloping
coastal plains, and they typically are separated from the mainland by a lagoon. Most
barrier islands are cut by one or more tidal inlets.
Figure 4.34: Formation of hook. connecting bar, bay bar and tombolo
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 102 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 4.35: Primary Coasts - produced by non-marine processes, e.g. rivers and
glaciers (after W.K. Hamblin et al.)
Water that occupies pores, cavities, cracks and other spaces in the crustal rocks is
known as groundwater, subsuface water or underground water. It includes water precipitated
from the atmosphere which has percolated through the soil (meteoric water), water that has
risen from deep magmatic sources, liberated during igneous activity (magmatic or juvenile
water), and fossil water retained in sedimentary rocks since their formation (connate water).
Some underground water may also be derived from the percolation of oceanic water,
especially in the coastal areas. The presence of groundwater is necessary for virtually all
weathering processes to operate. The slow moving underground water can dissolve huge
quantities of soluble rocks and carry them away in solution. In some areas, it is the dominant
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 103 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
agent of erosion and produces karst topography, which is charactensed by sink holes,
subsidence depressions, collapsed caverns, solution valleys and disappearing streams.
The water moves in the ground is proved by the direct and indirect evidences. For
example, wells are pumped dry, yet soon re-fill with water. Strong flows of water through
fractures in rocks are frequently encountered in mine and railroad tunnels. Underground
rivers have been discovered in great caverns. Water may move very long distances
underground. Except for the water that flows in such openings as fissures or caverns, the
movement of groundwater is very slow.
Both through its mechanical and chemical work, groundwater profoundly alters the
surface of the land. While neither activity is as widespread as are some other physiographic
agents, the total results are very great, especially in humid regions where the amount of water
in the ground is relatively more. As stated above, groundwater is capable of accomplishing
erosion on an enormous scale, but unlike streams, groundwater erodes only by dissolving
soluble rocks such as limestone, rock-salt, and gypsum. It then transports the dissolved
mineral matter and discharges it into other parts of the hydrologic system or deposits it in the
pore spaces within the rock. Groundwater erosion starts with water percolating through
joints, faults, and bedding planes and dissolving the soluble rock. in time, the fractures
enlarge to form a subterranean network of caves that can extend for many kilometres. The
caves grow larger until ultimately the roof collapses, and a crater-like depression, or sinkhole
is produced. Solution activity then enlarges the sinkhole to form a solution valley, which
continues to grow until the soluble rock is removed completely.
There are five conditions which contribute to the maximum development of karst
landform. These are:
1. There must be present at or near the surface a soluble rock, preferably limestone. The
limestone must be massive, thickly bedded, hard, tenacious and well cemented.
2. The soluble rock should be dense, highly jointed, and preferably thinly bedded.
3. The third condition which favours an excellent development of karst is the existence
of entrenched valleys below uplands underlain by soluble and well-jointed rocks. This
favours ready downward movement of groundwater through the rock.
4. Karst topography is largely restricted to humid and temperate climatic zones. In
desert regions, where little rain falls, extensive karst topography will not develop.
5. The region must be one of at least moderate rainfall. In general, arid and semi-arid
regions do not exhibit marked development of karst. It is significant that nearly all the
notable karst regions of the world are in the areas of moderate to abundant rainfall.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 104 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The work of underground water is important in the areas of limestone rocks where it
gives rise to distinctive landforms. Like running water, underground water also erodes,
transports and deposits.
Slow moving ground water can dissolve huge quantities of soluble rocks and carry it
away in solution. In some areas, it is the dominant agent of erosion and produces Karst
topography, which is characterized by sinkholes, solution valleys, and disappearing streams.
The evolution of Karst topography is shown in fig. 4.36. Initially, water follows surface
drainage until a large river cuts a deep valley below the limestone layer. Groundwater then
moves through joints and emerges at river banks. With the passage of time the water emerges
at the river banks. Finally, the roofs of the caves collapse so numerous sinkholes are
produced. This process ultimately develops solution valleys. Most of the original surface is
finally dissolved. The following are the unique erosional landforms of a karst region:
Karren: ‘Karren’ is a German term initially used to describe minor and major
solution furrows or funnels cut by surface water (groundwater) into limestone. Now,
the term is used for highly corrugated and rough surface of limestone lithology,
characterised by low ridges and pinnacles, narrow clefts and numerous solution holes.
In French, it is called as lopies.
Sinkhole: A funnel-shaped or cylindrical-shaped hole, depression, or sink in the
ground surface of a limestone or chalk terrain. It is equivalent to a ponor of karst
country. It is usually dry or exhibits only minor seepage of surface water and should
be distinguished from a swallet, which marks the disappearance of a surface stream.
A sinkhole is formed by subterranean collapse of a cave system or by surface
solution. The depth of the sinkhole varies from a few centimetres to about 10 metres.
Some swallow holes are further enlarged due to continuous solution into larger
depressions which are called dolines.
Caverns (Caves): Caverns or caves are also one of the important characteristic
features of groundwater in limestone regions. Caverns are formed in several different
ways. The rocks in which most caves occur are salt, gypsum, dolomite and limestone,
with the latter by far the most important.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 105 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Groundwater charged with carbon dioxide and other chemicals seeps along
stratification and joint planes or other cracks in the rock, and slowly dissolves the soluble
rocks. Wholly stagnant groundwater soon become saturated with minerals and loses its
effectiveness in the cave-making process. It is, therefore, necessary that there should be such
a condition of underground drainage that the saturated water can move away with its
chemical load and be replaced with a new supply of water which is capable of continuing the
solvent action. The underground drainage is most effective above the water table, but there is
abundant evidence of groundwater movement well below this table.
As the solvent action goes on, the caves continue to grow, usually they are irregular
in size and shape. Some are huge rooms, others are vast labyrinths of intricate branching
passages. In some caves there are pools of standing water, in others, there are large streams
of moving water. The Holloch cave with a length of 85 km is the longest cave in the world,
followed by Fint Ridge cave (81 km) and Mammoth cave (72 km) of Kentucky (USA).
Terra Rossa: When rainwater dissolves part of surface rock and enters the sub-surface,
particles of red clay soil are deposited on the surface as well as in the opened joints. This
is called terra rossa which resembles to lateritic soil. It may not be present at steep slopes
but can be seen in areas which are either flat or have gentle slope. Sometimes it may be
several metres thick and may entirely cover the rocky surface.
Karst Window: Karst is formed due to collapse of upper surface of sinkholes or dolines.
These windows enable the researchers and geomorphologists to observe sub-surface
drainage and other features formed below the ground surface.
Uvala: A large surface depression (several km in diameter) in limestone terrain (karst
region) is known as uvala. It is formed by the coalescence of adjoining dolines. It has an
irregular floor which is not as smooth as that of poije.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 106 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Polje: Polje is a large depression in a karst region with steep sides and a flat floor. If it is
drained by surface water soup it is termed as open polje, but if it drains by means of
swallow holes, it is a closed polje. The depression is thought to have been formed by the
coalescence of collapsed cave systems. Its floor is generally covered with alluvium. The
Livno polje of the Balkan region of Europe is 64 km long and 5-11 km wide. In Croatia,
Serbia and Bosnia-Herzegovina, cultivation on account of flat surface and easy
availability of water.
Figure 4.38: Idealized diagram of cave deposits- stalactites, stalagmites and columns
Swallet or Swallow Hole: The point at which a surface stream disappears u,hderground
in a limestone (karst) terrain prior to commencing its underground journey is known as a
swailet). In France, it is called as embut.
Sinking Creek: The surface of the karst plain looks like a sieve because of numerous,
closely spaced sinkholes. When surface water disappears through numerous sinkholes
located in a line, the resultant feature is called sinking creek.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 107 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Natural Bridge: Natural bridge is an erosional feature in karst topography. They are
formed either due to the collapse of the roofs of caves or clue to the disappearance of
surface streams as subterranean streams.
Figure 4.39: Karst topography (after W.K. Hambtin, et al., pp. 342-43)
Depositional Landforms
Stalactites: Stalactites are icicle-like forms that hang from the roofs of caves. In other
words, a tapering pendant of concretionary material descending from a cave ceiling,
created by the re-precipitation of carbonate in calcite form percolating groundwater is
known as a stalactite.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 108 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
4.9 CONCLUSION
By concluding it can be said that the external forces, which are working on earth’s
surface form time to time to wear away the surface, and the interaction of these constructive
and destructive forces gives rise to the great diversity of present day landforms.
4.10 SUMMARY
The unit 4, consist the denudation processes in details, which carried out in different
phases. It explains the weathering, which is gradual disintegration of rocks by atmosphere or
weather forces. Second deals with erosion process by different agents working differently on
earth’s surface for lowering and leveling out it. It’s very active process wearing away of the
earth’s surface by moving agents like running water, glaciers and waves. Besides this
transportation and deposition are also very important phases for development of landforms in
any area. The removal of eroded materials in the new area and the dumping of the debris in
certain part of the earth create many new and outstanding features (landforms). All the
landforms developed by various agents are dealt in the unit with details.
4.11 GLOSSARY
Weathering- To change or make something change in appearance because of the
effect of the sun, air or wind.
Erosion- The process by which the surface of the earth is worn away by the action of
water, glaciers, winds, waves etc.
Landforms- A natural feature of the earth’s surface.
4.13 REFERENCES
1) Brookfield, M.E. and T.S. Ahlbrandt, 1983, Eoiian Sediments and Process, New
York, Elsevier.
2) Christopherson, R.W., 1995, Elemental Geosystems: A Foundation in Physical
Geography, Englewood Cliffs, Prentice Hall.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 109 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
3) Goh Cheng. L., (1974), Certificate Physical and Human Geography. Oxford
University Press, New Delhi
4) Hamblin, W.K., 1995, Earth’s Dynamic Systems, Englewood Cliffs, Prentice Hall
5) Husain, M (2013). Fundamentals of Physical Geography. Rawat Publication. Jaipur
6) Oliver, J.E., 1979, Physical Geography, Massachusetts, Duxbury Press.
7) Sharp, R.P., 1992, Living Ice, New York, Cambridge University Press.
8) Singh, S (2013). Geomorphology. Prayag Prakashan, Allahabad
9) Strahier, A., 1997, Physical Geography, New York, Wiley.
10) Tarbuck, E.J. et al., 1976, Earth Science, Ohio, Charles E Merril.
11) Thornbury, W.D., 1998, Principles of Geomorphology, New Delhi, New Age
International Press.
UNIT 4 - WEATHERING, EROSION & ASSOCIATED LANDFORMS Page 110 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
BLOCK 2 : ATMOSPHERE
5.1 OBJECTIVES
5.2 INTRODUCTION
5.3 OVERVIEW OF THE EARTH’S ATMOSPHERE
5.4 COMPOSITION OF THE ATMOSPHERE
5.5 MASS OF THE ATMOSPHERE
5.6 VERTICAL STRUCTURE OF THE ATMOSPHERE
5.7 LAYERS OF THE ATMOSPHERE
5.7.1 TROPOSPHERE
5.7.2 STRATOSPHERE
5.7.3 MESOSPHERE
5.7.4 THERMOSPHERE
5.7.5 IONOSPHERE
5.8 CHEMICAL COMPOSITION OF THE ATMOSPHERE
5.9 CONCLUSION
5.10 SUMMARY
5.11 GLOSSARY
5.12 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
5.13 REFERENCES
5.14 SUGGESTED READINGS
5.15 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
5.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, you should be able to understand the:
5.2 INTRODUCTION
In earth’s atmosphere consists of air a mixture of various gases surrounding the earth
to a height of many kilometers. In the other words we can say that the earth is surrounded by
an ocean of air. This ocean of air is hanging under the pull of earth’s gravitational force. It
has a thickness of more than thousands of kilometers above from the earth surface. This thick
extensive envelop of gas around the earth is called as atmosphere. Due to the presence of the
atmosphere the earth is a unique planet in which life is found.
1. Atmosphere provides the life of both animals and plant species on the earth surface
because it contains oxygen for man and animals and carbon-di-oxide for the plants.
2. It protects earth from the ultra-violet rays which are very harmful to the plants and
animals on the earth surface. The ozone gas (O3) in the atmosphere absorbs these rays
and save the earth from the danger of them.
3. It also controls the flow of energy from sun to the earth and from the earth to the
space and regulates the temperature on the earth surface.
4. It is the storehouse of water vapours which produce condensation and precipitation on
the land and water surface of the earth.
5. It is very useful for the development of communication system through electronic
media. Radio-waves transmitted from earth surface, reflect back from the ionosphere
in the atmosphere.
Dry Air: The earth’s atmosphere is made of different kinds of gases. Nitrogen, Oxygen and
CO2 are the important gases which are found in their uniform or stable proportion with in the
lower layer of the earth’s surface. Important gases of dry air are described below:
Nitrogen: In the earth’s atmosphere Nitrogen (N2) is very important consistent. It accounts
for about 78.08 percent of total volume of dry air. Nitrogen gas works as a diluent and
neutralizes the combustion phenomena in the atmosphere by diluting the oxygen. It is also
used by plants and trees to make protein which is very useful for their growth but plants
cannot make use of free Nitrogen. They use Nitrogen in the form of a compound. The
lightning combines Oxygen with Nitrogen and the compounds so formed are swept down to
the Earth’s surface by rainfall. These Nitrogen, compounds act with soil chemicals and enter
the bodies of plants and form their bodies. Green vegetation cannot be green without
nitrogen. Nitrogen is also called the base of life because the smallest living organism (living
cell) contains Nitrogen in its protoplasm.
Oxygen: This gas is the second important constituent of the atmosphere. It accounts for
about 21 percent of the volume of dry air. The Presence of this gas in the atmosphere is very
useful. Man and animals inhale Oxygen and exhale the Carbon-di-oxide. In the absence of
Oxygen the survival of life on the earth surface is impossible. This gas is essential for
burning, when substances react sharply, they are called burning. Human body also depends
upon Oxygen. The body cells burns in oxygen to produce heat for the body. This process is
called breathing . Many small organisms which are present in the soil and are so small that
they are visible only under microscope cannot live without Oxygen and without these
microscopic organisms the whole of the organic world will be disbalanced.
When the Earth was in her initial stage of formation carbon-di-oxide was the major
component of the gases. There were no reserves of coal and graphite in the earth because
carbon the main component of coal, petroleum etc., was in the form of carbon-di-oxide. Due
to the evolution of plants, the ratio of carbon-di-oxide got reduced gradually. But, after
industrialization, urbanization and heavy amount of deforestation have been the important
agents of add CO2 in the atmosphere. CO2 is increasing at tremendous rate in the atmosphere.
From 1890 to 1990 CO2 has increased more than 10 times. Rising of its content in the
atmosphere will cause global warming through greenhouse effect.
Ozone: Ozone (O3) is very small constituent of dry air in the atmosphere of this planet. It
accounts for only 0.00006 percent of volume of dry air. It is formed from Oxygen (O 2) by
chemical reactions that absorb ultra-violet radiation, thus sheltering the elevation between
19to 35 km above the earth surface. This organism of the Earth’s surface from the damaging
effects of Ultra-Violet rays. Ozone lies at the zone is known as Ozonosphere. It is very useful
gas for life on the earth. It absorbs the ultra-violet rays and protects us from sun burns. In the
absence of this valuable gas, the ultra-violet radiations will reach the earth surface. Ozone
layer protects the Earth’s surface from this damaging form of radiation. If solar ultra-violet
radiation will to reach the Earth’s surface at full intensity, bacteria exposed on the Earth’s
surface would be destroyed and unprotected. Animal tissues would be severely destroyed.
The presence of this layer is thus essential to maintaining a viable environment for life on the
earth.
Moreover, study reveals that the ozone layer is depleting due to release of nitrogen
oxide from supersonic jet planes and CFC (Chloro-floro carbon) from refrigerator industries.
This depletion in the amount of ozone gas has resulted in blood cancer, cataract etc. diseases
in developed countries like USA, Canada and Germany etc.
Water vapour: Another important component of the atmosphere is water vapour, the
gaseous form of water. It is variable element and closed to the earth surface. Due to
insolation of the sun, the water of ocean, seas, lakes, rivers etc. go on evaporation into water
vapour. This water vapour later on, condenses into rainfall and falls on the earth surface.
Most of the water thus, received by the earth reaches the ocean. This cycle of water-vapour is
very important for human life. The content of water vapour varies from as little as 0.02 per
cent of air in desert environment to over 4 percent in the humid tropics. It is the source of all
types of condensation like snow, fogs, clouds, mist etc. and precipitation on the earth surface.
It directly determines the type (rain, hail, sleet) and amount of precipitation. It is regulator of
the heat on the earth surface. Water vapour is also the source of energy which helps in
hearting the atmosphere to some extent. After the condensation of vapour latent heat is
released in the atmosphere. This latent heat is also steering the turbulence in the atmosphere
and it also affects the rate of cooling of the human body and the amount of vapour in the
atmosphere is inversely related with the rate of cooling effect of body.
Dust Particles: Dust Particles are also very useful constituents of the earth’s atmosphere.
These dust particles are added in the atmosphere by cyclonic storms, volcanic activity,
breaking of salt along the sea coast, ploughing of land and so on. The presence of dust
particles in the atmosphere is very essential and affects the weather conditions. Dust particles
scatter the radiation from the sun in the atmosphere. The varied colours i.e. red and orange at
sun set and sunrise in only due to scattering of selective sunlight’s. The blue colour of sky is
attributed to the scattering of blue light in the atmosphere. Dust particles are in large numbers
in dry desert environment and lower in humid environment. In the absence of dust particles,
there would have been not formed precipitation for and snow on the earth surface.
The atmosphere may be divided into different roughly concentrating layers. The
layers may be demarcated on the basis of temperature, air pressure and ionization and
chemical properties of the air.
Source: Google
5.7.1 Troposphere
Troposphere is derived from Greek words Tropein (turning or rotating) and spheurous
(sphere). It is the lowest atmospheric layer, in which temperature decreases with increasing
elevation. It is closest to the earth surface. Since almost all human activity occurs in this
layer, it is of primary important to us. Everyday weather phenomena, such as clouds or
storms, occur mainly in the troposphere. The height of this layer is variable from equator to
poles and from season to season. At the equator, it has maximum (16 Km) height and at poles
it is lowest about 6 kms. The maximum height at the equator is due to convectional
movement of the air currents. Similarly, its altitude in summer season is higher than in the
winter season.
The very important feature of the troposphere is that it contains significant amounts
of water vapour. When the water vapour content is high, vapour can condense into water
droplets, forming low clouds and fog or the vapour can be deposited as ice crystals, forming
high clouds. When condensation or deposition is rapid rain, snow, hail or sleet- collectively
termed precipitation- may be produced and fall to earth surface. In desert regions where
water vapour is present only in small amounts, precipitation is infrequent. Water vapour and
dust particles are also confined to this atmosphere layer. Commercial aircrafts fly in this
layer near tropopause.
5.7.2 Stratosphere
This layer is the next important atmospheric strata over the troposphere. This zone of
separation is called as Tropopause. The stratosphere extends up to 50 km height from the sea
level.
In the lower part of this layer (up to 20km) temperature remains almost uniform and
winds are calm. In this layer, between 20 to 35 kms.,there is a zone in which ozone gas is
found abundantly, hence it is called ozone layer. The gas absorbs the ultra-violet rays of sun
and protects the earth surface from the burning. After 30km. altitude temperature starts to
increase with height due to presence of ozone layer. Weather elements like cloud formation,
storms and eddies, precipitation etc. are almost absent, but only horizontal movement of air
can be observed this layer. It is also the home of strong, persistent winds that blow from west
to east.
5.7.3 Mesosphere
Mesosphere is the third layer of atmosphere lies above the stratosphere. The former
layer is separated from latter by a narrow zone called Tropopause. This layer extends from 50
to 80 kms. above sea level. The main characteristic of this layer is that the temperature
decreases with altitude. It reaches up to – 800C at the upper limit 80 km of mesosphere. In
mesosphere, there is appearance of clouds in high latitudes region in summer season.
5.7.4 Thermosphere
Thermosphere is the biggest of all the layers of the earth’s atmosphere directly above
the mesosphere and directly below the exosphere. Within this layer, ultra-violet radiation
causes ionization. The International Space Station has a stable orbit within the middle of the
thermosphere, between 320 and 380 kms. Auroras also occur in the thermosphere. Named
from the Greek (Thermos) for heat, the thermosphere begins about 80kms above the earth. At
these high altitudes, the residual atmospheric gases sort into strata according to molecular
mass. Thermospheric temperature increase with altitude due to absorption of highly energetic
solar radiation by the small amount of residual oxygen still present. Temperatures are highly
dependent on solar activity and can rise to 15000C (2,7300F). Solar activity strongly
influences temperature in thermosphere.
5.7.5 Ionosphere
i- D-Layer – This layer lies between 60 to 99 km altitude. The main feature of this
layer is to reflect the low frequency radio-waves to the earth and to absorb the
medium and high frequency waves. It is disappears in the night because it is
associated with the sun shine.
ii- E-layer- This layer stretches between 99 to 130 km height above the D-layer. It
also appears with the sunrise because it is formed due to reaction between Ultra-
violet photon, nitrogen and nitrogen molecules.
iii- Sporadic E-layer- It is occurs occasionally and formed under special
condition. Very high frequency waves are reflected.
iv- E2 layer-This layer lies up to 150 km. It is formed by interaction between ultra-
violet photon and oxygen molecules. It is disappears after the sunset.
v- F-Layer- This layer overlies the E-layers and is known as Appleton layer. This
layer exists in night. F-layer is significant for long distance broadcasting
communication as it reflects medium and high frequency waves in both days and
nights. This layer is also divided into F1 and F2 layers. F1 extends between 145-
240 kms and F2 between 240-965 kms.
Atmospheric Composition
Notes: The concentration of CO2 and CH4 vary by season and location. The mean molecular
mass of air is 28.97g/mol.
5.9 CONCLUSION
Atmosphere is more important to human beings than any other part of the
environment. Man cannot live for more than a few minutes in the absence of air. It is
impossible to think of season or weather without the existence of atmosphere. In fact, even
the marine life is existing from this atmosphere.
5.10 SUMMARY
The atmosphere covers the Earth like a blanket 640 kms thick. In this chapter we discuss
about the origin and composition of the earth’s atmosphere in detail. Mass of the atmosphere
and vertical structure is also described very well. As we all know the atmosphere has great
thickness around the earth surface. The whole atmosphere is divided into different layers.
Every part, every layer and every particle which existing in the atmosphere is very important
and also plays a vital role for earth’s surface.
5.11 GLOSSARY
Chloro-fluorocarbons, CFCs : Chemical compounds which, although essentially stable at
ground level, undergo an exothermic photochemical reaction in the upper atmosphere,
releasing free chlorine radicals which break down ozone in the ozone layer; a reaction
potentially hazardous to human health.
Chlorophyll: The green substance in plants that takes in light from the sun to help them
grow.
Cataract: A white area that grows over the eye as a result of disease.
Condensation: The process of conversion of water vapours into water droplets or ice
crystals at the dew point is called as condensation, dew, fog, mist and clouds are difference
forms of condensation.
Deforestation: The complete clearance of forests by cutting and/or burning. Eddies (Eddy):
A roughly circular movement within a current of air, dust and water.
Precipitation: The falling of water droplets and ice crystals from the clouds under the effect
of gravitational force is termed as precipitation.
Photon: A unit of a certain type of energy (electromagnetic energy), for example light.
Photosynthesis: The Process by which green plants turn carbon-di-oxide and water into food
using energy from sunlight.
Microscope: A piece of equipment that makes very small objects looks big enough for you
to be able to see them.
Radar: A system that uses radio waves for finding the position of moving objects for
example ships and planes.
Satellites: An electronic device that is sent into space and moves around the earth or another
planet for a particular purpose, a weather/communication satellite.
5.13 REFERENCES
1. Barry, R.G. and Chorley, R.J. (1982), Atmosphere, Weather and Climate, Methuen,
London.
2. Batse, D.R. (1958), The Earth and its atmosphere, Basic Books, New York.
3. Critchfield, H. (1961), General Climatology, Prentice Hall, New York.
4. Das, P.K. (1968), The Monsoon, Arnold, London.
5. Gates, E.S. (1979), Meteorology and Climatology, George, H.Harrap & Co. Ltd. London.
6. Kellaway, G.P. (1957), A Background of Physical Geography, Macmillan and Co.,
London.
7. Khan Nizamuddin (2001), An Introduction to Physical Geography, Concept Publishing
Company, New Delhi.
8. Strahler A. and Strahler A. (2003), Introducing Physical Geography, John Wiley and
Sons, Inc.
9. Singh Savindra, (2004), Bhautik Bhoogol, Vasundhara Prakashan, Gorakhpur.
10. Tikka, R.N. (1994), Physical Geography, Kedar Nath Ram Nath and Co. Meerut.
2. What is the Atmosphere? Describe the structure and characteristics of various layers of the
atmosphere.
6.1 OBJECTIVE
6.2 INTRODUCTION
6.3 INSOLATION: MEANING AND CONCEPT
6.4 MECHANISM OF SOLAR RADIATION
6.5 DISTRIBUTION OF INSOLATION
6.6 FACTORS AFFECTING THE DISTRIBUTION OF
INSOLATION
6.7 HEAT BUDGET OF THE EARTH AND THE
ATMOSPHERE
6.7.1 NET RADIATION AND GLOBAL ENERGY
BALANCE.
6.8 HEATING AND COOLING OF ATMOSPHERE.
6.9 DISTRIBUTION OF TEMPERATURE.
6.9.1VERTICAL DISTRIBUTION OF TEMPERATURE.
6.9.2 HORIZONTAL DISTRIBUTION OF TEMPERATURE.
6.10 CONCLUSION
6.11 SUMMARY
6.12 GLOSSARY
6.13 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
6.14 REFERENCES
6.15 SUGGESTED READINGS
6.16 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
6.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this particular Unit, you would be able to understand the:
6.2 INTRODUCTION
We all know that the sun is the main source of energy for all the planets of the solar
system. A little heat is obtained from the interior parts of the Earth but it is significant. The
temperature of the surface of the sun is about 60000C. Sun radiates energy is huge amount
per second from its surface due to atomic fusion process. The earth is about 150,000,000 kms
away from the sun. Due to such long distance only minute fraction of solar energy reaches to
the earth surface. The energy which strikes with the earth is 1/20,000,000 part of energy
emitted by the sun’s surface. This insignificance amount of solar energy is responsible for
different kinds of physical, chemical and biological phenomena taking place on the earth
surface.
Ozone gas which is exist in ozonosphere absorbs these 35% of solar radiation is reflected
back by dust and clouds. Only 19% of the insolation is absorbed in the atmosphere. The
surface of the sea and the earth also reflect back 10% of insolation. It is therefore clear that
only 36% of the insolation reaches the Earth’s surface.
Insolation Spectrum
Wave-Length Length of wave Percentage of the total
(Smallest Waves) Energy
X-rays and Gamma Rays 1/2000 to 1/100 micron 9%
Ultra-violet Rays 0.2 to 0.4 micron
Visible Light Rays 0.4 to 0.7 micron 41%
Infra-red Rays (Longest 0.7 to 3.0 micron 50%
Waves)
Heat Rays 3.0 to 3,000 micron
Source: Dr. .N. Tikka, Physical Geography 1994-95.
Tropical zone intends between tropic of Cancers (23 ½ ON) and tropic of Capricorn
(23½OS). This zone receives maximum insolation due to the sun shines vertically twice a
year. Two maximum and two minimum amounts of insolation are received here due to
apparent movement of sun is northern and southern hemisphere according to the season.
Temperate zone lies between 23½O and 66½O in both hemisphere. Maximum insolation
is received once a year by every point of this zone on summer solstice (21 st June) in northern
hemisphere and on winter solstice (23rd September) in southern hemisphere. In this zone
there is no day is free from the sun shine. Seasonal variation in amount of insolation is
greater, while the minimum insolation occurs on winter solstice in northern hemisphere and
on summer solstice in southern hemisphere.
Polar zone extends between Arctic Circle (66½ON) and North Pole in northern
hemisphere and between Antarctic Circle (66 ½OS) and south poles in southern hemisphere.
This zone received maximum insolation in northern hemisphere on 21st June and 23rd
September in southern hemisphere. While the day of winter solstice in northern hemisphere
and day of summer solstice in southern hemisphere receive minimum insolation.
Table: 1: Distribution of Angle of Sun Rays on the Earth’s surface on Summer and Winter Solstice.
Angle between the rays of the sun Angle between rays of the sun at
at noon day and the surface of noon day and surface of the
Latitude the earth at summer solstice earth at the winter solstice Difference
The sun rays strike with the earth surface at sight angle, they cover small unit area
and the minimum area is heated and received insolation while the other hand when the sun
rays strike at acute angle, they cover relatively larger area and the intensity of heating is
rather lesser. Consequently, the amount of received insolation decreases.
Vertical rays have to pass through smaller passage than the inclined ones.
Atmosphere absorbs very little heat from the vertical than the inclined sun rays. It is why that
the days with a longer duration of sunlight in higher latitudes give less heat than those with
less duration of sunlight in lower latitudes. It is because the rays are more inclined in higher
than in lower latitudes.
The earth is inclined at an angle of 66½O at its orbital plane. Earth rotates around its
axis and revolves around the sun. The length of the days or duration of sun shine is not
uniform on every latitudes in a given time. On the equator days and nights are equal
throughout the year because the circle of illumination divides the equator into the equal parts
in all seasons. The circle of illumination passes through the two poles of the earth on March
21 and September 23. This creates day and night equal on these dates on the earth.
On June 21 the sun rays are vertical at 23½ON and the circle of illumination crosses
the North Pole and reaches 66 ½ON (Arctic Circle). On this day, all the places beyond 66
½ON will remain in sunlight. Therefore, the day will be of more than 24 hours.
24 hours duration of days occur on Arctic Circle and six months day on the North
Pole. Thus the length of days is longer on all latitudes in northern hemisphere during summer
while the nights are longer in the southern hemisphere during the same season. In winters
situation is totally reversed in both hemisphere.
At the equator, the sun rays are mostly vertical throughout the year. Hence days and
nights are usually of 12 hours duration each.
The duration of sunshine determine the amount of insolation it all the other conditions
are constant, therefore the higher latitude should have higher amount of insolation in summer
season in northern hemisphere. But the reality is exactly reversed. The slanting rays, which
fall in higher latitudes and snow capped surface, reduce the net amount of insolation received
by earth surface. In the lower latitudes amount of insolation received is greater due to
relatively vertical sun shine. Hence, the area of longer duration of days with vertical rays of
the sun receives maximum amount of insolation.
2. Atmospheric Transparency:
When atmosphere is free from the moisture, dust particles and clouds, the loss of
solar radiation through the atmosphere is lower due to low rate of reflection, scattering and
absorption of light in the atmosphere.
Insolation reached on the earth surface is relatively greater in the area of low moisture
and clear sky. For example, subtropical high pressure (20O_40O) latitude received greater
proportion of insolation due to low moisture and clear sky throughout the year.
The distance between the sun and the earth is not constant but goes on changing. The
orbit of the earth is in ecliptical form. The distance between these two changes from time to
time throughout the year. The mean distance between earth and sun is about 149 million km.
on July 4; maximum distance (152 million km.) is found between them this distance is
known as Aphelion. While, January 3 records minimum distance between the earth and sun.
This minimum distance is called Prehelion.
In the summer the month of July maximum insolation is received in the northern
hemisphere and minimum insolation is recorded in the southern hemisphere while in winters
the month of January maximum insolation is received in southern hemisphere and minimum
in the result of variation in angle of sun rays and the length of the days.
4. Sun Spots:
It is the minor factor to affecting the distribution of insolation on the earth surface.
The number of sun spots on the surface of the sun also influences the amount of insolation
reaches on the earth. Number of these spots changes every year. They are due to the internal
disturbances and explosion, in the sun’s surface. The amount of insolation is depend upon the
amount of insolation is depend upon the number of spots. Larger the number of sun spots,
higher the amount of insolation received on the earth surface and vice-versa.
Figure 6.2
Heat Budget
Here, the amount of insolation strikes the top of atmosphere is 100 units. Out of
which 27 units are reflected by clouds, 6 units are scattered and diffused by dust particles in
the atmosphere and 2 units are reflected back by earth surface as short wave to the space.
Thus 35 units of short wave radiation do not reach the earth surface and it is described as
Albedo of the earth. Albedo is an important property of a surface because it measures how
much incident solar energy will be absorbed. A surface with a high albedo such a snow or ice
(0.45 to 0.85) reflects much or most of the solar radiation and absorbs only a smaller amount.
A surface with a low albedo, such as black pavement (0.03), absorbs nearly all the incoming
solar energy. Besides, 14 units are absorbed by atmosphere. Only 51 units of short wave
radiations are received and absorbed by the earth surface. After the absorption of solar
radiation, the earth emits the energies in the form of long wave radiation. Out of 51 units
absorbed by earth 17 units are directly returned to the space, 19 units are used by water
vapour and 9 units are spent by convection and turbulence. Besides 6 units of long wave
radiation is directly absorbed by atmosphere, Thus 48 units of long wave radiation are
absorbed by atmosphere by one or other ways. Moreover, the radiation are absorbed by
atmosphere (14 short wave radiations – 48 long wave radiations) are finally returned to the
space and at last a balance is set in heat budget.
There is an important principle of physics that, except for nuclear reactions, energy is
neither created nor destroyed. It is therefore possible to follow the initial stream of solar
energy and account for its diversion into various system pathways and its conversion into
various energy forms. A full accounting of all the important energy flows among the sun,
atmosphere, earth surface and space forms the energy budget of the atmosphere and surface.
Solar energy is received by earth and because some of it is absorbed, the energy level
of earth tends to rise. Earth also radiates energy into outer space, this process that tends to
reduce the energy level of the earth. These incoming and outgoing radiation flows must
balance for the earth as a whole. However, incoming and outgoing flows do not have to
balance at any given surface location. At night there is no incoming radiation, yet the earth’s
surface and atmosphere still emit out going radiation.
Net radiation is the difference between all incoming radiation and all outgoing
radiation. Where radiant energy flows is faster than it flows out, net radiation is a positive
quantity in those places and providing an energy surplus. Where radiant energy is flowing
out faster than it is flowing in, net radiation is a negative quantity, yielding and energy
deficit.
At latitudes lower than 400 annual net radiations is positive, while it is negative at
higher latitudes. This imbalance creates pole ward heat transfer of latent and sensible heat in
the motions of warm water and moist warm air and thus provides the power that drives ocean
currents and broad scale atmospheric circulations patterns.
The long wave radiations are directly responsible for the hearting of the atmosphere.
The atmosphere is hearted from the earth surface temperature by these following processes
Radiation:
Radiation is very important process of heating of the atmosphere. In this process,
medium is not needed for the transmission of heat energy from one body to another. It can
transmit through vaccum of air. The upper part of the atmosphere is heated mainly by this
particular process. This process follows few principles given below –
Conduction:
In this process of transmission of heat, energy moves from particle to particle. This
process is continued unless the both ends of a body are heated equally. The lower layer of air
closed to earth surface is heated by conduction process. Upper portion of the atmosphere is
not affected by this process.
Convection:
Convection is also very efficient process of heating of upper air. It is a process in
which air is heated due to molecular movement of air. Earth surface is excessively heated by
this process and then heated air becomes lighter and move upward and the cold upper air
moves downward to take place of displaced hot air. Hence, the upper part of the atmosphere
is heated by this process.
There are two types of trends about the vertical distribution of temperature between
the earth and troposphere. They are: (i) Normal lapse of temperature, and (ii) inversion of
temperature.
Inversion of Temperature:
The temperature also increases with increasing height instead of decreasing
temperature due to some certain reasons. This kind of event is described as inversion of
temperature in meteorological field. On the basis of reasons involved for such types of
vertical distribution of temperature, inversion of temperature may be divided into following
types:
During long and cold night, clear sky and calm wind condition, the rate of long wave
radiation (terrestrial radiation) is rather faster, the earth and the lower layer of air is chilled
and temperature falls to considerable extent. While the temperature of the overlying air is
relatively higher and inversion of temperature happens lower and this type of inversion is
known as surface or radiational inversion.
When warm air mass moves into cold region the temperature of overlying air
becomes relatively higher than that of overlying air. The movement of cold air into warm
region also lowers the ground temperature and the air at higher level has higher temperature.
This type of inversion is known as Advectional inversion of temperature.
During the day time, the upper part of valley is heated up and low pressure is
developed there. When the bottom remains rather cooler and high pressure occurs then
mountain breeze move up the slope. While in the night, the upper slope of the valley is
chilled up and high pressure is occurs there. The bottom of the valley is relatively warmer
and low pressure region. Hence, cold heavy air moves down the valley slope to the bottom.
The warm air is displaced from the bottom to upper slope of the valley. Thus the upper slope
occurs high temperature than the and the inversion of temperature develops, this is called
valley inversion of temperature. This type of inversion is confined to the valley region.
6.10 CONCLUSION
Sun is the main source of energy for all planets of the solar system. The earth is
150,000,000 kms away from the sun but due to such long distance only minute fraction of
solar energy reaches to the earth surface. This energy is an important element for the life of
the earth. The energy emitted in the radiation by the sun is known as Insolation. Insolation
travel as a speed of 300,000 kms/ second from the sun and they reach in 8 minutes and 20
seconds on the earth surface. The amount of insolation is the product of various factors.
Insolation is maximum at equator and minimum at poles. There are three latitudinal zones of
insolation that is tropical, temperate and polar zones. There are various factors affecting the
distribution of insolation.
In this part of the study we discuss about net radiation and global energy balance in
short. Heating and cooling of atmosphere are processed by radiation, conduction, convection
and condensation.
6.11 SUMMARY
This unit describes the sun as the source of energy. Earth receives its energy and
reflected in the atmosphere. We understand the meaning, concept and distribution of
Insolation. Mechanism of solar radiation is also described. Angle of sun rays, length of the
days, atmospheric transparency, distance between the sun and the earth and sun spots are the
major factors affecting the distribution of insolation. Heat budget of the earth and the
atmosphere is also explained in upper written unit. Heat budget may be defined as the
balanced between incoming short wave radiation on the earth from the sun and outgoing
radiation from the earth surface. It may be classified as positive and negative.
Earth’s net radiation, sometimes called the flux, is the balance between incoming and
outgoing energy at the top of the atmosphere. It is the total energy that is available to
influence the climate. While global energy balance is describes as a sensitive one involving a
number of factors that determine how energy is transmitted and absorbed.
Distribution of temperature is also discussed in this unit. The degree of hotness of the
atmosphere and earth surface is described as temperature. The temperature distribution on the
earth is divided in two major types that one is vertical and second is horizontal distribution.
This unit described all the factors and components related to insolation, energy budget and
temperature etc.
6.12 GLOSSARY
Absorption : The process of a liquid, gas or other substance being taken in.
Aphelion: The position of the earth on its orbit when the maximum distance 152,000,000
km. is found between the sun and the earth.
Axis: A line we imagine through the middle of an object, around which the object turns or
rotate.
Centigrade: The name of a scale for measuring temperatures, in which water freezes at 0O
and boils at 100O.
Condensation: The process of conversion of water vapors into water droplets or ice crystals
at the dew point is called as Condensation. Dew, fog, mist and clouds are different forms of
condensation.
Conduction: The transfer of heat from one body to another through movement of heat from
one body to another through movement of heat from one particle to another. This process
continued until the both bodies get uniform temperature.
Convection: The process whereby heat is transferred from one past of a liquid or gas to
another, by movement of the fluid itself. Convection carries excess heat from the earth’s
surface and distributes it through the troposphere.
Conversion: The act or process of changing from one form, system or use to another.
Equator: The imaginary great circle around the world at latitude 0O. The equator is
equidistant between the North and South poles. It has a length of 40076 km.
Gamma Rays: Also gamma radiation. Rays that are sent out by some dangerous
(radioactive) substances.
Global Energy Balance: The difference between the total influx of solar radiation to the
earth’s surface and the loss of this energy via terrestrial radiation, evaporation and the
dissipation of sensible heat into the ground.
Heat Budget: Balance between the amount of incoming solar (short wave) radiation and
outgoing earth’s long wave (terrestrial) radiation.
Infrared Rays: Rays (used about light) that is produced by hot objects but cannot be seen.
Isotherm: An imaginary line drawn by connecting the places of equal temperature reduced
to sea level.
Latitude: Parallels of latitude are imaginary circles drawn round the earth parallel to the
equator.
Meteorology: The study of the character of the atmosphere and the events and processes
within it, together with the inter action between the atmosphere and the face of the earth.
Net Radiation: Also known as net radioactive balance, this is the balance of incoming solar
radiation and outgoing terrestrial radiation, which varies with latitude and season. Net
radiation is generally positive by day and negative by night.
Ocean Current: The flow of huge amount of water from tropical to polar and vice versa in a
definite direction.
Ozone Gas: A form of oxygen and an atmospheric trace gas, made by natural photo
chemical reaction associated with solar ultra-violet radiation. Ozone has three atoms of
oxygen combined in one molecule, rather than two atoms, as in free oxygen. The proportion
of ozone in the atmosphere is very small, but it is of vital importance in absorbing solar ultra
violet radiation.
Solstice: The time (21 June or 22 December) at which the overhead sun is furthest from the
equator and appears to stand still before returning towards the equator. The longest day
occurs at the summer solstice; the shortest day at the winter solstice.
Stratosphere: The second layer of atmosphere above the troposphere. Temperature increases
with height. It extends from tropopause to 50 kms height from sea level.
Sub–tropical: The term is used loosely to refer either to regions which experience some
features of tropical meteorology during part of the year, or to regions of near – tropical
climate.
Other side those areas lying between the Tropic of Cancer and 40ON and the Tropic
of Capricorn and 40OS.
Sunspots: A dark patch on the surface of the Sun. Sunspots usually occur in cluster and last
about two weeks. It has been suggested that the sun is 1% cooler when it has no spots ant that
this variations in solar radiation night affect the climates of the earth.
Terrestrial Radiations: The heat radiated from the earth. Short wave solar radiation
reaching the earth does not heat the atmosphere it passes through but does not heat the
atmosphere it passes through but does heat the earth’s surface. In turn, and particularly on
clear nights, much of this heat is radiated out from the earth. The earth also absorbs terrestrial
radiation reflected from the overlying opaque atmospheric layer.
Troposphere: The lowest layer of the atmosphere in which different kinds of weather
phenomena are confined. It is the closest to the earth. Temperature decreases with altitude at
the normal laps rate of 6.5OC/km.
Ultra Violet: Radiation (rays) with wavelength from 0.2 to 0.4 micrometers.
Weather: The average conditions of weather elements of shorter period and smaller area.
X-Rays: A kind of light that makes it possible to see inside solid objects.
6.14 REFERENCES
1. Barry, R.G. and Chorley, R.J.(1982), Atmosphere, Weather and climate, Methuen,
London.
2. Critchfield, H. (1961), General Climatology, Prentice Hall, New York.
3. Das, P.K. (1968), The Monsoon, Arnold, London.
4. Gates, E.S. (1979), Meteorology and Climatology, George, H. Harrap & Co., Ltd.,
London.
5. Koeppe, C.E. and Delong, G.C.(1958), Weather and Climate, Mc-graw Hill Book Co.,
New York.
6. Khan Nizamuddin(2001), An Introduction to Physical Geography, Concept Publishing
Company, New Delhi.
7. Trewartha, G.T. (1954), an Introduction to Climate, Mc-Graw Hill Book, New York.
8. Strahler Alan, Strahler Arthur (2003), Introducing Physical Geography, John Wiley 2
Sons, Inc.
9. Tikka, R.N. (1994), Physical Geography, Kedar Nath Ram Nath & Co., Meerut.
7.1 OBJECTIVES
7.2 INTRODUCTION
7.3 ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE: MEANING AND CONCEPT
7.4 HORIZONTAL DISTRIBUTION OF AIR PRESSURE AND
PRESSURE BELT
7.4.1 EQUATORIAL LOW PRESSURE BELT
7.4.2. SUB-TROPICAL HIGH PRESSURE BELT
7.4.3 SUB – POLAR LOW PRESSURE BELT
7.4.4 POLAR HIGH PRESSURE BELT
7.5 SHIFTING OF PRESSURE BELTS
7.6 WIND: THE CONCEPT
7.7 CLASSIFICATION OF WINDS AND THEIR DISTRIBUTION
7.7.1 TROPICAL WINDS
7.7.1.1 DOLDRUM AND EQUATORIAL WESTERLIES
7.7.1.2 INTER-TROPICAL CONVERGENCE (ITC)
7.7.1.3 TRADE WINDS
7.7.2 MID-LATITUDE WIND
7.7.2.1 HORSE LATITUDE
7.7.2.2 WESTERLIES
7.7.3 POLAR WINDS
7.8 SEASONAL SHIFTING OF WIND BELTS AND THEIR
CLIMATIC SIGNIFICANCE
7.9 TRICELLULAR MERIDIONAL CIRCULATION OF THE
ATMOSPHERE
7.10 MONSOON WINDS
7.11 LOCAL WINDS
7.12 JET STREAM
7.13 HUMIDITY: THE CONCEPT
7.14 RAINFALL
7.15 TYPES OF RAINFALL
7.16 WORLD DISTRIBUTION PATTERN OF PRECIPITATION
7.17 CONCLUSION
7.18 SUMMARY
7.19 GLOSSARY
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 138 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
7.1 OBJECTIVES
You should have learnt by now:
The meaning atmospheric pressure and horizontal distribution of air pressure and
pressure belt.
Different pressure belts, winds and its types with world distribution.
Humidity and types of rainfall.
World distribution of rainfall.
7.2 INTRODUCTION
An atmosphere derived from Greek word atmospa, atmos meaning ‘vapour’and pa
meaning ‘sphere’ is a layer of gasses surrounding the earth or other material body that is held
in place by the gravity of that body. It is subject to high if the temperature of atmosphere low.
Thus surrounding the earth in eachlatitude, over land and sea, is a gaseous envelops which is
spoken of as the air or the atmosphere. Its presence when at rest is unperceived, though when
moving it becomes apparent, since it imparts its motion to leaves and other bodies free to
move.
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 139 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 140 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
pressure belt. Thus, this low pressure belt is dynamically produced, the surface air spreads
outward from this zone due to rotation of the earth and low pressure is caused. It may be
pointed out that this factor should be more effective at the poles but the effects of the rotation
is neglected due to exceptionally low temperature prevailing throughout the year at the poles
.The sub–polar low pressure belt is more developed and regular in the southern hemisphere
while it is broken in the northern hemisphere because of over dominance of water (oceans) in
the southern. It may be noted that due to great contrasts of temperature of the continents and
oceans during northern summer the low pressure belt becomes discontinuous and is found in
a few low pressure cells while the temperature contrast between the continents and oceans is
much reduced during winter and hence low pressure belt becomes more or less regular and
continuous in the northern hemisphere.
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 141 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
place to place and since air naturally moves for readjustment of pressure. Thus, if the
difference of pressure is same so the winds are permanent here throughout the year. They are
periodic if the pressure differences only arise at definite intervals. Variable in pressure
disturbances which may ensure from local peculiarities of situation or from any other cause.
Thus the general effect of unequal isolation, effect of the extra-tropical belt of high pressure,
unequal heating of land and water and atmospheric disturbances are few important causes for
birth of wind.
ITCZ, known by sailors as the doldrums, is the area encircling the earth near the
equator where the northeast and southeast trade winds converge. The ITCZ was originally
identified from the 1920s to the 1940s as the ”Intertropical Front” (ITF), but after the
recognition in the 1940s and 1950s of the significance of wind field convergence in tropical
weather production, the term “ITCZ” was then applied. When the ITCZ is drawn into and
merges with a monsoonal circulation, it is sometimes referred to as a monsoon trough, a
usage more common in Australlia and parts of Asia. According to Seaman the zone is
referred to as the doldrums because of its erratic weather patterns with stagnant calms and
violent thunderstorms. The ITCZ is effectively a tracer of the ascending branch of the Hadley
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 142 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
cell, and is wet. The northern and southern boundaries of ITC are called NITC and SITC
respectively.
There is more or less regular inflow of winds from subtropical high pressure belts to
equatorial low pressure belt. These tropical winds have north-easterly direction in the
northern hemisphere while they are south-easterly in the southern hemisphere. These winds
are called trade winds because of the fact that they helped the sea merchants in sailing their
ships as their direction remains more or less constant and regular. According to Farrel’s law
trade winds are deflected to the right in the northern hemisphere and to the left in the
southern hemisphere. There are much variations in the weather conditions in the different
parts of trade winds.
The dynamically induced subtropical high pressure belt extends between 300- 350
latitudes in both the hemispheres. Thus, this belt separates two wind systems viz. trade winds
and westerlies. It is also apparent that the subtropical high pressure belt is the source for the
origin of trade winds and westerlies because winds always blow from high pressure to low
pressure. The air after being heated near the equator ascends and after blowing in opposite
direction to the surface trade winds descends in the latitudinal zone of 30 0- 350 . Thus, the
descent of winds from above causes high pressure on the surface which in turn causes
anticyclonic conditions. This is why the anticyclonic conditions cause atmospheric stability,
dry condition and very weak air circulation. Thus, this zone is characterized by weak and
variable winds and calm. This belt of calm is very popularly known as horse latitudes
because of the fact that in ancient times the merchants had to throw away some of the horses
being carried in the ships inorder to lessen the weight so that the ships could be sailed
through the calm conditions of these latitudes. Anticyclones are produced due to subsidence
of air currents in the horce latitudes. These anticyclones are known as ‘subtropical
anticyclones.
7.7.2.2 Westerlies
Westerlies is known as mid-latitude winds. These are the permanent winds blowing
from the subtropical high pressure belts to the subpolar low pressure belts (600-650)in both
the hemispheres are called westerlies. The general direction of the westerlies is S.W to N.E in
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 143 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
the northern hemisphere and N.W to S.E in the sourthern hemisphere. There is much
variation in the weather conditions in their poleward parts where there is convergence of cold
and denser polar winds and warms and lighter westerlies. The general characteristic features
of the westerlies are largely modified due to cyclones and anticyclones associated with them.
Because of the dominance of land in the northern hemisphere the westerlies become more
complex and complicated and become less effective during summer seasons and more
vigorous during winter season. They brings good precipitation in the western parts of the
continents as they pick up plenty amount of moisture while passing over the vast stretches of
the oceans. The velocity of the westerlies becomes so great that they are called roaring forties
between the latitudes of 400-500S, furious fifties at 500S latitude and shriecking sixties at 600
S latitude.
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 144 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 145 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Properties
1- Generally, their circulation is observed between poles and 200 latitudes in both the
hemispheres. These are also called circum-polar whirl because these move around the
poles in both the hemispheres.
2- There is seasonal change in the wind velocity in jet streams wherein these become strong
during winter season and the wind velocity becomes twice the velocity during summer
season. Maximum wind velocity is 480 km (per hour).
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 146 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Humidity Capacity - The moisture content (humidity) of the air is measured in grain per
cubic foot or in gram per cubic centimeter. Humidity capacity becomes higher during
summer months than during winter months and during daytime than nights. Humidity
capacity decreases from equator to poleward.
Absolute Humidity - The total weight of moisture content (water vapour) per volume of the
air at definite temperature is called absolute humidity.
Relative Humidity- It is also defined as a ratio of the amount of water vapour a actually
present in the air having definite volume and temperature to the maximum amount the air can
hold (i.e. humidity capacity). Generally it is expressed in percentage. It decreases with
increasing temperature and increases with decreasing temperature.
7.14 RAINFALL
Rainfall results from clouds when condensation has gone on for a sufficiently long
time, or when the cloud has been pushed up sufficiently high to enable the formation of big
drops of water, the drops fall from the clouds as rain. The Rain gauge is an equipment to
measure the amount of rain. It is the most common form of precipitation.
Orographic rainfall - Occurring due to ascent of air forced by mountain barrier. The rainfall
that takes place at the foot hills of the Himalayas in India, is of such type.
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 147 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Man – induced rainfall. It is also known as artificial rainfall and pluviculture. It is the act of
attempting to artificially induce or increase precipitation, usually to stave off drought and to
increase reservoir irrigation water or water supply capacity, or to increase water levels for
power generation.
Mean annual rainfall for the whole globe is 970 mm but this means annual amount is
unevenly distributed on the earth’s surface. Some places receives less than 100 mm of means
annual rainfall (for example, tropical hot deserts like Sahara, thar, Atacama, Kalahari etc.)
while some places receives more than 12000 mm of annual rainfall (e.g. Cherrapunji of
India). Not only this, there is much temporal variation of annual rainfall in a particular area.
Most of the annual amount of rainfall is received during a few months of the year while most
of the months either remain dry or receive little rainfall. For example, 12000 mm of rainfall
at Cherrapunji is received only in 159 days. The equatorial regions receive rainfall
throughout the year but other areas are characterized by seasonal rainfall. For example, more
than 80 per cent of annual rainfall in India is received during 3 wet summer monsoon months
(July, August and September). On the other hand, the Mediterranean regions receive most of
their annual rainfall during winter months while summer season remains dry. Since air
moisture depends upon temperature and horizontal distribution of temperature is found in
zonal patterns and hence rainfall distribution is also characterized by zonal pattern. Based on
above considerations, 6 major zones of rainfall distribution are identified on the earth’s
surface.
Equatorial zone of maximum rainfall - This zone extends up to 100 latitudes on either side
of the equator and falls within intertropical convergence characterized by warm and moist air
masses .The mean annual rainfall ranges between 1750 mm and 2000 mm. Most of the rains
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 148 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
are received through convectional rainfall accompanied by lighting and cloud thunder. There
is daily rainfall in the afternoon. The rainfall intensity is very high as it occurs in form of
heavy showers. .
Trade wind rainfall zone - extends between 100-200 latitude in both the hemisphere and is
characterized by north- east and south – east trade winds. These winds yield rainfall in the
eastern parts of the continents because they come from over the oceans and hence pick up
sufficient moisture but as they move westward in the continents they become extremely dry
and deserts. The monsoon region located in this zone receives much rainfall. Summers
receive most of the mean annual rainfall.
Subtropical zone of minimum rainfall - extends between 200 and 300 latitudes in both the
hemispheres, where descending air from above induced high pressure and winds diverge in
opposite direction at the ground surface, with the result anti-cyclones are formed. This
condition is not conducive for rainfall and hence dry condition prevails over large areas.
Mean annual rainfall is 900mm. It may be pointed out that the entire tropical hot desert are
located in this zone where mean annual rainfall is below 250mm. The average annual rainfall
becomes for the whole zone, higher (900 mm) than the average value for the desert because
the eastern parts of the continents receive more rainfall from relatively moist trade winds
which come from over the oceans. Most of annual rainfall occurs during summer months
while winter season is dry.
Mediterranean rainfall zone- extends between 300-400 latitudes in both the hemisphere
where rainfall occurs through westerlies and cyclone during winter season while summers
remain dry because this zone comes under the influence of trade winds due to northward
shifting of wind and pressure belt during northern summer (summer solstice). Mean annual
rain fall is 1000mm.
Mid-latitudinal zone of high rainfall - extends between 400-500 latitudes in both the
hemispheres where rainfall occurs through westerlies and temperate cyclones. Mean annual
rainfall ranges between 1000 mm and 1250 mm. The western parts of the continents receive
more rainfall. It decreases from the western coastal areas to inland. Southern hemisphere
records more rainfall than northern hemisphere because of dominance of oceans in the
former. Winter season receives maximum precipitation through temperate cyclones .The
precipitation is of long duration but occurs in the form of light showers.
Polar zone of low precipitation – Precipitation decreases from 600 latitude to pole ward in
both hemispheres. Mean annual precipitation becomes only 250mm beyond750 latitude. Most
of the precipitation occurs in the form of snowfall.
7.17 CONCLUSION
Thus we can say that atmospheric pressure is a most important phenomena and
completely responsible for all weather activities as wind, rain, cyclone etc. Sometimes it also
called as barometric pressure, is the pressure within the atmosphere of Earth. In most
circumstances atmospheric pressure is closely approximated by the hydrostatic pressure
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 149 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
caused by the weight of air above the measurement point. As elevation increases, there is less
overlying atmospheric mass, so that atmospheric pressure measures force per unit area
decreases. Variation in temperature, distribution of land and water, nature of the land etc. few
important responsible factors for existence of pressure. In all, there are seven pressure belts
on the globe.
Winds are the result of unequal insolation and variation in pressure of an area. Wind is
simply air in motion, usually in a horizontal direction. It is commonly classified on the basis
of spatial scale as it’s speed, the types of forces, the region in which it occur, and it’s effect
etc. The broad categories of classified winds on the globe are Permanent winds, seasonal
winds and local winds. Whereas trade winds, westerlies and polar winds are sub type of
permanent winds. Monsoon winds are the example of seasonal winds. Chinook, Foehn,
Khamsin and Mistral are local winds types. Jet stream is the strong and rapidly moving
circumpolar westerly air circulation in a narrow belt of a few hundred kilometers width in the
upper limit of troposphere.
Humidity express to the content of water vapour present in the air in gaseous form at a
particular time and place. Humidity and rainfall are interconnected atmospheric phenomena
convectional, orographic and cyclonic are the major natural types of rainfall. Whereas, man-
induced rainfall also includes under it. Equatorial region receives maximum rainfall and as
we move towards poles it decreases. Yet Mid-latitudinal zone lies under good rainfall region
in both hemisphere because of westerlies and temperate cyclones.
7.18 SUMMARY
What do we infer? All the contents of the unit, such as the concept of atmospheric pressure
and various components related to it, wind and wind type seasonal shifting of wind belts and
their climatic significance, different mechanism such as tricellular meridional circulation of
atmosphere, humidity, rainfall types with world distribution are interlinked with each other.
All the sub topics are essential to study the atmosphere, an important part of physical
geography.
7.19 GLOSSARY
Absolute humidity: The total weight of moisture content per volume of air at definite
temperature and point of time is called absolute humidity, generally expressed in gram per
cubic meter volume.
Chunook/ Foehn : Warm and local dry winds blowing on the leeward slopes of the
mountains are called ‘chinook’ in the USA and ‘foehn’ in Switzerland.
Doldrum :A belt of low pressure, popularly known as equatorial trough of low pressure
extending discontinuously within a zone of 50 N and 50 S latitude is called the belt of calm or
doldrum.
Humidity: The state of the atmosphere with respect to the water vapour present in it.
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 150 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Humidity capacity: The moisture retaining capacity or simply humidity capacity refers to
the capacity of a parcel of air having certain volume at certain temperature and point of time
to hold maximum amount of moisture content. It is directly proportional to air temperature.
Hadley cell: The tropical convrctive cell, one each in the northern and the southern
hemispheres, is called Hadley cell (named after George Hadlely).
Ferrel’s law :is related to deflection of winds. The law states that if one stands with one’s
back towards the direction from where winds are coming they are defected to the right in the
northern hemisphere and to the left in the southern hemisphere..
Jet stream: The strong and rapidly moving circumpolar upper air westerly air circulation in
a narrow belt of a few hundred kilometers width in the upper limit of the troposphere is
called jet stream.
Monsoon: The word is used to indicate the wind system in the regions where they change
their directions twice a year.
Pressure gradient: The rate of change of pressure per unit horizontal distance is called
pressure gradient.
Relative humidity: The ratio between the actual amount of water vapour in a given volume
of the air and the amount that would be present if the air were saturated at the amount that
would be present if the air were saturated at the same temperature, generally expressed as
percentage
Saturated air : The parcel of air with definite volume at given temperature at given moment
of time having moisture content equal to its humidity capacity is called saturated air.
UNIT 7 - ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 151 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
7.21 REFERENCES
1. Singh, Savindra : Climatology, Prayag Pustak Bhawan, University Road, Allahabad.
2. Aguado Edward and Burt J.E: Weather and Climate, Printice Hall, New Jersey.
Q.2 Write the difference between Absolute humidity and Relative humidity?
UNIT 7 – ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE, WINDS, HUMIDITY AND RAINFALL Page 152 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
8.1 OBJECTIVES
8.2 INTRODUCTION
8.3 CLIMATE & CLIMATIC CLASSIFICATION
8.4 CLIMATIC CLASSIFICATION OF KOPPEN
8.4.1 GROUP A: TROPICAL/MEGA THERMAL CLIMATES
8.4.2 GROUP B: DRY (ARID AND SEMIARID) CLIMATES
8.4.3 GROUP C: MILD TEMPERATE/ MESO THERMAL
CLIMATES
8.4.4 GROUP D: CONTINENTAL/MICRO THERMAL
CLIMATES
8.4.5 GROUP E: POLAR CLIMATE
8.4.6 EVALUATION OF THE KÖPPEN’S SCHEME
8.5 CLIMATIC CLASSIFICATION THORNTHWAITE
8.5.1 1931 CLASSIFICATION
8.5.2 1948 CLASSIFICATION
8.5.3 EVALUATION OF THE THORNTHWAITE’S
SCHEME
8.6 CONCLUSION
8.7 SUMMARY
8.8 GLOSSARY
8.9 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
8.10 REFERENCES
8.11 SUGGESTED READINGS
8.12 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 153 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
8.1 OBJECTIVES
After going through this chapter, you will have learnt
8.2 INTRODUCTION
Climate is one of the most important phenomena in physical geography. Climate
classification systems work as key to understand the physical and cultural geography. It was
first published by Russian German climatologist Wladimir Koppen in 1884, with several
later modifications republished in 1918 and 1936 Where as C.W.Thornthwaite also published
and republished the world climate classification in 1931 and1948. The detail description is
given below.
Thornthwaite system was introduced in 1931 and published that climate of a location
is affected by its latitude, terrain and altitude, as well as nearby water bodies and their
currents. Climate can be classified according to the average and the typical ranges of
different variables, most commonly temperature and precipitation. The most commonly used
classification scheme was the Koppen climate classification 1948, incorporates
evapotranspiration and is diversity and how climate change affects it. along with temperature
and precipitation information used in studying biological diversity and how climate change
affects it.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 154 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
1918 wherein he paid more attention to monthly and annual averages of temperature and
precipitation and their seasonal distribution. He again modified his scheme in 1931 and 1936.
Koeppen used five major vegetation zones of the world as identified by Candolle in 1874.
The basis of classification of world climates is on the belief that the distribution of natural
vegetation was the best indicator of the total picture of climate of a region concerned. Thus
he divided the world climates into 5 principal types and represented them by capital letters A
to E. The detail description about scheme symbols of climate types are as-
The Koppen climate classification scheme divides world climates into five main groups:
A (tropical climate)
B (dry climate)
C (temperate climate)
D (contintal climate)
E (polar climate)
The second letter indicates the seasonal precipitation type, while the third letter indicates the
level of heat.
Am = Tropical monsoon climate; driest month with precipitation less than 60 mm, but more
than 4% the total annual precipitation.
Aw or As = Tropical wet and dry or savanna climate; with the driest month having
precipitations less than 60 mm (2.4 in) and less than 4 % of the total annual precipitation.
(a) 280 if 70% or more of the total precipitation is in the spring and summer months
(April –
(b) 140 if 30% - 70% September in the Northern Hemisphere, or October-March in the
Southern), or of the total precipitation is received during the spring and summer, or
(c) 0 if less than 30% of the total precipitation is so received.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 155 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
If the annual precipitation is less than 50% of this threshold, the classification is BW
(arid: desert climate); if it is in range of 50%-100% of the threshold, the classification is
BS (semi- arid: steppe climate).
A third letter can be included to indicate temperature. Originally, h signified low- latitude
climate (average annual temperature below 180C (64.4*F) while k signified middle- latitude
climate (average annual temperature below 180C ), but the more common practice today,
especially in the United States, is to use h to mean the coldest month has an average
temperature above 00C (320F), with K denoting that at least one month’s averages below 00C
.
Cfb = Temperate oceanic climate; coldest month averaging above 00C (320 F), all months
with average temperatures below 220C (71.60 F), and at least four months averaging
above100C (500F). No significant precipitation difference between seasons. abovementioned
set of conditions fulfilled).
Cfc = Subpolar oceanic climate; coldest month averaging above 00C (320 F) and 1-3 months
averaging above 100C (500F). No significant precipitation difference between seasons.
Cwa = Monsoon-influenced humid subtropical climate, coldest month averaging above 00C
(320 F) and at least one month’s average temperature above 220C (71.60 F). at least four
months averaging above 100C (500F). At least ten times as much rain in the wettest month of
summer as in the driest month if winter (70% or more of average annual precipitation is
received in the warmest six months).
Cwb = Subtropical highland climate or temperate oceanic climatic with dry winters; coldest
month averaging above 00C (320 F), all months with average temperature below 220C (71.60
F), and at least four months averaging above 100C (500F). At least ten times as much rain in
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 156 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
the wettest month of summer as in the driest month of winter ( 70% or more of average
annual precipitation received in the warmest six months).
Cwc = Cold subtropical highland climate or subpolar oceanic climate with dry winters;
coldest month averaging above and 00C (320 F) and 1-3 months averaging above 100C
(500F). At least ten times as much rain in the wettest month of summer as in the driest month
of winter (70% or more of average annual precipitation is received in the warmest six
months).
Csa = Hot summer Mediterranean climate; coldest month averaging 00C (320 F), and at least
one month’s average temperature above 220C (71.60 F) and at least four months averaging
above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the wettest month of winter
as in the driest month of summer, receives less than 30 mm.
Csb = Warm-summer Mediterranean climate; coldest month averaging above 00C (320 F), all
months with average temperatures below 220C (71.60 F), and at least four months averaging
above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the wettest month of winter
as in the driest month of summer, and driest month of summer receives less than 30 mm.
Csc = Cool-summer Mediterranean climate; coldest month averaging above 00C (320 F), and
1-3 months averaging above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the
wettest month of winter as in the driest month of summer, and driest month of summer
receives less than 30 mm.
Dfa = Hot-summer humid continental climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F),
and at least one month’s average temperature above 220C (71.60 F), and at least four months
averaging above 100C (500F). No significant precipitation difference between seasons.
Dfb = Warm-summer humid continental climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F),
all months with average temperatures below 220C (71.60F). No significant precipitation
difference between seasons.
Dfc = Subarctic climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F), and 1-3 months
averaging above 100C (500F). No significant precipitation difference between seasons.
Dfd= Extremely cold subarctic climate; coldest month averaging below -380C (-36.40F) and
1-3 months averaging above 100C (500F). No significant precipitation difference between
seasons.
Dwa = Monsoon- influenced hot- summer humid continental climate; coldest month
averaging below 00C (320 F), and at least one month’s average temperature above 220C
(71.60 F) and at least four months averaging above 100C (500F). At least ten times as much
rain in the wettest month of summer as in the driest month of winter.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 157 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Dwc = Monsoon-influenced subarctic climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F),
and 1-3 months averaging above 100C (500F). At least ten times as much rain in the wettest
month of summer as in the driest month of winter.
Dwd = Monsoon- influenced extremely cold subarctic climate; coldest month averaging
below -380C (-36.40F) and 1-3 months averaging above 100C (500F). At least ten times as
much rain in the wettest month of summer as in the driest month of winter.
Dsa = Hot, dry-summer continental climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F), and
at least one month’s average temperature above 220C (71.60 F). and at least four months
averaging above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the wettest month
of winter as in the driest month of summer, and driest month of summer receives less than 30
mm.
Dsb = Warm, dry-summer continental climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F),
all months with average temperatures below 220C (71.60 F), and at least four months
averaging above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the wettest month
of winter as in the driest month of summer, and driest month of summer receives less than 30
mm.
Dsc = Dry-summer subarctic climate; coldest month averaging below 00C (320 F), and 1-3
months averaging above 100C (500F). At least three times as much precipitation in the
wettest month of winter as in the driest month of summer, and driest month of summer
receives less than 30 mm.
Dsd = Extremely cold, dry-summer subarctic climate; coldest month averaging below -380C
(-36.40F) and 1-3 months averaging above 100C (500F). At least three times as much
precipitation in the wettest month of winter as in the driest month of summer, and driest
month of summer receives less than 30 mm.
ET = Mild tundra climate; all 12 months of the year with average temperatures between 0 0C
(320 F), and 100C (500F).
ETf = Cold tundra climate; at least one month with an average temperature below 00C (320
F).
EF = Ice cap climate; eternal winter, with all 12 months of the year with averagetemperature
below 00C (320 F).
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 158 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Yet Koeppen’s climate classification has good scope but sometimes it also suffers
from some serious drawbacks. As he focused only on mean monthly temperature and
precipitation where as neglected other weather elements such as winds, amounts of
cloudiness and number of rainy days etc. He made his scheme more descriptive, generalized
and ignored the consideration of causative factors of climate.The use of different letter
symbols to indicate different climatic types and their secondary and tertiary subtypes makes
the scheme very difficult to memorise.
8.5.1 1931-Classification
Thornthwaite also considered natural vegetation of a region as the indicator of climate
of that region as Koeppen. He used the concept that the amount of precipitation and
temperature had paramount control. Thus Thornthwaite used two factors, as precipitation
effectiveness and temperature effectiveness, for the delimitation of boundaries of different
climatic regions.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 159 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
He identified 5 humidity zones on the basis of P/E Index and boundary values for the major
vegetation zones.
(ii) Thermal Effectiveness- He believed that temperature had important contribution in the
growth of vegetation. Thus divised an index of thermal efficiency or temperature
effectiveness, expressed by positive departure of monthly mean temperatures from freezing
point, and for the better result suggested the following formula-
A’ – Tropical 127
B’ – Mesothermal 64-127
C’ – Microthermal 32-63
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 160 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
D’ – Taiga 16-31
E’ – Tundra 1.15
F’ – Frost 0
Thus, on the basis of precipitation effectiveness, thermal efficiency, and seasonal
distribution of rainfall there may be 120 probable combinations and hence climatic types on
theoretical ground but he depicted only 32 climatic types on the world map as given below-
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 161 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
8.5.2 1948-Classification
Thorthwaite presented his modified scheme of climatic classification in 1948. Though
he reused three indices of precipitation effectiveness, thermal efficiency and seasonal
distribution of precipitation in the second classification but in different way. Now the new
scheme of climatic classification was based on the concept of potential evapotranspiration
(PE) which is an index of thermal efficiency and water loss because it represents the amount
of transfer of both moisture and heat to the atmosphere from soils and vegetation. It may be
pointed out that potential evapotranspiration is calculated from the mean monthly
temperature with corrections for day length of the day. The PE for a 30 days month is
calculated as follows-
t = temperature in 0C
(i) Moisture Index (Im)- Moisture index refers to moisture deficit or surplus
and is calculated according to the following formula -
Im = (100S-60D) /PE
The sum of the 12 monthlly values of Im gives the annual moisture Index.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 162 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Aridity Index = in moist climates annual water deficit taken as a percentage of annual PE
becomes aridity index.
Humidity Index = in dry climates annual water surplus taken as a percentage of annual PE
becomes humidity index.
2 80 to 100 B4 Humid
3 60 to 80 B3 Humid
4 40 to 60 B2 Humid
5 20 to 40 B1 Humid
6 0 to 20 C2 Moist subhumid
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 163 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
On the basis of summer concentration of thermal efficiency the world was further divided
into 8 provinces-
1 Below 48.0 a’
2 48.0 – 51.9 b’
8 Above 88.0 d’
On the basis of seasonal moisture adequacy 2 major and 10 subclimatic types were
identified-
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 164 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The climate of a place, thus is determined by combining the aforesaid elements of the
climatic classification e.g. moisture index, thermal efficiency index, summer concentration of
thermal efficiency and seasonal moisture adequacy. Thus, the climate of a place is
represented by four letters. For example- A A’ a’r climate = Perhumid (A) megathermal (A’)
climate with summer concentration of annual thermal efficiency of less than 48% (a’) and
little or no water deficit (r) etc. On the basis of above indices the classification system
becomes so complex due to large number of climatic types that it becomes difficult to
represent them cartographically.
The Thornthwaite’s scheme differs from the Koeppen’s scheme in that the former
used two indices of precipitation efficiency and thermal efficiency for differentiation of
different climatic types but the delimitation of climatic boundaries on the basis of these two
indices becomes difficult and vague. Thus the lack of adequate climate data makes it difficult
for the precise demarcation of climatic boundaries.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 165 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
different climatic types could be prepared. It may be pointed out that it becomes very
difficult to cartographically represent a large number of climatic types identified
quantitatively on the basis of aforesaid indices, Moreover; the data of potential
evapotranspiration are not available for all the places for a worldwide classification of
climates. They also involve a lot of calculations for determining the climatic type of a
particular place. Thus this scheme could not get more popularity and recognition.
8.6 CONCLUSION
Thus we can say that climate is a long term calculation or study of the atmoshpheric
condition by a climatologist with the help of weather instruments.and very early attempts by
the ancient Greeks at classifying climate were logic- based, and resulted in paramenides’
identification of three principal climate regions; the Frigid Zone, the Temperate Zone, and
the Torrid Zone. In modern time sir koppen and Thornthwaite classified the world climate
into various region on the basis of different parameters. And both’s scheme are most popular
in geographers.
8.7 SUMMARY
The objectives for the unit were to study the Climate & its classification;
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 166 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
for warm summers,”c” indicating mild summers, and the rare “d” indicating cool
summers.
Arid climates have a third-order subdivision of “h” and”k” which are used to denote
“hot” and “cold” arid or semi- arid regions, respectively.
The Thornthwaite climatic classification system is built on the physical interactions
between local moisture and temperature rather than only the precipitation and
temperature data. It represents a more sophisticated and precise scheme of
classification based on local surface water balance.
Thornthwaite devised a number if specific indices to quantify necessary climatic
components, including the moisture index (MI) and the potential evapotranspiration
(PE) rate for a location.
He also derived a Thermal Efficiency Index (T/EET) of the ration of temperature (T)
to a calculated evapotranspiration (ET) value, and a Dryness Index (DI) and Humidity
Index (HI) to identify the times of the year with water deficit or surplus.
8.8 GLOSSARY
Weather: refers to the condition of the atmosphere at a certain time or over a certain short
period, as described by various meteorological phenomena.
Climate: refers to the average weather conditions of a place or region throughout the
seasons. It depends on latitude position.
Climatology: The science that deals with the various climates of the earth, and their
influence on the natural environment.
Evapotranspiration :A term signifying the total loss of moisture from the soil in the form of
water vapour, including the lost by evaporation from bodies of open water, e.g., lakes,
reservoirs, and from the surface of soils and also that lost by transpiration from growing
plants.
Transpiration: refers to the process whereby plants, having taken in moisture though their
roots, return it to the atmosphere through the stomata of their leaves in the form of water
vapour.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN & THORNTHWEIT Page 167 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
8.10 REFERENCES
1. Koppen, Wladimir (1918). “Klassification der Klimate nach Temperatur, Niederschlag and
Jahreslauf”. Petermanns Geographische Mitteilungen.
2. Critchfield, Howard J (1983). General Climatology (4thed.) New Delhi: Prentice Hall. pp.
154-161.
3. Singh, Savindra, (2015). Physical Geography Prayag Pustak Bhawan, University Road,
Allahabad.
UNIT 8 - CLIMATES AND ITS CLASSIFICATION- KOPPEN AND THORNTHWEIT Page 168 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
BLOCK 3 : HYDROSPHERE
9.1 OBJECTIVES
9.2 INTRODUCTION
9.3 SURFACE CONFIGURATION OF OCEAN BOTTOMS
9.3.1 BOTTOM RELIEF OF THE ATLANTIC OCEAN
9.3.2 BOTTOM RELIEF OF THE PACIFIC OCEAN
9.3.3 BOTTOM RELIEF OF THE INDIAN OCEAN
9.4 CONCLUSION
9.5 SUMMARY
9.6 GLOSSARY
9.7 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
9.8 REFERENCES
9.9 SUGGESTED READINGS
9.10 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
9.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, you should be able to understand the:
Difference between sea and ocean,
Sea level and the causes of sea level changes,
Description about continental shelf, continental slopes, deep ocean basins, ocean
deeps and submarine canyons etc.
9.2 INTRODUCTION
Hydrosphere is far more extensive than lithosphere on the surface of the earth. It is
calculated that about 71% of the earth’s surface is occupied by seas and oceans. The oceans
have a greater extent of water in the southern hemisphere than in the northern one.
An extension of saline water on earth is called sea. Large sea areas are called oceans.
Seas are separated from oceans by a series of peninsulas or land pieces.
A great success has been achieved in unravelling the mystery of seas and oceans
because divers have reached very deep areas of the oceans with the help of scientific
equipments. Nowadays, the floors of the oceans have been charted on maps. Two scientists
descended into the deepest trench in January, 1960 to a depth of 11.9 Km. This trench is
situated in western Pacific ocean and is called Mariana Trench.
Sea level: The sea level is used as a standard for measuring heights of landforms. This is
because the sea level is considered to be fixed. In fact, the sea level is not fixed. Many land
areas have risen above sea and many land areas which were once above sea level are now
submerged under the sea. There are two reasons for this phenomenon :-
1) The sea level is rising.
2) The land is subsiding in comparison with sea.
Whatever be the reason, one thing is clear that the sea level is not stationary by
continues to change.
About three fourth or 71% of the surface of the earth consists of water and this is
known as the Hydrosphere. It consists of a number of oceans, seas, bays, gulfs and lakes. The
five important oceans, in order of size, are the Pacific, Atlantic, Indian, Antarctic and the
Arctic. Of these, the most important is the Atlantic ocean, being flanked on both sides by
Europe and the U.S.A.
The oceans are of varying depths. Within the same ocean, depth varies from place to
place. The depth of the oceans is measured in Fathoms, each fathom being of 6 feet. For
sounding the depths of the oceans a fathom line is used. It consists of a rope with a leaden
weight tied at one end. In deeper oceans fathoms meter is used. It has an automatic drum
which produces a sound on reaching the bottom and it reaches the ears of the observers
through a headphone. Thereafter the depth is computed on the basis of the fact that the sound
waves travel through the water at the rate of 4,840 feet per second.
Some different topographic features of ocean and sea floor give us an idea of the
surface configuration of ocean bottoms. According to depth, the ocean is divided into these
sections or zones are given below:
The structure, configuration and relief features of the different oceans vary from each
other. The oceans ridges are the most remarkable and obvious features. An oceanic ridge is a
mountain chain of young basaltic rock at the active spreading centre of an ocean. Stretching
65,000 km, more than 1.5 times the earth’s circumference, oceanic ridges girdle the globe
like seams surround a softball. The rugged ridges which often are devoid of sediment rise
about 2km above the sea floor. In places they project above the surface to form islands such
as Iceland, the Azores and Easter Islands. Oceanic ridges and their associated structures
account for about 23% of the world’s solid surface area (all the land above the sea level
accounts for 29%). Although these features are often called mid-ocean ridges, less than 60%
of their length actually exists at mid-ocean.
The surface beneath the water is characterized by a great diversity of relief features,
i.e., the towering mountain chains, deep canyons, flat plains, oceanic ridges, trenches, island
arcs, sea mounts and guyots. The submarine relief has, however, been classified under the
following major categories: i) Continental shelves, ii) Continental slopes, iii) Deep ocean
basins (abyssal plains), and iv) Trenches and island arcs.
Continental margins have two main divisions: i) a shallow, nearly flat continental
shelf close to shore, and ii) a more steeply slope continental slope towards the sea.
1. Continental Shelf
Oceans are full of water. Some of it spreads on to the neighboring land. The portions
of the land which are submerged under sea water constitute Continental Shelf. The
continental shelf is shallow and its depth is not more than 200 meters. Its slope from the land
to the sea is about 2 meters per km. The breadth of the continental shelf is not the same
everywhere. The extent of the continental shelf depends upon the physical configuration of
the bordering landmass. If the coastal region is a plain area, the continental shelf will be
several miles in width. On the contrary, if the coastal region is hilly and mountainous, the
continental shelf will be narrow.
The continental shelf is not flat everywhere. Had it been flat, dunes, river valleys,
depressions, etc., would not have been found on the shelf. Some areas of the shelf are
composed of hard rocks. Mud, sand and glacial deposits are found on the continental shelf in
New England and Canada. Many drumlins rise above sea surface and appear as islands.
These continental shelves are rising as also subsiding at different places. Sediments
are deposited on them by river, wind and ocean waves and currents. Sunlight penetrate to
some depth into the sea water and support animal and vegetation lives on sea floors. The
world famous fisheries are situated in these areas. The continental shelves have become
increasingly important because of exploration for natural resources. Numerous deposits of oil
and natural gas are found in the continental shelves which are being prospected and
extracted. Moreover, the waters of the continental shelves will be even more important
geopolitically and economically as the fast growing population of the developing countries
will look towards the sea for its food, minerals and raw material requirements. Types of
continental shelves –
A few important types of continental shelves are described in order to have a proper
idea of shelves.
(i) Glaciated shelves – These are the shelves where a lot of glacial action had
taken place. Some hills rise from it. The shallow sea near New England is a
continental shelf. The breadth of this type of shelves is about 150km.
Moraines, drumlins, etc. are found on them.
(ii) Broad river shelves – When delta is not formed the big develop a broad
continental shelves. The interior edges of the shelves are uniformly flat but the
outer ones are studded with hills. The shelves of yellow sea and the Gulf of
Siam belong to this type.
(iii) Coral Shelves – These shelves have been built by corals. The depth of the
outer edge is 20 meters. The shelves are shallow. Continental shelves in
Eastern Australia are an example of this type.
2. Continental Slope
The continuously sloping portion of the continental margin, seaward of the
continental shelf, and extending down to the deep sea floor of the abyssal plain, is known as
continental slope. The continental slope is beyond the continental shelf, where the sea floor
slopes downwards. This is abrupt and its depth is sometimes as much as 2000 fathoms. The
continental slopes mark the beginning of the true sea bed.
At the outer edge of the continental shelf, the slope suddenly steepens. This is found
to be 35 to 61 metres per km. The value of the slope is much more adjacent to the Fold
Mountains than that near the coastal plains. One end of the slope connects it with continental
shelf while the other one merges into the ocean floors. The area occupied by continental
slope is 8.5% of the total ocean area.
Generally, the steep gradient of the continental slopes does not allow any marine
deposits on them. The most significant relief features of the continental slope are submarine
canyons.
deeps are also called trenches and troughs. Sometimes their name suggests that the trenches
have a steep stope. Due to the non-existence of sediments, the deeps are almost empty. The
slopes of their walls is, however much steeper than that of any other feature.
The origin of the ocean deeps is attributed to the endogenetic forces which have produced the
mountains.
5. Submarine Canyons
These are depressions with walls of steep slopes and have V-shape. They exist on the
continental slopes and the shelves. They are found to have a length of 16 km., at the
maximum and have a dendritic pattern. The canyons are found to be close to river mouths
such as those of the Congo, the Hudson, the Delaware, the Columbia, etc. the depth varies
from 1800 metres to 2800 metres. Coarse deposits are found in the Canyons.
These canyons are found in Asia in Aleutian Island, Japan, Philippines, etc., in
Europe near the Mediterranean sea, in North America at the coasts of Mexico and California
and along the eastern coasts from Cape Hatteras to the middle of Canada.
Many sea mounts are found in the Gulf of Alaska. Patton, Prat, Faris etc., are well
known sea mounts. Some of them attain a height of 3000 metres.
Guyots were discovered by a Swiss scientist Guyots, A.H. near Mariana deep and
Hawaii Islands in Pacific Ocean. An ordinary guyot has a diameter of 20-25 km. The tops of
guyots are 1200 to 1800 metres below sea level. Some scientists think that many volcanic
crests were eroded by ocean currents and formed guyots on submergence. Some scientists
think that guyots are remnants of atolls.
7. Ocean Ridges
These ridges are submerged under sea water. Some important ridges in North and
South Atlantic Ocean are Dolphin and Challenger and are thousands of metres high as
measured from the ocean floors. The Mid-Atlantic ridge is famous. No such ridge exists in
Pacific Ocean. Some ridges in the form of small plateaus have been located in the eastern
part. North to south ridges exists in the Indian Ocean.
1. Shape and size – It has the shape of the English alphabet- S. It has 1/6 of the area of
the earth or ½ of that of the Pacific. Its area in 82 million sq.km. The broadest part is
6000km along 35south. It is surrounded by Europe and Africa on the east and north
and South America on the west.
2. Depth – About ¼ of the ocean is less than 1000 meters deep. It is because of the
shallowness of the marginal seas.
3. Island – The British Island and New Zealand are the raised portions of continental
shelf. The West Indies Islands are situated between the North and the South America.
Greenland and the northern Scotland are situated on the Mid-Atlantic ridge. Other
important islands are Faukland, South Archaes, Shettland, Sandwich, Ascension,
Tristan de Cunha, Bermuda, Madeira, Canaries etc.
Plateau to the south of Greenland between Africa and America. It subsides at few
places. Many branches leave this ridge at various places.
7. Basins and Deeps – There are a number of basins situated in the ocean. Labrador,
North – west and North – east Pacific, Cape Verde, Sierra Leone, Guniea, Brazilian,
Agulhas, Argentinean and other basins area well known. Ramanche deep in Sierra
Leone is the deepest (19,290.4 metres).
Trenches are few. West of the West Indies is Puerto Rico and to the west is
Caymon trench. The south sandwich trench is situated in the southern part of the
ocean.
The Pacific Ocean is the largest and deepest of all water bodies. Together with its
associated seas, it covers about one third of the earth’s surface and exceeds the total land area
of the world in size. The average depth is generally around 7300 meters.
Indonesia, Japan, etc., belong to this type. Some scattered islands like cook Island,
Society Island, Polynesian Island, etc are like dots in the ocean.
The Hawaii Islands are famous in the North Pacific Ocean. The north –
East Ocean appears to be a big mass of water.
4) Marginal seas –Such seas are mostly found in the western part of the ocean.
Here the marginal seas are deep but narrow. Bering, Okhotsk, Japan, China, Sulu,
Celebes and other seas are well known. The number is much less in the west and
the seas are shallow. Some of the well known seas are California and Aleutian
seas.
5) Continental Shelf – The western shelf is broad as compared to that in the east.
The eastern shelf is about 80 km. broad while the width in the west ranges from
150 to 1500 km. the Japan sea, the Yellow sea, etc., stand over the shelf.
6) Submarine Ridges – More submarine ridges are found in the east then in the
west – Albatros plateau is one such ridge. Albatros is 4000 meter deep and its
length is 1500km. Howaii ridge, Marcuo, Neeker, etc., are other ridges suitable
for mention.
7) Ocean Basins – Famous basins are Aleutian, Phillipines, Carolina, Fiji, South-
east Pacific basin, etc.
8) The Deeps and the Trenches – The famous trenches are Aleution, Keurile,
Mariana, Togo- Kermadec, Chile, etc.
The deepest deep in Mariana trench is 28,018.55 metre deep Cape Johnson (26,665
metres) in Phillipines trench, Vityez (26,360 metres) in Keurile trench, Aldrich (23,407
metres) in Togo – Kermadec Milne Edward (15,906 metres) in Peru trench etc. are some of
the important deeps in Pacific Ocean.
1) Location –Asia to the north, Australia to the east and Africa towards west
surrounded this ocean. It meets Atlantic Ocean and Pacific Ocean in the south but it
extends to Tropic of Cancer in the north.
2) Shape and Size – It has a compact shape. It is the third ocean in order of size. It is
narrow in the north and broad in the south.
3) Depth – Its depths ranges from 4000 to 6000 metres in 60% of the Indian Ocean. Its
average depth is thought to be about 4000 metres.
4) Islands – Islands of this ocean can be divided into three parts –
(i) Medium sized Island – Madagascar Sri Lanka, Sumatra, Java etc.
(ii) Small sized Islands – The Andaman & Nikobars, Socotra, Zanzibar,
Comoro, Mauritius, Kerguelen, etc.
(iii) Tiny Islands- Chagos, Maldives, Seychelles, Amrantes, Cocos, St. Paul,
Diego Garcia, etc.
5) Marginal Seas – There are very few marginal seas in the Indian Ocean. The largest
are the Bay of Bengal and the Arabian sea. Small marginal seas are Persian Gulf, Red
Sea, Gulf of Aden, Andaman Sea, etc. Very small marginal seas are the Gulf of
Oman, Gulf of Kutch, Gulf of Cambay, etc.
6) Continental Shelf – The breadth of the shelf is not the same everywhere. Shelf is
the broadest in the Arabian Sea and the Bay of Bengal. It extends to 600 Km. in these
areas but is about 159 Km. in the east. It is narrow near Antarctica, Australia and
Indonesia. Africa has a medium sized shelf.
7) The Central Ridge – Like the Mid-Atlantic ridge, a central ridge exists in the
Indian Ocean but it is comparatively broad and less deep.It has various names at
different places. Some islands like Lakshadweep, Maldive etc., are situated on the
northern part of the Central Ridge, St. Paul Island and Chagos stand on its middle
section. The southern part of the ridge is very wide and is called Amsterdam- St. Paul
plateau.
8) Basins, Deeps and Trenches - There are few deeps and trenches and some small
basins. Some important basins are those of the Oman, Arab, Somali, S.W.
Madagascar, Natal, Agulhas, Andaman, Cocus- Keeling, etc.
9.4 CONCLUSION
Oceanography involves the considerations a wide range of oceanic phenomena, both
physical and biological. From the point of view of the physical geographer, the most
important feature is the extent and shape of the ocean basins, for the distribution of land and
sea is for him a fundamental concept. The structure and relief of the ocean floor and of the
marginal seas afford contributory evidence towards the structure of the earth, concerned as
we are with the permanence or otherwise of the oceans and continents, the problem of
continental drift, changes of sea level, the distribution of volcanoes and earthquake zones and
the accumulation of sediments on the sea floor which may ultimately from sedimentary
rocks.
The movements it sea-water, in the form of waves, tides and currents, affect the coast
line with which they come in contact and warm and cool currents may powerfully modify the
climates of coastal areas. When we speak of the topography of the ocean floor, we mean the
various shapes that the bottom of the ocean can take. We tend to picture the ocean floor as
being as flat and sandy as the beaches with which we are familiar. Fortunately, the ocean
floor is not quite simple, predictable, or boring. Though the bottom of the ocean is hidden
from our sight by vast quantities of water, it’s anything but boring, flat and featureless. As
our technological expertise increases, so does our ability to visualize these distant landscapes.
We find basically that the ocean floor has all the same shapes, bumps, mountains, valleys,
plateaus and such that we are more familiar with on the surface. When you consider that
three quarters of our planet’s surface is covered by ocean water, you soon realize that there’s
more land “down there” than we have “up here”. It really is not all that different from the
land on which we live.
9.5 SUMMARY
Seen from space, our planet’s surface appears to be dominated by the colour blue.
The earth appears blue because large bodies of saline water known as the oceans dominate
the surface. Oceans cover approximately 70.8% or 361 million sq. kms. of earth’s surface
with a volume of about 1370 million cubic kilometers. The average depth of these extensive
bodies of sea water is about 3.8 kilometers. Maximum depths can exceed 10 kilometers in a
number of areas known as ocean trenches.
The oceans contain 97% of our planet’s available water. The other 3% is found in
atmosphere, on the Earth’s terrestrial surface or in the Earth’s lithosphere in various forms
and stores.
The oceans are of varying depths. Within the same ocean, depth varies from place to
place.
This unit is totally dedicated to explain the configuration and structural features of
ocean bottoms of the earth’s surface.
9.6 GLOSSARY
Sea = The salt water that covers large parts of the surface of the earth.
Ocean = The mass of salt water that covers most of the surface of the
earth.
Sea level = The average level of the sea, used for measuring the height of
places on land.
Continental Shelf = The gently sloping submarine fringe of a continent.
Hydrosphere = All the water on , or close to, the surface of the earth.
Hemisphere = One half of the earth.
Peninsula = A piece of land jutting into and almost surrounded by the sea.
Glacier = A mass of ice which may be moving , or has moved, overland;
when enough ice has accumulated, a glacier will start to move
forwards.
Subsidence = To sink down into the ground
Configuration = The way in which the parts of something, or a group of things,
are arranged.
Dunes = A hill or ridge of sand accumulated and sorted by wind action.
Drumlins = A long hummock or hill, egg shaped in plan and deposited and
shaped under an ice sheet or very broad glacier while the ice
was still moving.
Coral = An offshore ridge, mainly of calcium carbonate, formed by the
secretions of small marine animals.
Oozes = A deep, sea floor deposit either of tiny organisms such as
diatoms (a type of algae) or of fine inorganic sediments.
Atolls = A coral reef, ring or horseshoe shaped, enclosing a tropical
lagoon.
9.8 REFERENCES
1. Ahmad, A., 1993, Physical geography, Rawat Publication, Jaipur.
2. Bharatdwaj, K., 2009, Physical Geography: A landscape Appreciation, Discovery
Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi.
3. Tikka, R.N., 1994-95, Physical Geography, Kedar Nath Ram Nath & Co., Meerut.
4. Dasgupta, A., 1995, Kapoor, A.N. Principles of Physical Geography, S. Chand &
Company Ltd., New Delhi – 55.
5. Lebon, J.H., 1969, 9An Introduction to Physical Geography, Hutchinson, London.
6. Mathur, S.M., 1994, Physical Geology of India, National Book Trust, New Delhi.
7. Bembrick, S., 1994, The Cambridge Encyclopedia of Physical Geography, Cambridge
University Press, New York.
8. Basham, A.L., 1959, A Handbook of Physical Geography, Grove Press, New York.
10.1 OBJECTIVES
10.2 INTRODUCTION
10.3 TEMPERATURE OF THE OCEAN WATER: DAILY AND
ANNUAL RANGES
10.4 CONTROLLING FACTORS OF DISTRIBUTION OF
TEMPERATURE
10.5 HORIZONTAL DISTRIBUTION OF TEMPERATURE
10.6 VERTICAL DISTRIBUTION OF TEMPERATURE
10.7 COMPOSITION OF THE SEA WATER
10.8 SOURCES OF OCEAN SALINITY
10.9 CONTROLLING FACTORS OF SALINITY
10.10 HORIZONTAL DISTRIBUTION OF THE SALINITY
10.11 VERTICAL DISTRIBUTION OF SALINITY
10.12 CONCLUSION
10.13 SUMMARY
10.14 GLOSSARY
10.15 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
10.16 REFERENCES
10.17 SUGGESTED READINGS
10.18 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
10.1 OBJECTIVES
After reading this unit, you should be able to understand the:
10.2 INTRODUCTION
The temperature of oceanic water is important for marine organisms including plants
(phyto plankton) and animals (zoo plankton). The temperature of sea water also affects the
climate of coastal lands and plants and animal therein. The study of both, surface and sub-
surface temperature of sea water is significant. Standard type of thermometer is used to
measure the surface temperature while reversing thermometers and thermographs are used to
measure the sub surface temperature. These thermometers record the temperature up to the
accuracy of ± 0.02° centigrade. With respect to temperature, there are three layers in the
oceans from surface to the bottom in the tropics viz;
(i) The first layer represents the top-layer of warm oceanic water and is 500 m thick
with temperature ranging between 20° and 25°C. This layer is present within the
tropics throughout the year but it develops in mid-latitudes only during summer.
(ii) The thermocline layer represents vertical zone of oceanic water below the first
layer and is characterized by rapid rate of decrease of temperature with increasing
depth.
(iii) The third layer is very cold and extends up to the deep ocean floor. The polar
areas have only one layer of cold water from the surface (sea level) to the deep
ocean floor.
The major source of the temperature of the oceanic water is the sun. The radiant
energy transmitted from the photosphere of the sun in the form of electromagnetic short
waves and received at the ocean surface is called insolation. Besides, some energy, below the
bottom and through the compression of sea water. The amount of insolation to be received at
sun’s rays, length of day, distance of the earth from the sun and effects of the atmosphere.
The mechanism of the heating and cooling of ocean water differs from the said mechanism
on land because besides horizontal and vertical movements of water, the evaporation is most
active over the oceans.
The diurnal range depends on the conditions of sky (cloudy or clear sky), stability or
instability of air and stratification of sea water. The heating and cooling of ocean water is
rapid under clear sky (cloudless) and hence the diurnal range of temperature becomes a bit
higher than under overcast sky and strong air circulation. The high density of water below
surface water causes very little transfer of heat through conduction and hence the diurnal
range of temperature becomes low.
Annual range of temperature is higher in the enclosed seas than in the open seas
(Baltic Sea records annual range of temperature of 4.4℃ or 40℉ ) the size of the oceans and
the seas also affects annual ranges of temperature e.g., bigger the size, lower the annual range
and vice-versa. The Atlantic Ocean records relatively higher annual range of temperature
than the Pacific Ocean.
lower temperature than the open seas in the high latitudes (Baltic Sea records 0℃ (32℉)
and open seas have 4.4℃ or 40℉)
In the south western part of the Atlantic, isotherms buldge towards south-west due to
warm Brazil Current but in the eastern part of south Atlantic isotherm bend towards north-
west due to cold Bengula current. Further south, isotherms are parallel owing to constant
prevailing west wind drift.
The distribution of temperature in the north and the south Atlantic is not symmetrical.
For example, in north Atlantic, 5℃ isotherm touches 70°N latitude whereas in the southern
half of the Atlantic it never crosses 50° South latitude because the warm Gulf Stream is more
powerful and it reaches to much higher latitude than the cold Brazil current. Moreover, there
is a considerable difference between the eastern and western parts of the Atlantic. In the
western part near Labrador coast, 0℃ to 13℃ temperature is found on the west coast of
Europe.
In the marginal seas, temperature varies due to latitude and location, e.g., the
Mediterranean records higher temperature than the neighboring Atlantic Ocean but Baltic
and the Hudson Bay are colder than the Atlantic.
In the northern half of the Pacific, isotherms and latitudes are almost parallel, but on
the coast of North America isotherms bend slightly northward under the influence of the
warm Kuroshio Current and along the coast Japan isotherms are closely spaced due to the
cold Oyashio Current.
In the equatorial region of the western part of the Pacific, high temperatures are
recorded as the warm equatorial current flows towards south. In the eastern part of the
Pacific, low temperatures prevail due to the influence of cold Peru Current. In the south
Pacific, isotherms make minor loops due to the warm Peru or Humboldt Current.
In the Indian Ocean, the isotherms of 25℃, 27℃ and 28℃ occupy the central location
of the ocean. Towards south no difference is observed with the Pacific as the isotherms
roughly follow the parallels except a minor loop near the Cape of Good Hope due to the cold
Agulhas Current. The isotherms bend southward near the coast of North Africa due to a cold
current which flows south-westward from Cape Guardafui.
The same isotherm bends northward in the Arabian Sea when it enters the Indian
peninsula, but in the Bay of Bengal it bends towards south due to the effect of monsoon drift.
The enclosed water bodies like the Red Sea have higher temperature towards south due to the
mixture of open ocean water. The Persian Gulf records lower temperature than the Indian
Ocean under the influence of cold land area.
In the Indian Ocean, the highest surface, temperature of 28℃ is recorded over the
Arabian Sea and the Bay of Bengal. In August, the enclosed seas like the Red Sea and the
Persian Gulf show higher temperature (30° to 33°C) than the open ocean due to their contant
with warm land areas.
There is an inversion of temperature in polar seas. The water obtained from melting
of polar ice floats over comparatively warm water of the ocean but the fall of temperature
becomes distinct only below 400 metres.
Similarly, the Mediterranean Sea and the Atlantic Ocean are separated by Gibralter
Strait. Hence, the water of the Atlantic Ocean cannot enter the Mediterranean Sea freely.
This strait is about 400 metre deep. The temperature at the bottom of the Mediterranean is
13℃.
The Wyville-Thomson is submerged hill and separated the Arctic and Atlantic
Oceans. The temperature to the north of the submerged hill in Norwegian Sea is 1.5℃ and
the temperature at the same depth in the Atlantic Ocean is 7℃.
3. The Effect of Depth -The rate of the fall of temperature in an ocean is not uniform
at all depths. It can be generally surmised that the fall of temperature is very low upto a
depth of 1000 metres (3000ft) in an open ocean but beyond this the fall of temperature
is very steep. It continues upto 3,000 metres. After this the temperature remains almost
fixed beyond this depth and ranges from 1.5℃ to 7℃.
4. The Effect of Rain – In areas of the oceans where the rain is heavy, the temperature
of the sea water is a bit high. For example, the daily rain fall in equatorial areas keeps
the temperature higher than those in higher latitudes.
There is a gradual decrease of temperature with increasing descent. Normally, 90
percent of the solar heat is absorbed in the topmost 15.6 metre (60 feet) of water. The
sea water temperature corresponds to the surface temperature only up to a depth of
about 100 metre, and, will further descent, temperature generally decreases.
In tropical oceans and seas, three layers can be recognized from surface to bottom.
The first layer is about 500 m thick with temperature varying between 20° and 25℃. In mid-
latitude regions this top layer is found only during summer. The thermocline layer is found
just below the first layer. It is characterized by rapid decrease of temperature with increasing
depth. The third layer is very cold and extended up to the ocean floor.
In contrast to the tropical oceans, in Polar Regions only one layer of cold water is
identified. It extends from the surface to the bottom.
As the temperature decreases in water with increasing descent, some scientists have
divided the oceans into two broad zones: (i) Photic and Euphotic zone which extends from
the upper surface to 200 metres; the photic zone receives adequate solar insolation; and (ii)
Aphotic zone extending from 200 m to the ocean bottom; this zone does not receive adequate
sunrays.
liquid state) was in 2010, in a stream under an Antarctic glacier and measured -2.6℃
(27.3℉). Seawater pH is typically limited to a range between 7.5 and 8.4. However, there is
no universally accepted reference pH-scale for seawater and the difference between
measurements based on different reference scales may be up to 0.14 units.
Oceans have a great amount of water but it is not suitable for drinking. The main
cause for it to be unsuitable for drinking purpose is the presence of slats in the ocean water. It
would be proper if we call the ocean water a dilute solution of salts. The presence of salts in
ocean water causes salinity which is known as the salinity of ocean water. Salinity is
expressed by the amount of salts dissolved in 1000 gms. of sea water. The salinity is
expressed as 21%.
Salinity is the amount of solid substance (expressed in gms) present in one kilogram
of sea water when all the carbonates are converted into oxides, bromine and iodine replaced
by chlorine and the inorganic substances are oxidized.
The river and sea waters are much different from each other from the point of view of
mineral substances. One thousand tones of sea water contains on any average, 34.75 tones of
salt. According to Joly, 50,000 million tones of salt are present in the oceanic waters. This
salt, it dried, will cover the entire globe with a layer 50 metre thick. If this salt is spread over
land areas, the thickness will be more than 150 metres. The sea level will fall by about 30
metres if the salt is entirely withdrawn from the oceans.
River water has a lot of calcium and bicarbonates but has very low quantity of
sodium, Magnesium and Chlorides. The case is just the reverse in sea water.
Gases are also dissolved in sea water. The main gases are Nitrogen, Oxygen and
Carbon-di-oxide. It is estimated that the amount of Carbon-di-oxide in atmosphere is 2,200
billion tones but according to T. Schloesing the quantity of Carbon-di-oxide in oceans is 18
to 27 times that in atmosphere.
Chemical composition of Ocean Water – The salts and their composition in water is
given in the following table: -
About half of the known elements are found in sea water. All the gases present in
atmosphere are also found dissolved in sea water to some extent . According to weight, 55 %
Chlorine and 31% Sodium constitute the mineral content of oceans. Besides the five salts
mentioned above, some important elements present in sea water are Bromine, Carbon,
Strontium, Boron, Silicon, Fluorine, etc.
If the various specimens of sea water of different parts of oceans and seas are
considered, the ratio of the main slats is almost the same built there is a variation in the
salinity in them. Isohalines are drawn on the sea surface or at any depth of water to express
salinity. Isohaline is an imaginary line drawn to join places having equal salinity.
1. Sea water is a weak, but complex solution made up of many things including mineral
salts and decayed biologic matter from marine organism. Most of the ocean’s salts are
derived from gradual processes, such as weathering and erosion of the earth’s crust and
mountains by the dissolving action of rains and streams.
Some of the ocean’s salts have been dissolved from rocks and sediments below the
sea floor, while other have escaped from the Earth’s crust though volcanic vents as solid and
gaseous materials.
Salts become concentrated in the sea because the sun’s heat evaporates almost pure
water from the surface of the ocean, leaving the salts behind. This process is part of the
continual exchange water between the Earth and the atmosphere, called the hydrologic cycle.
Water vapour rises from the ocean surface through evaporation and in carried
landward by the winds in the form of clouds and humidity. When the vapor in the cloud
collides with a colder mass of air, the moisture condenses (changes from a gas to a liquid)
and falls to Earth as rain.
The rain runs off into streams or underground as ground water, both of which
transport water back to the sea.
Evaporation from both the land and the ocean again causes water to return to the
atmosphere as vapour and the cycle starts anew.
Natural products like dissolved salts are not the only chemicals that are transported by
rivers to the sea.
Rivers and surface runoff are not the only source of dissolved salts. Hydrothermal
vents are recently discovered features on the crest of oceanic ridges that contribute dissolved
minerals to the oceanic. These vents are the exit point on the ocean floor from which sea
water that has seeped into the rocks of the oceanic crust has become hotter, has dissolved
some of the minerals from the crust and then flows back into the ocean. With the hot water
comes large amount of dissolved minerals. Estimates of the amount of hydrothermal fluids
now flowing from these vents indicate that the entire volume of the oceans could seep
through the oceanic crust in about 10 million years. Thus, this process has a very important
effect on salinity. The reactions between sea water and oceanic basalt, the rock of ocean
crust, are not one way, however; some of the dissolved salts react with the rock and are
removed from sea water.
A final process that provides salts to the oceanic submarine volcanism, the eruption of
volcanoes under water. This is similar to the previous process in the sea water is reacting
with hot rock a dissolving some of mineral constituents.
The salinity of water in the surface layer of oceans depends mainly on evaporation
and precipitation.
Surface salinity is greatly influenced in coastal regions by the fresh water flow, rivers
and in polars by the processes of freezing and thawing of ice.
Wind, also influences salinity of an area by transferring to other areas.
The ocean currents contribute to the salinity variations.
Salinity, temperature and density of water are interrelated. Hence, any change in the
temperature or density influences the salinity of an area.
The salinity variation in the Pacific Ocean is mainly due to its shape and lager areal
extent.
In the Atlantic Ocean the average salinity of the Atlantic Ocean is around 36-37. The
equatorial region of the Atlantic Ocean has a salinity of about 35. Near the equator, there is
heavy rainfall, high relative humidity, cloudiness and clam air of the doldrums. The polar
areas experience very little evaporation and receive large amounts of fresh water from the
melting of ice. This leads to low levels of salinity, ranging between 20 and 32. Maximum
salinity 37 is observed between 20° North and 30° West to 60° West. It gradually decreases
towards the north.
In the Indian Ocean the average salinity of the Indian Ocean is 35. The low salinity
trend is observed in the Bay of Bengal due to influx of river water by the River Ganga. On
the contrary, the Arabian Sea shows higher salinity due to high evaporation and low influx of
fresh water.
Marginal Seas
The North Sea, inspite of its location in higher latitudes, records higher salinity due to
more saline water brought by the North Atlantic Drift.
Baltic Sea records low salinity due to influx of river waters in large quantity.
The Mediterranean Sea records higher salinity due to high evaporation.
Salinity is, however, very low in Black Sea due to enormous fresh water influx by
rivers.
10.12 CONCLUSION
The main source of heat for the oceans is the sun but due to certain special
characteristics, the heating of water is quite different from that of land. That specific heat of
water is five times as much as that of land. Besides, evaporation, which is always going on
over the surface of the ocean, is a cooling process. Because of these reasons, water takes
longer time to be heated and cooled. Therefore in comparison with land area, the water is
heated after a longer time and so it cools off late as well. The result is that in winters oceans
are warmer than the surrounding land areas and summers find them a little cooler.
The temperature of the ocean water varies according to latitude, depth and salinity.
Besides these, the prevalent winds, currents and continental margins also modify the
temperature of the ocean water. The temperature varies with salinity. The greater the salinity
the higher is the temperature.
The water of the sea is brackish or saline. This is due to (1) the rivers, which bring
huge amounts of mineral salts dissolved in water; (2) evaporation, which transforms water
into vapour and makes the mineral content of the ocean increase every year; (3) the meager
amount of fresh water coming into the oceans through precipitation.
As these factors are not the same everywhere, the salinity of the ocean differs from
place to place. Along with salinity, the density of ocean waters also varies. In hot deserts,
where the rainfall is meager and evaporation excessive, density is high, the percentage of
salinity being very large. The percentage of salinity and density of the ocean water is low in
those cold regions, where large amounts of fresh water are added by the melting of ice.
Although the salinity of the ocean water is 36% on an average, it is the highest near
the Tropics of Cancer and Capricorn, it is the lowest near the polar region but it varies widely
in open oceans and those bound by land.
The salinity of the water not only affects the density but also its colour and
temperature. It the salinity is high, the colour of water will be deep blue but if it is less, the
colour will be green. The temperature of saline water is higher. Therefore, the lower the
mineral content of the water, the lower will be its temperature.
10.13 SUMMARY
Two of the most important characteristics of sea water are: temperature and salinity–
together they control its density, which is the major factor governing the vertical movement
of ocean waters. Because the seawater signature of temperature and salinity are acquired by
processes occurring at the air-sea interface, we can also state that the density characteristics
of a parcel of sea water are determined when it is at the sea surface. Temperatures of sea
water vary widely (-1 to 30℃ ), where as the salinity range is small (35.0 ± 2.0). The North
Atlantic contains the warmest and saltiest water of the major oceans, the Southern Ocean (the
region around Antarctica) is the coldest, and the North Pacific has the lowest average
salinity.
Temperature and salinity both affect the density of water. Hence all those things
which affect temperature and salinity also affect density of ocean water.
10.14 GLOSSARY
Electromagnetic = Waves of energy propagated through space at the speed of
light.
Insolation = From incoming solar radiation, this is the solar radiation
received at the earth’s surface. The amount of insolation
varies with latitude, since the angle of the sun’s rays and the
duration of daylight change with latitude and season.
Q.2 What is the meant by ocean salinity? Account for the difference in ocean salinity and
describe its effects on ocean currents.
10.16 REFERENCES
1. Ahmed, A., 1993, Physical Geography, Rawat Publication, Jaipur.
4. Tikka, R.N., 1994-95, Physical Geography, Kedar Nath Ram Nath & Co., Meerut.
2. Tikka, R. N. (1995) Physical Geography, Kedar Nath Ram Nath & Co., Meerut.
Q.2 Explain: “The Salinity in the ocean water is not the same everywhere.”
Q.3 Explain with illustration the factors that influence the horizontal distribution of
temperature on the land surface.
Q.4 Describe the temperature of the ocean water with the special reference of daily and
annual ranges.
11.1 OBJECTIVES
11.2 INTRODUCTION
11.3 CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER: CONCEPT
11.4 OCEAN WAVES
11.5 OCEAN CURRENTS: MEANING
11.5.1 ORIGIN OF THE CURRENTS
11.5.2 CURRENTS OF ATLANTIC OCEAN
11.5.3 CURRENTS OF PACIFIC OCEAN
11.5.4 CURRENTS OF INDIAN OCEAN
11.6 TIDES: MEANING AND CONCEPTS
11.6.1 TIME OF TIDES
11.6.2 TYPES OF TIDE
11.6.3. THEORIES OF THE ORIGIN OF TIDES
11.7 CONCLUSION
11.8 SUMMARY
11.9 GLOSSARY
11.10 ANSWERS TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
11.11 REFERENCES
11.12 SUGGESTED READINGS
11.13 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 198 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
11.1 OBJECTIVES
To know about the various oceanic phenomena
Differentiate between currents, waves and tides
Know about the different types of currents
To know about the world distribution of ocean currents
To know the origin of tides and their importance
11.2 INTRODUCTION
Can we think of life without water? It is said that water is life. Water is an essential
component of all life forms that exist over the surface of the Earth. The creatures on the Earth
are lucky that it is a water planet; otherwise we all would have no existence. Water is a rare
commodity in our solar system. The Earth fortunately has an abundant supply of water on its
surface. Hence our planet is called the “Blue Planet’. The water on Earth is also of very
types. We will read about ocean water, in particular, in this chapter.
The ocean water is dynamic. Its physical characteristics like temperature, salinity,
density and the external forces like the sun, moon and the winds influence the movement of
ocean water. The horizontal and vertical motions are common in water bodies. The
horizontal motion refers to the ocean currents and waves. The vertical motion refers to tides.
Ocean currents are the continuous flow of huge amount of water in a definite direction while
the waves are the horizontal motion of water. Water moves ahead from one place to another
through ocean currents while the water in the waves does not move, but the wave trains move
ahead. The vertical motion refers to the rise and fall of water in the oceans and seas. Due to
attraction of the sun and the moon, the ocean water is raised up and falls down twice a day.
The upwelling of cold water from subsurface and the sinking of surface water are also forms
of vertical motion of ocean water.
One of the best examples is the Gulf Stream. This current creates in the north Western
Europe more temperate conditions. Another instance is the Hawaiian Islands, where the
climate is cooler (sub tropical) than the tropical latitudes in which they are located, due to the
effect of the California current.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 199 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 11.1
1. Wave crest and trough: The highest and lowest points of a wave are called the crest
and trough respectively.
2. Wave height: It is the vertical distance from the bottom of a trough to the top of a
crest of a wave.
3. Wave amplitude: It is one-half of the wave height.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 200 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
4. Wave period: It is merely the time interval between two successive wave crests or
troughs as they pass a fixed point.
5. Wavelength: It is the horizontal distance between two successive crests.
6. Wave speed: It is the rate at which the wave moves through the water, and is
measured in knots.
7. Wave frequency: It is the number of waves passing a given point during a one
second time interval.
The forward movement of the surface water of the oceans under the influence of
prevailing winds is called drift, whereas currents movement of a mass of oceanic water in a
definite direction with greater velocity. Ocean stream involves the movement of larger mass
of oceanic water like big rivers of the continent in a definite direction with a greater velocity
than a drift or current, e.g., Gulf Stream.
The prevailing planetary winds (trade winds, westerlies and polar winds) play vital
roles in the origin and development of ocean currents. Most of the Earth’s surface energy is
concentrated in each hemisphere’s trade winds and westerlies. Tiny irregularities in the sea
surface, called capillary waves, transfer some of the energy from the moving air to the water
by friction. This tug of wind on the ocean surface begins a more rapid mass flow of water. As
a rule, the friction of wind blowing for atleast ten hours will cause surface water to flow
downward at about 2% of wind speed. The water flowing beneath the wind forms the surface
current.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 201 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Because of the Coriolis Effect, the Northern Hemisphere currents flow to the right of
the wind direction while in the Southern Hemisphere currents flow to the left. Intervening
continents and basin topography often block continuous flow and help to deflect the Moving
water into a circular pattern.This flow around the periphery of an ocean basin is called gyre
(gyros=circle). Two gyres are shown in Figs. 11.2, 11.3 and 11.4. Most of the ocean currents
of the world follow the direction of prevailing, permanent and planetary winds. For example,
the equatorial current flow westward at a speed of 40 km (25 miles) per hour, under the
impact of the trade winds.
Figure 11.2
A combination of Four Forces-the sun’s heat, winds, the Corolis Effect and Gravity-circulates the
ocean surface clockwise in the Northern Hemisphere and anti-clockwise in Southern Hemisphere.
Gyres thus formed are shown.
Figure 11.3
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 202 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The North Atlantic Gyre, a series of four interconnecting currents each with different flow,
characteristics and temperatures
The Gulf Stream in the Atlantic Ocean and Kuroshio in the Pacific Ocean move in the
North-eastern direction under the influence of the anti-trade (westerlies) winds (Figure 11.5).
Many of the ocean currents are drifts caused by the friction between the winds and the
surface water. They move more or less in the direction of the wind and vary in position and
strength with the seasonal winds, e.g., Indian Monsoons.
Figure 11.4
General summer air circulation patterns of the east and west coasts of United States
There is a marked variation in the horizontal and vertical distribution of the oceans. In
general, the temperature decreases from the equator towards the poles and from the surface
towards the bottom of the seas and oceans. Thus, in the equatorial region the density of water
decreases due to high temperature. There is a negative correlation between the temperature
received and the density of water, which means higher the temperature, lower the density of
water, and vice versa.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 203 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 11.5
Surface water blown by winds at a point ‘A’ will veer to the right of its initial path and
continue eastward. Water at point ‘B’ veers right and continues westward
As a result of this the less warm and lighter water from the equatorial region moves
toward the colder and denser water of the polar areas. Contrary to this, there is a movement
of ocean water below the water surface in the form of sub-surface current from the colder
polar areas to warmer equatorial areas. The Gulf Stream and Kuroshio (warm currents)
moving from equator towards North Pole and the Labrador and Kurile currents moving from
polar areas towards equator are some of such examples.
The amount of salts contained in sea water does not vary from one part of the ocean
to another. Water with a high salinity is denser than that with lower amounts of salts. The
high salinity water tends to subside and move below the water of less salinity to the areas of
high salinity. There is marked variation in the salinity of Atlantic Ocean and the
Mediterranean Sea. Because of this variation, the ocean currents flow from the Atlantic
Ocean to the Mediterranean Sea. A similar ocean current may be observed between the
Indian Ocean and the Red Sea via Bab-el-Mandeb. An identical pattern is found in the Baltic
Sea and the North Sea. The Peru Current may also be cited as an example of a current which
has its origin because of the variation in the density of water.
The Earth rotates on its axis, from west to east. The rotation is the cause of deflective
force known as ‘Corolis Force’, which deflects the general direction of the winds and that of
the ocean currents. For example, the currents flowing from equator towards the north and
south poles are deflected to their right in the Northern Hemisphere and towards their left in
the Southern Hemisphere, respectively. The counter-equatorial currents are also the result of
rotation of the Earth.
The shape and configuration of the coastlines also have a close influence on the
direction and movement of the ocean currents. For example, the equatorial current after being
obstructed by the Brazilian coasts is bifurcated into two branches. The northern branch is
known as the Caribbean current flowing along the northern coast of South America, while
the southern branch moves along the eastern coast of Brazil, which is known as the Brazilian
current. In the India Ocean, the monsoon currents closely follow the coastlines.
In addition to the shape of coastline, the configuration of the bottom relief also
modifies the direction of movement of the ocean currents. Generally, the ocean currents
while crossing over a submarine ridgeare deflected to the right in the Northern Hemisphere
and to the left in the Southern Hemisphere. For Example, the North Atlantic Drift is deflected
to the right when it crosses the Wyville-Thomas ridge. Similarly, the north equatorial
currentis deflected to the right while crossing over mid-Atlantic ridge.
Normally, the north equatorial current is formed between the equator 10ºN latitude.
This current is generated because of upwelling of cold water near the west coast of Africa.
This warm current is also pushed is also pushed westward by the cold Canary current. On an
average, the north equatorial warm current flows from east to west but this saline current is
deflected northward when it crosses the Mid-Atlantic Ridge near 15ºN latitude. It again turns
southwards after crossing over the ridge. This current after being obstructed by the land
barrier of the east coast of Brazil, is bifurcated into two branches-Antilles current and
Caribbean current. The Antilles current is diverted northwards and flows to the east of West
Indies islands, and helps in the formation of Sargasso Sea, while the second branch known as
the Caribbean current enters the Gulf of Mexico and becomes Gulf Stream.
South Equatorial Current flows from the western coast of Africa to the eastern coast
of South America between the equator and 20ºS latitude. This current is more constant,
stronger and of great extent than the north equatorial current. In fact, this current is the
continuation of the Benguala current. The warm current is bifurcated into two branches due
to obstruction of and barrier in the form of the east coast of Brazil. The northward branches
after taking north-westerly course merges with the north equatorial current near Trinidad
while the second branch turns southward and continues as Brazil warm current parallel to the
east coast of South America. This current is basically originated under the stress of trade
winds.
The Counter-equatorial Current flows from west to east between the westward
flowing strong north and south equatorial currents. This current is less developed in the west
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 205 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
due to stress of trade winds. In fact, the counter current mixes with the equatorial currents in
the west but it’s more developed in the east where it is known as the Guinea Stream.
Along the coastof Florida, the average surface temperature of the Gulf Stream reads
about 25ºC. Moving northward at 30ºN, the surface temperature decrease to about 10ºC. The
general direction of flow of the Gulf Stream, north of the 30ºN latitude, is northward, but
beyond Cape Hatteras it bends slowly to the right, passing the 350 km south of Natucket until
the south of Halifax the flow is nearly due east. Where the Gulf Stream leaves the continental
shelf at Cape Hatteras, its average width is about 82 km. Eastward, it widens gradually,
becoming 120 km wide in the longitude of Halifax. The temperature of water near the coasts
of 40ºN ranges between 4ºC and 10ºC. Moving along the east coast of the United States, it is
strengthened by the prevailing westerly winds and is deflected to the east between 35ºN and
45ºN latitudes. Near Newfoundland its water mixes with that of the cold water current of
Labrador which results in formation of dense fog. The dense foggy conditions around the
Newfoundland are hazardous to the navigation of ships. Gulf Stream flows in 55 million
cubic meters water per second, about 300 times the usual flow of Amazon, the greatest of
rivers.
As the Gulf Stream continuous north-eastward beyond the Grand Bank, it gradually
widens and decreases its speed until it becomes a vast, slow moving current known as the
North Atlantic Drift. As the North Atlantic Drift approaches Western Europe, it splits. Part of
it moves northward, past Great Britain and Norway. The other part is deflected southward as
the cool Canaries current.
The warm water current of the Gulf Stream modifies the weather conditions of the
eastern coast of U.S.A. and Canada, and the western coast of Europe. The temperature of the
eastern coast of U.S.A. becomes significantly high during the summer months. On the
western coast of Europe, the warm water of this current keeps the sea port open upto 70ºN,
even in the severe winter season and make the climate and weather milder.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 206 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
merges with the north equatorial current. The Canary cold current ameliorates the otherwise
hot weather conditions of the western coast of North Africa.
It originates in the Baffin Bay and Davis Strait and after flowing through the coastal
waters of Newfoundland and Grand Bank merges with the Gulf Stream around 50ºW
longitude. The flow discharge rate of the current is 7.5 million m3 of water per second. This
current along with it bring a large number of big icebergs as far as south as Newfoundland
and Grand Bank. These icebergs present effective hindrances in the oceanic navigation.
Dense fogs are also produced due to the convergence of the Labrador cold current and the
Gulf Stream near Newfoundland.
Along the eastern coast of Brazil flowing from north to south upto 40ºS is the warm
water current of Brazil. The surface temperature of the current reads about 25ºC in the north
and about 15ºC at 40ºS. The average speed of the current varies between 28 km per day. It
ameliorates the weather conditions along the eastern coast of Argentina.
The Falkland Current has its origin in the Antarctic Ocean around 65ºS. It flows from
south to north. The average speed of this current is about 18 km per day. It brings large sized
icebergs from the Antarctic Ocean to make the Falkland and eastern coast of south Argentina
cold.
The Benguela Current flows from south to north along the western coast of South
Africa. In fact, the South Atlantic Drift turns northward due to the obstruction caused by the
southern tip of Africa. Further northwards this current merges with the South Equatorial
Current.
The eastward movement of the Brazilian Current is known as the South Atlantic
Drift. It develops at 40ºS owing to the impact of the westerlies which are known as the
roaries forties. Consequently, it is also known as the westerlies drift or the Antarctic Drift.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 207 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The north equatorial current flows westward which originates around 10ºN to the
west of Mexico (North America). Moving westward, almost parallel to the line of equator, it
reaches the coasts of Philippines after covering a distance of about 12,000 km. The Pacific
Ocean is too wide in the lower latitudes and, therefore, a greater volume of water is involved.
After reaching the coast of Philippines, under the impact of Corolis force, it takes a northerly
direction. Its surface temperature varies between 25ºC to 30ºC. The speed of the currents
ranges between 10 km and 25 km per day.
Under the impact of south-east trade winds, the south equatorial current originates to
the west of Peru around 10ºS latitude. It is one of the strongest currents. The speed of the
current varies between 16 km to 30 km per day. The surface temperature of its water reads
between 20ºC to 25ºC.
Both the north and south equatorial current flows westward, with a compensatory
counter-current flowing in the reverse direction between them along a line about 5ºN. The
counter-equatorial current reaches upto Panama.
Kuroshio is the most important warm water current of the North Pacific Ocean. It is
analogous to the Gulf Stream of the Atlantic Ocean. It develops partly due to the Corolis
force and partly due to the obstruction of the Philippines in the flow of the north equatorial
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 208 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
current. The average surface temperature of these current remains around 18ºC. It moves at a
speed of about 30 km per day. It keeps the eastern coast of Japan warm even in the coldest
month (January) when snowing is frequent in Honshu and Hokkaido.
An offshoot of Kuroshio Current, also known as Tsushima current, enters into the Sea
of Japan along the west coast of the islands. The relatively warm water of Tsushima current
keeps the western coast of Japan warm. Around 35ºN, the Kuroshio current under the impact
of westerlies, leaves the coast of Japan and adopts a north-easterly direction, and reaches the
western coast of North America around 150ºW. Further north it is known as the Aleutian
current.
This cold current originates from the Bering Strait and moving in southerly direction
touches the island of Kurile, wherefrom it is called Kurile Current. It transports the cold
water of the Arctic Sea into the Pacific Ocean. Near 50ºN latitude this current is bifurcated
into two branches. One branch turns eastward and merges with the Aleutian and Kuroshio
Currents. The second branch moves upto the Japanese coasts. This current is comparable to
the cold Labrador Current of the North Atlantic Ocean. The convergence of cold Oyashio
(Kurile) and warm Kuroshio Current causes dense fog which become potential hazards for
navigation.
The California Current,an example of cold current, is similar to the Canary current of
Atlantic Ocean in most of its characteristics. In fact, his current is the eastward extended
portion of the North Atlantic Drift. The cold California Current is generated because of the
movement of oceanic water along the Californian coast from north to south in order to
compensate the loss of water which is caused due to large-scale transport of water off the
coast of Mexico under the influence of trade winds in the form of north equatorial current.
The current after reaching the Mexican coast turns westward and merges with the north
equatorial current.
The cold current flowing along the western coast of South America from south to
north is called Peru Current or Humboldt Current. This current is known as Peru coastal
current while it is called Peru oceanic current off the coast. Mean annual temperature ranges
between 14ºC and 17ºC and the average velocity of moving water is 15 nautical miles (27
km) per day. The temperature of the sea water increases from the coast towards the ocean.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 209 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
In the summer season in the northern parts of Indian Ocean, the monsoon winds blow
from south-west to north-east. Consequently, the ocean currents follow the general direction
of summer monsoon.
In the winter season the monsoon winds blow from north-east to south-west.
Influenced by the direction of winds, the ocean currents flow from north-east to south-west.
In brief, in the Indian Ocean, the ocean currents are closely controlled by the south-west and
north-east monsoons.
Like Pacific and Atlantic Oceans eastwards flowing current, known as west wind
drift, is also generated in the Indian Ocean. The current is produce due to eastward blowing
westerlies along 40ºN latitude is known as ‘roaring forties’. This current bifurcates in two
branches near 110ºE longitude. One branch turns northward and flows as West Australia cold
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 210 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
current along the western coast of Australia and near the Tropic of Capricorn turns towards
west and north-west and ultimately merges with the south equatorial current near 100ºE
longitude. The second branch of the west wind drift turns southward.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 211 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 11.7
The tidal bulges on wide continental shelves have greater height. When tidal bulges
hit the mid-oceanic islands they become low. The shape of bays and estuaries along a
coastline can also magnify the intensity of tides. Funnel-shaped bays greatly change tidal
magnitudes. When the tide is channeled between islands or into bays and estuaries they are
called tidal currents.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 212 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Let us understand this process with the help of a diagram (Figure 11.8).
Figure 11.8
Suppose if ‘P’ experiences first tide at 4 p.m., the second tide will occur at 4:26 a.m.
and the next tide will be experienced at 4:52 p.m. The moon is at ‘K’ location and the place
‘P’ on the Earth’s water surface under the moon (K) will experience the tide at 4 p.m. The
place ‘P’ after completing its full rotation in 24 hours to come to its original place but by that
time the moon moves to ‘L’ position which is above ‘F’ place on the Earth’s surface. Now
the place ‘P’ has cover extra distance P-F so that it may come under L position of the moon
and ‘P’ may experience next tide. The earth has to spend 52 minutes to cover P-F distance.
The moon completes its one revolution around the Earth in 27 days, 7 hours, 43 minutes and
17.5 seconds (average 27.5 days). Thus, the P-F distance is 2/55th part of the moon’s orbit.
The place ‘P’ will take 24×60×2/55=52 minutes to cover the distance of 2/55 (P-F) part of
the moon’s orbit, therefore, the place ‘P’ will experience next tide at 4:26 a.m. when it is at
‘O’ place and subsequent tide occur s 4:52 p.m. It is evident that at each place every day tide
occurs after 12 hours 26 minutes and after the tide, ebboccurs after 6 hours 13 minutes. It
may be pointed out that each place experiences tide twice a day, i.e., when the place is under
the moon and when the place is at the opposite side of the moon and thus each tide at
particular place is delayed by 26 minutes.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 213 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The height of rising water (high tide) varies appreciably depending upon the position
of sun and moon with respect to the earth. Spring tides and neap tides come under this
category.
i. Spring tides: The position of both the sun and the moon in relation to the earth has
direct bearing on tide height. When the sun, the moon and the earth are in a straight
line, the height of the tide will be higher. These are called spring tides and they
occur twice a month, one on full moon period and another during new moon period.
ii. Neap tides: Normally, there is a seven day interval between the spring tides and
neap tides. At this time the sun and moon are at right angles to each other and the
forces of the sun and moon tend to counteract one another. The Moon’s attraction,
though more than twice as strong as the sun’s, is diminished by the counteracting
force of the sun’s gravitational pull.
Once in a month, when the moon’s orbit is closest to the earth (perigee), unusually
high and low tides occur. During this time the tidal range is greater than normal. Two weeks
later, when the moon is farthest from earth (apogee), the moon’s gravitational force is limited
and the tidal ranges are less than their average heights.
When the earth is closest to the sun (perihelion), around 3rd January each year, tidal
ranges are also much greater, with unusually high and unusually low tides. When the earth is
farthest from the sun (aphelion), around 4th July each year, tidal ranges are much less than
average.
The time between the high tide and low tide, when the water level is falling, is called
the ebb. The time between the low tide and high tide, when the tide is rising, is called the
flow or flood.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 214 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
This theory was put forward on the basis of Newton’s law of Gravitation (1686),
which states that each body in the universe attracts every other body with a force directly
proportional to the product of their masses and inversely proportional to the square of the
distance between them measures from their centres of mass along a line joining these centres.
In other words, the celestial bodies attract each other through their gravitational force in such
a way that they remain in equilibrium. The sun, the moon, and the Earth are also in
equilibrium due to their respective pull towards each other. Though the gravitational force of
the sun is far greater than that of the moon, but the lunar gravitational force has more effect
on the Earth than the sun because of its nearness to the Earth. As a result of this, the water of
the Earth’s surface under the moon is attracted and pulled and high tide is caused. The
opposite side of the Earth’s surface also experiences tide because of the centrifugal or
reactionary force. Because of the force of gravitation, the highest point of rise of water (high
tides) lies nearest to and farthest away from the moon, while the lowest points of the water
surface (low tides) lie at places perpendicular to the above places.
The theory has not been universally accepted as it does not explain some of the points
about the occurenc3 of tides. For example, the Earth’s surface is composed of land (29%)
and oceans (71%). Owing to the nature of composition of the earth’s surface, the moon will
not be as effective as it would have been, if the Earth’s surface would have been composed of
only water.
The theory also does not explain how the tides occur in the areas of oceans where the
horizontal movement of water is absent or insignificant. According to the scientists, the bulge
of water may not be possible unless some sort of horizontal movement of tide is involved.
In addition to these, one more criticism about the equilibrium theory is about the time
of occurrence of tides. For example, the time of high tide should be the same at all places
along each meridian but this never happens.
In view of the above weaknesses Airy opposed this theory and declared it erroneous
as it does not explain the origin of tides as a result of the gravitational force.
The Earth is a heterogeneous body and not a perfect fluid (surrounded by water on all
sides).
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 215 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Because of the above facts, the tidal waves are generated in the oceans of the
Southern Hemisphere, under the influence of tide-producing force of the moon. These waves
are called as the primary waves which move from east to west in the form of force waves.
The primary waves are obstructed by the continents and are consequently refracted
northward. Consequently, the secondary waves are generated when the westward movement
of primary waves is obstructed by land masses. The northward moving secondary waves are
also called as the derived waves. Further minor waves are generated from these secondary
waves, which may be termed as the tertiary waves. The secondary and tertiary waves move
northward with decreasing intensity and magnitude but generate tides everywhere. It may be
mentioned that the primary waves are influenced by the moon but the tertiary or minor waves
move freely.
Thus, the tidal waves after being originated in the oceans of Southern Hemisphere,
Progressively move northward with continuous lag of time and dissipation of wave energy.
In other words the arrival of these progressive waves at successive places northward along
the same longitude is also progressively delayed. This explains the delay in the occurrence of
tide at different places on the same longitude. Thus, the time of tide is progressively delayed
northward along the longitude. These progressive waves become insignificant and ineffective
after reaching the North Pole. Moreover, the crests and troughs of these waves after reaching
the coasts cause tides and ebbs respectively.
The progressive wave theory is, however, not free from criticism. According to this
theory, the age of tides increases northwards. In other words, if the tide is generated in the
south on a particular longitude, it reaches quite late at the points located further north on the
same longitude. Normally, the tides are local or regional phenomena rather than phenomena
originating in the southern ocean and moving progressively northward. At some of the
latitudes, both the daily and semi-diurnal types of tides are observed. Moreover, there is
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 216 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
spatial variation in the irregularity of tides in different oceans. These variations cannot be
explained on the basis of the progressive wave theory.
This theory was propounded by R. A. Harris of the Geodetic Survey of U.S.A. This
theory, which was developed as a reaction to the progressive wave theory, gives an
unsatisfactory explanation for the locational differences and variations in tides.
In the opinion of Harris, the phenomenon of tide is not due to progressive waves
which originate in the oceans of Southern Hemisphere as claimed by Whewell, but because
of the stationary waves which originate independently in each ocean. In other words, tides
are regional phenomena.
In the huge water bodies of oceans, the sun and the moon cause oscillations, but the
oscillation does not occur along straight lines. This process results in the formation of waves.
Every stationary wave has a definite time of its oscillation. The oscillation system and
process are affected by the depth, configuration, length and breadth of the ocean basin. These
waves, after their origin, move towards the coasts. The forward movement of these waves is,
however, hampered by the continental peninsulas, islands, bays, gulfs and straits. Reaching
the coasts, the crests and troughs of the waves cause tides and ebbs, respectively. Thus, there
is a positive correlation between the depth of the oceans and the height of the tides. In other
words, greater the depth of the ocean, higher the stationary waves generated which lead to
high or spring tides. Low tides are caused in the shallow seas because, of the lower heights of
the stationary waves.The main advantage of the stationary wave theory lies in the fact that it
helps in making reliable prediction about the magnitude of tides.
11.7 CONCLUSION
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 217 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The chapter states the different types of oceanic currents and the areas which are
affected by them. There are beneficial acceptances of the currents as well as some of them
create problems. The major different between tides and waves is clarified and various kinds
of tides along with their origin theory are explained. All this is done to know about our
oceans more deeply and know about the various phenomenons they possess.
11.8 SUMMARY
Waves are actually the energy, not the water as such, which moves across the ocean
surface.
The general movement of a mass of oceanic water in a definite direction is called
ocean current. Ocean currents are the most powerful of all the dynamics of oceanic
waters because these drive oceanic waters for thousands of kilometers away.
Ocean currents are divided on the basis of:
i. Temperature: a) warm currents and b) cold currents
ii. Velocity, dimension and direction: a) drifts, b) currents and c) streams
The rotation of Earth is the cause of deflective force known as ‘Corolis Force’, which
deflects the general direction of the winds and that of the ocean currents.
The periodical rise and fall of the sea level, once or twice a day, mainly due to the
attraction of the sun and the moon, is called a tide.
Together, the gravitational pull and the centrifugal force are responsible for creating
the major tidal bulges on the earth.
The time between the high tide and low tide, when the water level is falling, is called
the ebb.
The time between the low tide and high tide, when the tide is rising, is called the flow
or flood.
The equilibrium theory was put forward on the basis of Newton’s law of Gravitation
(1686), which states that each body in the universe attracts every other body with a
force directly proportional to the product of their masses and inversely proportional to
the square of the distance between them measures from their centres of mass along a
line joining these centres.
In other words, the celestial bodies attract each other through their gravitational force
in such a way that they remain in equilibrium.
11.9 GLOSSARY
Apogean Tides: The low tides caused at the time when the moon is at the farthest distance
from the Earth, are called Apogean tides, which are 20%lower than the normal tides.
Centrifugal Force: Force that works outward on a body rotating about an axis
Currents: The movement or circulation of ocean water in definite direction with greater
velocity is called current.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 218 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Drifts: The surface ocean currents moving forward under the influence of prevailing winds
are called drifts.
Ebb: The fall of sea water and its movement away from the coast, i.e., towards the sea is
called an ebb.
Gyres: The closed circulation pattern of current flows in the oceans is called gyre.
Ocean Currents: The general movement of mass of ocean water in a definite direction is
called ocean current, which is more or less similar to water stream (river)) draining on the
land surface of Earth.
Perigean Tide: The tide generated at the nearest position of the moon with the Earth is
called Perigean tide, which is 15 to 20 % higher than the normal tides because the tidal force
of the moon is most powerful.
Streams: Ocean streams involve movement of enormous volume of ocean water like big
rivers of the continents, in a definite direction with greater velocity.
Surface Ocean Currents: The ocean currents of surface water of the oceans upto the depth
of 100 meters are called surface ocean currents which involve only 10% of the total water
mass of all the oceans.
Ans.1 Waves are actually the energy provided by wind, to travel in the oceans; whereas
the periodical rise and fall of the sea level, once or twice a day, mainly due to the
attraction of the sun and the moon, is called a tide.
Ans.2 It is an effect caused due to rotation of earth which deflects the direction of surface
winds.
Ans.3 The eastward blowing westerlies along the 40ºN latitude are known as the ‘roaring
forties’.
Ans.2 The fall of sea water and its movement away from the coast, i.e., towards the sea is
called an ebb.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 219 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
11.11 REFERENCES
1. Bascom, W., 1959, “Ocean Waves”, Scientific American, August: 89-97.
2. Bascom, W., 1980, Waves and Beaches, New York, Anchor/ Doubleday.
3. Defant, A., 1958, Ebb and Flow: the Tides of Earth, Air and Water, Michigan, University
of Michigan.
5. Shopmmel, H., 1987, AView of the Sea, New Jersey, Princeton University Express.
6. Wiebe, P., 1982, “Rings of the Gulf Stream”, Scientific American, March 60-79.
7. Shephard, F. P., 1969, The Earth Beneath the Sea, New York, Athneum.
2. Kapion, D., 1989, The Book of Waves, Santa Barbara, Arpel Graphics.
UNIT 11 - CIRCULATION OF OCEAN WATER, CURRENTS & TIDES Page 220 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
12.1 OBJECTIVES
12.2 INTRODUCTION
12.3 MARINE DEPOSITS
12.4 SOURCES AND TYPES OF OCEAN DEPOSITS
12.4.1 TERRIGENOUS DEPOSITS
12.4.2 VOLCANIC MATTER AND DEPOSITS
12.4.3 BIOTIC MATTER AND DEPOSITS
12.4.4 ABIOTIC MATTER AND DEPOSITS
12.5 CLASSIFICATION OF OCEAN DEPOSITS
12.5.1 CLASSIFICATION BASED ON LOCATION
12.5.2 CLASSIFICATION BASED ON DEPTH
12.5.3 GENERAL CLASSIFICATION
12.5.4 CLASSIFICATION BASED ON ORIGIN OF
SEDIMENTS
12.6 DISTRIBUTION OF OCEAN DEPOSITS
12.6.1 SEDIMENT-WISE DISTRIBUTION
12.6.2 MARINE PROVINCE-WISE DISTRIBUTION
12.7 CORAL REEFS: ORIGIN OF CORAL REEFS, MEANING
12.7.1 ORIGIN OF CORAL REEFS
12.8 CONDITIONS FOR THE GROWTH OF CORAL POLYPS
12.9 TYPES OF CORAL REEFS
12.9.1 FRINGING REEFS
12.9.2 BARRIER REEFS
12.9.3 ATOLLS
12.10 CORAL BLEACHING
12.11CONCLUSION
12.12 SUMMARY
12.13 GLOSSARY
12.14 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
12.15 REFERENCES
12.16 SUGGESTED READINGS
12.17 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 221 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
12.1 OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter, you should be able:
12.2 INTRODUCTION
The Earth is majorly divided into continents and oceans. The landmasses turn out to
be a major living habitat whereas; the oceans are the living habitat of only the aquatic group
of worldwide plants and animals. However, the oceans provide a single different world in
itself. The physiography and biological phenomenon of the oceans is not at all lesser than
that of the terrestrial ecosystem. Here we will learn today the different types of sediments and
depositional factors which make this thing happen.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 222 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Sands: - The sediments varying in diameter from 1mm to 1/16mm are termed as sands.
On the basis of size of grains sands are classified as: (i) very coarse sands (1mm), (ii)
coarse sands (0.5mm), (iii) medium sands (0.25mm), (iv) fine sands (0.125mm), and (v)
very fine sands (0.0625mm). The disintegration of continental rock fragments into fine
sediments produces sands which are deposited in the oceans by the rivers, surface wash
and winds. There is a marked gradation of sand deposits in the oceans i.e. coarser sands
are deposited close to the coast while fine sands are deposited away from the coast.
Silt, Clay and Mud: -The finer sediments ranging in diameter from 1/32 mm to 1/8192
mm are grouped under the category silt, clay and mud. Silt comes under 1/32 mm to
1/256 mm whereas clay under 588/8/87/256 to 1/8192 mm. Mud is much finer than clay
as clay is a cementing element. Clay and mud are deposited in calm seawater. Generally,
these deposits are found at the depth of 100 to1000 fathoms (600 to 6000 feet). Murray
has divided mud into three types on the basis of colour:
i. Blue mud includes the materials derived through the denudation of rocks rich in iron
sulphide and organic elements. These are generally found at the greater depths of the
continental shelves. The original colour of blue mud s bluish black and it contains
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 223 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
TABLE 12.1
Particle Size and Settling Rate in Sediment
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 224 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
ii. Volcanic eruptions in the oceans and the seas- in such cases volcanic materials are
directly deposited. Volcanic materials resemble blue mud and are grey and black in
colour.
i. Neritic matters deposited mainly on the continental shelves and are generally covered
by terrigenous materials. Shells of mollusks and their fragments, skeletons of
radiolarian and spicules of sponges, calcareous and siliceous plant remains.
ii. Pelagic matters are the deposits derived from algae and are mostly in the form of
liquid mud, generally known as ooze. These oozes of pelagic materials are divided
into two categories on the basis of lime and silica contents in them.
Calcareous oozes: contain lime contents in abundance and are seldom found at
greater depths because of their high degree of solubility. They are generally found at
the depths of the sea floor ranging from 1000 fathoms to 2000 fathoms, i.e., 6000-
12000 ft. On the basis of principal organisms, calcareous oozes are further divided
into two sub-types:
Pteropod Ooze: They are generally conical in shape with half an inch of average
diameter. These cones are formed by the floating pteropod molluscs having thin
shells. It is found in the tropical seas and oceans at the depths of 300-1000 fathoms. It
decreases with greater depths and practically disappears beyond 2000-fathom bar. It
contains 80% calcium carbonate and is found mostly in the region of corals. Pacific
Ocean, Canary Island, Mediterranean submarine ridge, Indian Ocean, etc are some
main locations of pteropod ooze.
Globigerina Ooze: Though this ooze is formed from the shells of a variety of
foraminifera but most of such oozes are formed of, germs called globigerina. Its
chemical composition is somewhat 64.46% of calcium, 1.64% of silica and 3.33% of
minerals. Found mainly at the depths of 2000-4000 fathoms, the deposit dries up and
becomes dirty white powder, giving the ooze a milky white colour. Besides having a
milky white colour, it is also blue, grey, yellow and green in colour. Globigerina is
found mostly in tropical and temperate zones of Atlantic Ocean, eastern and western
continental shelves of the Indian Ocean and eastern Pacific Ocean.
Siliceous Ooze: is formed when the silica is obtained in abundance from a group of
protozoa and radiolarians and benthic animals mainly sponges. The ooze does not
dissolve as compared to calcareous ooze because of less calcium carbonate and
dominance of silica. Due to this, these oozes are found in both warm and cold water
at greater depths. This group is also divided into two sub-types on the basis of
dominance of a particular organism:
Radiolarian ooze: This ooze is formed by the shells of radiolarian and foraminifera.
It changes to dirty grey powder when dried. Silica is predominant but calcium
carbonate is also present between 5-2%. Lime content decreases with increased
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 225 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
depths and absolutely disappears at greater depths. The ooze is found up to 2000-
5000 fathoms covering the largest areas in the Pacific Ocean. The ooze is the home of
tropical oceans and seas.
Diatom ooze: The diatom ooze contains the shells of microscopic plants having silica
in abundance. It also has some clayey content whereas calcium content varies from 3-
30%.The diatom ooze is found mainly at greater depths in high latitudes. It is blue
near the land and the colour changes yellow or cream away from the land and it
becomes a coherent white powder when dried. The areas of this deposit include the
zone around Antarctica and the belt from Alaska to Japan in the N. Pacific at depth of
600-2000 fathoms.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 226 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Generally ocean deposits are locationally classified into the following two categories:
Shelf deposits
Pelagic deposits
Shelf deposits include the deposition of marine sediments of the variable origin on the floors
of continental shelve, while pelagic deposits consists of sedimentation of fine particles on the
floors of deep sea plains.
Classification of Murray: Sir John Murray has classified the ocean deposits into to broad
categories viz. (a) terrigenous deposits, and (b) pelagic deposits.
Classification of Jenkins:Jenkins has divided marine deposits into three groups viz (a)
deep sea deposits, (b) shallow water deposits, and (c) littoral deposits.
a) Pelagic deposits
Red clay
Radiolarian ooze
Diatom ooze
Globigernia ooze
Pteropod ooze
b) Terrigenous deposits
Blue mud
Red mud
Green mud
Coral mud
Volcanic mud
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 227 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
a) Gravels
b) Sands
c) Mud
3. Littoral Deposits (between high and low tide water)
a) Gravels
b) Sands
c) Mud
2. Neritic Deposits
a) Shallow Water Neritic Deposits
b) Deep Seawater Neritic Deposits
c) Pelagic Deposits
d) Radiolarian Ooze
e) Globigerina Ooze
f) Pteropod Ooze
2. Hemi pelagic Deposits (partly from land and partly from marine origin)
a) Green Mud
b) Volcanic Mud
c) Coral Mud
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 228 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
deep-sea sediments are of biogenous of origin.Sediments of the slope, rise and deep-ocean
floor that originate in the ocean are called pelagic sediments (Pelagius=of the sea). The
distribution and average thickness of the marine sediments in each of the oceanic region are
given in Table 12.2. It may be seen from the Table 12.2 that 41% of the total volume of
marine sediments lie on the continental slope, followed by continental rise 31% and
continental shelves 15%. The average thickness of marine sediments is maximum on
continental slope being 9 km, followed by continental rise 8 km and continental shelves 2.5
km. It may also be seen from the data that 72% of all marine sediment is associated with
continental slopes and continental rises.
Figure 12.1
Sequence of Deposition of Marine Sediments on Continental Shelves
TABLE 12.2
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 229 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Ocean
Deposits
Terrigenous Pelagic
Deposits Deposits
(Earth-born) (Ocean-born)
Shore Shallow Deep Organic Inorganic
(Littoral) Water Ocean (Ooze) (Red Clay)
Deposits Deposits Deposits
Calcareous Silicious
Ooze Ooze
1. Terrigenous Deposits
As stated earlier, they are basically the material which is “of the coast”, mainly
consisting of gravel, sand, silt, clay and mud, in sequence from the coast. There is a marked
gradation of these sediments when they are deposited in the oceans, however, the ocean
current and waves often disturbs the gradation process and sequence of the sediments. These
material deposits are mainly gravels, sand, volcanic materials, etc which are derived through
the erosion and weathering of the continental rocks. They are basically divided into three
categories:
Littoral Deposits
Shallow Water Deposits
Deep Water Deposits
2. Pelagic Deposits
The greater part of Deep Ocean is covered by pelagic sediments. The pelagic deposits
include:
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 230 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
i. All the very fine grained material of lithogenous origin carried by suspension in the
air or ocean water for long distances.
ii. The organic remains that settle slowly to the ocean floor.
iii. The hydrogenous minerals such as phillipsite and montomorillonite, an
iv. The fine grained meteoric dust found in the sediments of the deep ocean basins.
The pelagic deposits have been classified into organic and inorganic deposits as follows:
Inorganic Deposits
Less than 30% organic material is present in these deposits. These deposits are known
as red clay. The iron oxide present displays a brown or somewhat red colour to it. Red clay
constitutes 3.1% of the total oceanic deposits. It is distributed over an area of 129 million
km2 of all the oceans
Organic Deposits
These deposits contain more than 30% organic matter. The common term used for
these deposits is ‘Ooze’. Oozes are named after the dominant remnant organisms
contributing their remains to the deep-sea. Oozes are small, single-celled, drifting plant-like
organisms and the single celled organism that feed on them. The hard shell and skeletal
remains of these creatures are of relatively dense glass-like silica or calcium carbonate
(limey) substance. When these organisms die, their shells settle slowly toward the bottom,
mingle with fine grained terrigenous silts and clays, and accumulate as ooze. These deposits
are classified on the basis of their chemical composition, and also on the basis of organism
which predominates them. Hence the oozes have been classified as calcareous-pteropod and
globigerina and siliceous ooze-radiolarian and diatom ooze.
The pelagic oozes cover about 75.5% of the ocean areas. Pteropod, diatom and
radiolarian oozes cover 0.4, 6.4 and 3.4 percent areas of all the oceanic deposits respectively.
Pteropod oozes are found over an area of 12, 90,000 km2. Globegerina oozes cover
larger areas in the Pacific (64.5 million km2), the Atlantic (37.9 milion km2) and the Indian
31.4 million km2) oceans, shown in Figs. 12.2 A and B.Radiolarian oozes are found over an
area of 5.16 million km2 in the Pacific and Indian oceans. Diatom oozes are spread over an
area of 1,03,000 km2 in the North Pacific Ocean and 27.6 million km2 in the southern oceans.
It is apparent from the Figs. 12.2, 12.3, 12.4 that terrigenous deposits are found along
the coasts mainly on the continental shelves but them cover greater extent near the East
Indies, in the North Pacific and along the Labrador Coast. Globigerina ooze, red clay and
diatom ooze dominates in the western, eastern and southern parts of the Indian Ocean
whereas it contains maximum areal extent in the Pacific Ocean.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 231 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Ocean
Deposits
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 232 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
A B
Figure 12.2
Horizontal Distribution of Marine Deposits in (A): Atlantic Ocean and (B): Pacific Ocean
3. Bathyl Deposits
The bathyl deposits occur on the continental slope. These sediments consist of blue,
green and red muds, corals and fossils of marine organisms.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 233 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
red clays. Ooze is a fine sediment form at a greater height of 2000 meters depth and
so in the abyssal zone and ocean deeps.
Figure 12.3
Horizontal Distribution of Marine Deposits in Indian Ocean
About 38% of deep-sea sediments are clays and terrigenous sediments. The finest
terrigenous sediments are easily transported by wind and water currents. Microscopic water-
borne particles are tiny bits of wind-borne dust and volcanic ash settle slowly deep ocean
floor, forming fine brown, olive-coloured or reddish clays. Terrigenous sediment
accumulation on the deep-ocean floor may be less than a millimeter every thousand years.
However, pelagic sediments dominates the entire area of deep-ocean sediments. The
percentages of these deposits have been shown in Table 12.3.
TABLE 12.3
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 234 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 12.4
Spatial Distribution of Deep Sea Deposition of Pelagic Sediments
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 235 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
thrive in the tropical oceans confined between 25ºN-25ºS latitudes and live on lime.
Numerous coral polyps live at a place, in groups in the form of a colony and form calcareous
shells around them. Coral reefs are formed due to formation of one shell upon another shell
along submarine platforms at suitable depth. Since coral polyps cannot survive above water
level and hence coral reefs are always found either upon the sea level or below it. They are
generally attached to submarine platforms or islands submerged under seawater. It may be
mentioned that coral reefs are more diverse than tropical rainforests because the coral reefs
have about 1,000,000 species of which onlyn10% have been studied. This is why these are
called rainforests of the oceans.
In 1842, Charles Darwin proposed a theory to explain the origin of atolls. The theory
is based on the relative subsidence of a volcanic island. Darwin suggested that coral reefs are
originally established as fringing reefs along the shores of new volcanic islands. As the island
gradually subsides the coral reef grows upward along its outer margins. The rate of upward
growth essentially keeps the pace with subsidence. With the continued subsidence the area of
the island becomes smaller, and the reef becomes a barrier reef. Ultimately the island is
completely submerged and the upward growth of the reef forms an atoll. Erosional debris
from the atoll fills the enclosed area of the atoll to form a shallow lagoon.
Darwin’s subsidence theory on the whole finds confirmation from the recent seismic
studies and drilling in the Pacific Atolls. The conditions in which corals grow have been told
by Darwin which you will read in Unit 12.8.
Figure 12.5
Reef Formation: Darwin Subsidence Theory
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 236 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
This theory was UT forward by R. A. Daly. In his opinion atolls are the results of the
influence of the changing sea levels of the Pleistocene period. In other words, the
submergence was entirely post-glacial owning to the rise of the sea level which resulted from
the melting of Pleistocene ice sheets. The main points of Daly’s theory are:
i. The depth of the lagoons back of the atolls and barrier reefs is remarkably uniform
and rarely exceeds 80 to 90 meters, which implies a cause worldwide in nature.
ii. Glacial conditions would result in a worldwide chilling of the seas and increased
turbidity of the oceanic waters as a result of the churning up of muds formerly below
the reach of waves and thus would kill off reef-building organisms.
iii. The destruction of these organisms permitted marine abrasions to attack the islands
and banks upon which they had grown and produce at a lowered sea level a great
number of truncated islands or benches around islands.
iv. In the interglacial phase, the sea level rose. The relatively warmer and cleared waters
favoured the re-establishment of corals and associated organisms upon submerged
platforms which resulted in the development of an atoll or barrier reef. In such a
situation, corals establish themselves around the periphery of a platform and
gradually drew upward and forward as sea level rose, until their bases were ultimately
submerged about 250 to 300 feet.
Daly’s theory about the origin of the reefs was criticized by the geologists. Some of
the main criticisms are:
a. Many of the platforms are too broad to have been cut by marine abrasion during the
glacial age.
b. Lagoon depths are hardly as uniform a have been claimed.
c. It is doubtful if the low-level marine abrasions could form the low-level platforms.
d. It is difficult to suppose that the low temperatures could be extended in the lower
latitudes from the glaciated areas.
Corals are temperature-sensitive. They cannot thrive in either cold or very warm sea
temperatures. Corals can grow in a temperature range of 20ºC-30ºC and hence are
found mainly in tropical oceans and seas.
Corals do not live in deeper waters i.e. not more than 200-250 feet (60-77m) below
sea level because they die in waters deeper than 77m due to lack of sufficient amount
of sunlight and oxygen which is very much required for the growth of coral polyps.
High turbidity of seawater i.e. high concentration of suspended materials, both
organic and inorganic, does not allow growth of corals because their mouths are
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 237 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
clogged by muddy water and hence corals cannot get food and ultimately die of
starvation.
It may be pointed out that though coral polyps require sediment-free water but fresh
water is also injurious for the growth of corals. This is why corals avoid coastal lands
and live away from the areas of river mouth.
High salinity of water is injurious for coral growth because such waters contain very
less amount of calcium carbonate whereas lime is an important food for coral polyps.
The oceanic salinity ranging between 27% and 30% is most ideal for the growth and
development of coral polyps.
Ocean currents and waves are favorable for corals because they bring necessary food
supply for the polyps. It is obvious that corals grow in open seas and oceans but they
die in lagoons and small enclosed sea because of lack of supply of food. Currents and
waves also determine the shapes of coral reefs.
There should be extensive submarine platforms for the formation of the colonies by
the coral polyps. Such platform should not be more than 91 meters below the sea
level.
There should be pollution free coastal water for the survival and growth of corals,
because lack of them causes fatal diseases to the corals. Recent studies have shown
that 58% of the world’s coral reefs are threatened by human activities.
Coral bleaching caused by the sudden increase in the temperature of seawater due to
the anthropogenic sources such as emission of greenhouse gases and resultant global
warming, results in mass deaths of coral polyps.
Fringing reefs form in the areas of low rainfall run-of primarily on the downward idea
of tropical islands. The greatest concentration of living material will be at the reefs’ seaward
edge, where planktons and clear water of normal salinity are dependably available. Most new
islands available anywhere in the tropics have fringing reefs as their first reef form.
Permanent fringing reefs are common in Hawaiin Islands and in similar areas near the
boundaries of the tropics.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 238 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure 12.6
Types of Reefs
They tend to occur at lower islands or in lines parallel to continental shores. The outer
edge- the barrier- is raised because the seaward part of the reef is supplied with more food
and is able to grow more rapidly than the shore side. The lagoon may be from a few meters
deep to 60 m (200 feet) deep, and it may separate the barrier from the shore only by tens of
meters or by 300 km. In the case of north-eastern Australia’s Great Barrier Reef, coral grows
slowly within the lagoon because fewer nutrients are available and because sediments and
fresh water runoff from the shore.
12.9.3 Atolls
A ring of narrow growing corals of horseshoe shape and crowded with palm trees is
called an atoll. It is generally found around an island which has subsided or in elliptical form
on a submarine platform. There is a lagoon in the mid of the coral ring. The depth of the
lagoon ranges between 40 to 70 fathoms (240-420 feet). Atolls are divided into three types:
a. True Atolls characterized by circular reef enclosing a shallow lagoon but without
island.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 239 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
b. Island Atolls having an island n the central part of the lagoon enclosed by a circular
reef.
c. Coral Island or Atoll Island does not have an island in the beginning but later on
island is formed due to erosion and deposition by marine waves.
Atolls are found near Antilles Sea, Red Sea, China Sea, Australian Sea, and
Indonesian Sea. Funfutti Atoll of Ellice Island is a famous atoll. The enclosed lagoon is 12.8
km wide and 19.2 km long.
The cases of large scale coral bleaching have been reported in the Andaman and
Nicobar Islands of India. It may be pointed out that the areal coverage of coral reefs in India
has been estimated to be 18,000 km2. The corals have mainly colonized around the
Lakshadweep and the Andaman and Nicobar Islands. Besides, small patches of coral reefs
are found in the Gulf of Kutch and Gulf of Mannar. According to the study conducted by the
Society of Andaman and Nicobar Ecology (SANE) based at Port Blair there has been mass
coral bleaching (in 1998) around the Andaman reefs and 30-70% bleaching round the
Nicobar reefs. The bleaching is related to 2ºC rise in temperature from the normal
temperature in the Andaman Sea in 997-1998. According to the study by National Institute of
Oceanography (NIO) based at Goa, the coral reefs of the Kavaratti and Kadamat Islands in
Lakshadweep have suffered great damage from coral bleaching due to the bacterial diseases
and warmer sea temperatures. The corals in the Gulf of Kutch have been bleached due to
siltation.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 240 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
1. Most of the scientists have acknowledged global warming as the most significant
factor of coral bleaching causing large scale coral deaths. According to the Global
Coral Reef Alliance ‘every known mass bleaching occurred when temperatures were
just 1ºC higher than normal during the warmest summer months’ (down to Earth,
1999).
2. El Nino phenomenon has also been related to coral bleaching. It may be mentioned
that the warmest year of 1998 was also associated with the strongest El Nino
phenomenon causing further warming of the Pacific Ocean waters. It may be pointed
out that El Nino accounts for coral bleaching in certain localities only but the
phenomenal increase in coral bleaching in the years 1983, 1987 and 1988 was also
associated with strong El Nino weather phenomenon.
3. The outbreaks of coral diseases (black band diseases (black band disease, coral
plague, aspergillosis and white band disease) cause coral death.
4. Local factors like increase in siltation of sea waters due to mass flux o sediments and
nutrients brought by the streams from the erosion of high islands consequent upon
land use changes; pollution of sea waters caused by industrial effluents, urban sewage
and oil slicks; destructive fishing practices, over-fishing; clearing of marine forests
around coral reefs; filling of wetlands (marine forests and wetlands trap sediments
and filter pollutants and thus save corals from degradation); mining of coral rocks for
building materials; collection of rare coral species, etc. are also responsible for coral
degradation at local and regional level.
It may be mentioned that corals also have recovery characteristics. In the past inspite
of large scale climatic changes since Mesozoic Era (200 million years ago) like Ice Age
(Pleistocene Ice Age), fluctuations in solar activities and several environmental stresses
corals have managed to survive and recover. ‘Reefs will not become extinct in the long term,
but a single bleaching event will take reefs between 30 to 100 years to recover’, (Down to
Earth, August 15, 1999). It is suggested that proper investigations and studies of coral
ecosystems are necessary to understand the holistic view of association between coral
ecosystems, global warming and coral bleaching so that the corals may be rejuvenated.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 241 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
12.11 CONCLUSION
It is concluded that the marine ecosystem is vivid and cultured in its own way like the
terrestrial ecosystem. The different kinds of physical processes along with the
biogeochemical processes, marine animals, their types, plants and their contribution in
making all this happen makes it a beautiful and a mysterious area to find out and most
importantly to protect it from getting exploited or damaged.
12.12 SUMMARY
The unconsolidated sediments, derived from various sources deposited at the sea
floors are included in ocean deposits.
The sediments deposited in the oceans and the seas are derived from four major
sources viz. 1) Terrigenous sources, 2) Volcanic eruptions, 3) Marine plants and
animals and 4) Abiotic matters.
Terrigenous deposits are those derived from the erosion of rocks on land; that is, they
are derived from terrestrial (as opposed to marine) environments. They are
responsible for the significant amount of salt in today’s oceans.
Continental shelf sediments-called neritic (neritos=of the coast)-consist primarily of
the terrigenous materials. Deep-ocean floors are covered by finer sediment than those
of the continental margins, and a greater proportion of deep-sea sediments are of
biogenous of origin.Sediments of the slope, rise and deep-ocean floor that originate in
the ocean are called pelagic sediments (pelagios=of the sea).
Coral reefs are more diverse than tropical rainforests because the coral reefs have
about 1,000,000 species of which onlyn10% have been studied. This is why these are
called rainforests of the oceans.
Coral bleaching refers to the lack of algae from the corals resulting into the white
colour which is indicative of death of corals.
12.13 GLOSSARY
Atoll: A ring of narrow growing coral animals of horseshoe shape and crowned with palm
trees.
Barrier Reef: The largest coral reefs off the coastal platforms of the continents but parallel
to them.
Biogenic Sediments: The sediments formed through the deposition of skeletal remains of
marine organisms on sea floors, which have atleast 30% by volume of remains of marine
organisms.
Continental Shelf: The brad, flat, shallow and gently sloping sea floor extending from the
coasts to the point of shelf break or upper part of the continental slope.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 242 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Continental Slope: Steeply sloping submerged sea bottom extending from the outer margin
of continental shelf or from the point of shelf break and ending into deep sea trenches.
Coral Bleaching: Coral bleaching refers to the lack of algae from the corals resulting into
the white colour which is indicative of death of corals.
Coral Reefs: The reefs of cemented and compacted rigid massive structures of numberless
corolites (skeletons) of dead coral animals.
Corals: The living organisms of the category of marine animal and related to jellyfish, which
are responsible for building coral reefs.
Diatoms: Single-celled microscopic phytoplanktons which are responsible for bulk primary
production in marine environment.
Foraminifera: They are marine protozoans having test c0mposed of calcium carbonate, and
linear or spiral or concentric shells perforated by mall holes or pores.
Fringing Reefs: Coral reefs developed along the continental margin or along the islands
Lithogenous Sediments: The sediments derived from the weathering and erosion of rocks
either on land or in oceans.
Littoral Zone: The zone of benthic province between high and low tide waters.
Macro-biogenic Sediments: These are the sediments which are derived from the shells,
bones and teeth of marine animals.
Micro-biogenic Sediments: These are the small particles of microscopic marine animals.
Neritic Sediments: The marine sediments deposited on the floors of continental shelves.
Ocean Deposits: The consolidated marine sediments in the form of sedimentary layers on
sea floors.
Pelagic Matter: The sediments deposited on deep sea floors through slow sedimentation.
Radiolaria: These are unicellular marine animals having siliceous composition and belong
to planktonic and benthos community.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 243 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Shelf Break: It is the outer edge of the continental shelves from where starts the continental
slope.
Terrigenous Sediments: They are those marine sediments which are derived through the
weathering and erosion of continental rocks and brought to the oceans by rivers.
12.15 REFERENCES
1. Daly, R. A., 1934, The Changing World of the Ice Age, New Haven, Yale University
Press.
3. Daly, R. A., 1942, The Floor of the Ocean, University of North Carolina Press.
4. Dana, J. D., 1879, Corals and Coral Islands, New York, Dodd Mead & Co.
UNIT 12 – OCEAN DEPOSITS AND CORALS REEFS Page 244 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
BLOCK 4 : BIOSPHERE
13.1 OBJECTIVES
13.2 INTRODUCTION
13.3 BIOSPHERE: MEANING AND CONCEPT
13.4 ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE
13.4.1 ABIOTIC ELEMENTS
13.4.2 BIOTIC ELEMENTS
13.5 HABITAT
13.6 PLANT KINGDOM
13.6.1 VERTICAL STRATIFICATION OF PLANT
COMMUNITIES
13.7 ANIMAL KINGDOM
13.8 HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION
13.9 CONCLUSION
13.10 SUMMARY
13.11 GLOSSARY
13.12 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
13.13 REFERENCES
13.14 SUGGESTED READINGS
13.15 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 225 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
13.1 OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter, you will be able:
13.2 INTRODUCTION
Earth is the only known life sustaining planet in the universe. It has great diversity of
flora and fauna and is able to show the various forms of life altogether in a single bunch. It is
the only planet to be having all the life-sustaining things like adequate temperature, air to
breathe, water for utilization and what not; all blended upon so well that all its components
help each other in maintaining the well-being of each other. They are all interdependent on
each other and form a cycle of life sustaining elements going.
Theorganic world or biosphere is that part of the earth which contains the living organisms-
the biologically inhabited soil, air and water’ -J. Tivy, 1982
The biosphere consists of the entireliving organism (the biotic component), energy
(the energy component) and the physical environment (the abiotic component)and there are
continuous interactions between the living organisms and the physical environment and
among the living organisms themselves. The average thickness of the biosphere or life
supporting layer consisting of air, water, soil and rock is about 30 km. The upper limit of the
biosphere is determined by the availability of oxygen, moisture, temperature and air pressure
with increase in height in the atmosphere limits the upper boundary of the biosphere. Though
the NASA has discovered the presence of bacteria up to the height of 15 km in the
atmosphere but the lower layer of the atmosphere upto a few hundred meters accounts most
of the living organisms becausefavourable environmental conditions are available for the
growth and development of living organisms in the lower part of the atmosphere.
The lower limits of the biosphere are determined by the availability of the required
amount of oxygen and light which can sustain life. Thus, the depth of the biosphere over the
land is upto the depth of the deepest roots of the trees or the depth at which lie the parent
rock-beds. The biosphere extends upto greater depths in the oceans. The existence of life has
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 226 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
been detected upto a depth of 9,000m in the deep oceanic trenches and deep sea plains (Fig
13.1)
Figure 13.1
Extent of Biosphere (life supporting layer)
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 227 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The lithosphere accounts for about 29% of the total surface area of the globe. The
landforms of various sizes as mentioned above provide a variety of habitat for the plants and
animals. Thus, it is necessary to study the main characteristics of lithospheric components
and all the physical processes, whether exogenetic or endogenetic, which affect the
lithosphere- the surface of the Earth. The geological cycle involving a set of processes and
sub-cycles, e.g., tectonic cycle, rock cycle, geochemical cycle, water cycle, etc, is responsible
for the creation, maintenance, changes or destruction of the materials of the Earth, for
example, elements, minerals, rocks, soils, water and landform assemblage.
Soil system is a very important component because soils acts as vital pathways of
energy in the biosphere and are very important for the biological cycles of nutrients. The soil
system acts as very important biological furnace between the vegetation cover and
unweathered parent rocks. Soil environment also provides habitats of various sorts o the
largest community of organic life (biological community). On the other hand, sols act as
nutrient reservoirs for living organisms. Soil facilitates the process of root osmosis for the
transfer of their nutrients to the plants through their roots in solution form. Soil system is also
called as the biological factory or laboratory because the processes of creation of nutrients,
their consumption and their return are confined to soils.
The atmosphere helps in the process of photosynthesis and drives hydrological cycle,
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 228 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The water component consists of surface water, subsurface or ground water and oceanic
water.
a. Surface water of the Earth surface is found in static state (e.g. water of lake, tanks,
ponds, reservoirs, etc.) and in dynamic (in motion) state (e.g. surface runoff, streams,
springs, etc.)
b. Groundwater is found in the pore spaces of regolith known as Aquifers.
c. Oceanic water or hydrosphere covers about 71% of the total surface f the area of the
globe. On the basis of size and location the hydrosphere is divided into oceans, seas,
small enclosed seas, bays, etc. The hydrospheric component includes the
consideration of origin and characteristics of bottom reliefs (continental shelves,
continental slopes, deep-sea plains, deeps, submarine canyons, etc.), temperature,
salinity, ocean deposits, waves and currents, coral reefs and atolls because these
determine different types of habitats of marine organisms.
1. Plant Component
Social grouping of plant species is called plant community and plants are basic unit of
this community. Plantsare found on any land in different forms, e.g., woodland, forest,
meadow, bogs, grasslands, marshlands, etc. These different forms of plants are collectively
known as vegetation. In other words-
‘all the plants that grow in an area form its vegetation, the character of which
depends not just on the different species present but on the relative proportions in
which their members are represented.’
-Joy Tivy, 1982
Thus, the vegetation of any particular habitat consists of groupsof plants of different
species or of the same species which are ecologically related, meaning thereby different plant
groups are able to occupy the same habitat because of their competitive ability and range of
tolerance. Plant community has been defined in a variety of ways by the ecologists and
biogeographers, some examples are as follows-
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 229 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
There are certain characteristics of the plant community. The major ones are
explained as under:
In other words, this is a well known fact the species of plants, their structure,
composition and growth form depend upon the nature of mutual interaction between the
abiotic and biotic components of the environment, it is easier to understand the nature and
pattern of mutual interactions of factors (components, both abiotic and biotic) which affect
the species, their structure, composition and growth form. Out of the abiotic or physical
factors, climate and soil mostly affect the species of plants, their structure and growth form.
In turn, plants also affect and control the properties of soils and climatic conditions of their
physical habitat. It appears that plant community not only affects but also determines the
productivity of the land and their habitat.
Plants are primary producers because they produce their food themselves through
the process of photosynthesis. Thus, plants are also calledautotrophs. It is evident that the
plants are the major source of food and energy supply to animals including man.
2. Animal Components
It must be noted that the it is not necessary that the autotrophic component must have
roots. This is the reason why, some bacteria fall under this category as they are able to
produce their food themselves.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 230 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The main function of the heterotrophic component or the animals (primary consumers
or herbivores) includes:
Thus the heterotrophic component is classified into three broad categories on the basis of
the availability of organic matter to them:
a. Saprophytes are those animals which live on organic compounds in the solution form
derived from dead plants and animals.
b. Parasites are those animals which depend upon other living organisms for food and
life.
c. Holozonicanimals are those who take their food through their mouths. All the big
animals like elephants, cows, camels, lions, etc. are included in this category.
3. Micro-organisms
Micro-organisms are also known as decomposers because these decompose the dead
plants and animals and other organic matter in different forms. During the process of
decomposition of organic matter, micro-organismsobtain their food as well as they
differentiate and separate complex organic matters and thus make them simple so that these
may be again used by autotrophic primary producer green plants. A large number of micro-
bacteria and fungi are included in the category of micro-organisms.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 231 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
___________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
13.5 HABITAT
A habitat is an ecological or environmental area that is inhabited by a particular
species of animal, plant, or other type of organism. The term typically refers to the zone in
which the organism lives and where it can find food, shelter, protection and mates for
reproduction. It is the natural environment in which an organism lives, or the physical
environment that surrounds a species population.
A habitat is made up of physical factors such as soil, moisture, range of temperature,
and light intensity as well as biotic factors such as the availability of food and the presence or
absence of predators. Every organism has certain habitat needs for the conditions in which it
will thrive, but some are tolerant of wide variations while others are very specific in their
requirements. A habitat is not necessarily a geographical area, it can be the interior of a stem,
a rotten log, a rock or a clump of moss, and for a parasitic organism it is the body of itshost,
part of the host's body such as the digestive tract, or a single cell within the host's body.
Habitat types include polar, temperate, subtropical and tropical. The terrestrial
vegetation type may be forest, steppe, grassland, semi-arid or desert. Fresh water habitats
include marshes, streams, rivers, lakes, ponds and estuaries, and marine habitats include salt
marshes, the coast, the intertidal zone, reefs, bays, the open sea, the sea bed, deep water
and submarine vents.
Habitats change over time. This may be due to a violent event such as the eruption of
a volcano, an earthquake, a tsunami, a wildfire or a change in oceanic currents; or the change
may be more gradual over millennia with alterations in the climate, as ice
sheets and glaciersadvance and retreat, and as different weather patterns bring changes
of precipitation and solar radiation. Other changes come as a direct result of human activities;
deforestation, the ploughing of ancient grasslands, the diversion and damming of rivers, the
draining of marshland and the dredging of the seabed. The introduction of alien species can
have a devastating effect on native wildlife, through increased predation, through
competition for resources or through the introduction of pests and diseases to which the
native species have no immunity.
Types of Habitats
Terrestrial habitat types include forests, grasslands, wetlands and deserts. Within
these broad biomes are more specific habitats with varying climate types, temperature
regimes, soils, altitudes and vegetation types. Many of these habitats grade into each other
and each one has its own typical communities of plants and animals. A habitat may suit a
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 232 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
particular species well, but its presence or absence at any particular location depends to some
extent on chance, on its dispersal abilities and its efficiency as a coloniser.
Freshwater habitats include rivers, streams, lakes, ponds, marshes and bogs. Although
some organisms are found across most of these habitats, the majority have more specific
requirements. The water velocity, its temperature and oxygen saturation are important
factors, but in river systems, there are fast and slow sections,
pools, bayous and backwaters which provide a range of habitats. Similarly, aquatic plants can
be floating, semi-submerged, submerged or grow in permanently or temporarily saturated
soils besides bodies of water. Marginal plants provide important habitat for both
invertebrates and vertebrates, and submerged plants provide oxygenation of the water, absorb
nutrients and play a part in the reduction of pollution.
Marine habitats include brackish water, estuaries, bays, the open sea, the intertidal
zone, the sea bed, reefs and deep water zones.[11]Further variations include rock pools, sand
banks, mudflats, brackish lagoons, sandy and pebbly beaches, and sea-grass beds, all
supporting their own flora and fauna. The benthic zone or seabed provides a home for both
static organisms, anchored to the substrate, and for a large range of organisms crawling on or
burrowing into the surface. Some creatures float among the waves on the surface of the
water, or raft on floating debris, others swim at a range of depths, including organisms in
the demersal zone close to the seabed, and myriads of organisms drift with the currents and
form the plankton.
A desert is not the kind of habitat that favours the presence of amphibians, with their
requirement for water to keep their skins moist and for the development of their young.
Nevertheless, some frogs live in deserts, creating moist habitats underground and hibernating
while conditions are adverse. Couch's spadefoot toad (Scaphiopuscouchii) emerges from its
burrow when a downpour occurs and lays its eggs in the transient pools that form; the
tadpoles develop with great rapidity, sometimes in as little as nine days,
undergo metamorphosis, and feed voraciously before digging a burrow of their own.
Other organisms cope with the drying up of their aqueous habitat in other
ways. Vernal pools are ephemeral ponds that form in the rainy season and dry up afterwards.
They have their specially-adapted characteristic flora, mainly consisting of annuals, the seeds
of which survive the drought, but also some uniquely adapted perennials. Animals adapted to
these extreme habitats also exist; fairy shrimps can lay "winter eggs" which are resistant
to desiccation, sometimes being blown about with the dust, ending up in new depressions in
the ground. These can survive in a dormant state for as long as fifteen
years. Some killifish behave in a similar way; their eggs hatch and the juvenile fish grow
with great rapidity when the conditions are right, but the whole population of fish may end
up as eggs in diapause in the dried up mud that was once a pond.
Many animals and plants have taken up residence in urban environments. They tend
to be adaptable generalists and use the town's features to make their
homes. Rats and mice have followed man around the
globe, pigeons, peregrines, sparrows, swallows and house martins use the buildings for
nesting, bats use roof space for roosting, foxes visit the garbage bins and
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 233 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
squirrels, coyotes, raccoons and skunks roam the streets. About 2,000 coyotes are thought to
live in and around Chicago. A survey of dwelling houses in northern European cities in the
twentieth century found about 175 species of invertebrate inside them, including 53 species
of beetle, 21 flies, 13 butterflies and moths, 13 mites, 9 lice, 7 bees, 5 wasps, 5 cockroaches,
5 spiders, 4 ants and a number of other groups. In warmer climates, termites are serious pests
in the urban habitat; 183 species are known to affect buildings and 83 species cause serious
structural damage.
For example, two habitats may have similar floras but their vegetation may vary from
one another and two habitats having different floras may have similar vegetation. For
instance, if there are two similar habitats wherein both have grasses and sal trees but there is
overwhelming dominance of grasses nd sparse distribution of sal trees in the first habitat
whereas the second habitat is characterized by dense sal trees and sparse distribution of
grasses, the vegetation of the first habitat will be grasses whereas the vegetation of the
second habitat will be sal forest.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 234 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
place through the process of adaptation, competition and natural selection. This results in
the development of various strata or layers between the soil surface or ground surface and the
tree canopy. This vertical layering pattern or vertical stratification of plants is a result of
competition among various species of plant community to get sunlight because it is the
primary source of energy for photosynthesis through which these plants manufacture their
food. It is obvious that the availability of sunlight is mainly responsible for the development
of vertical stratification of plants wherein the height of different species of plants varies
significantly. On an average, there are four vertical strata of plant community in a given
region mainly in the deciduous forests of the temperate region.
1. Dominant Layer represents the topmost layer of the plant community (Fig, 13.2) which
is determined by the canopy of the largest trees. The uppermost stratum is also called
crown or canopy which represents the highest limit of plant community in a given region.
A secondary very often called as co-dominant layer is formed just below the crown or
dominant layer by those large trees which are relatively shorter than the larger trees (Fig
13.2).
Figure 13.2
Vertical Stratification of Plant Kingdom (with respect to temperate deciduous forest)
2. Secondary Layer is located below the dominant layer or crown layer and is represented
by plants of shrubby life-form. This is also called the shrub layer.
3. Third Layer is formed by the herbaceous plants and is also called the herb layer.
4. Fourth Layer represents mosses on the ground surface and is also called as moss layer
or ground layer.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 235 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
For a plant, a good habitat must provide the right combination of light, air, water,
and soil. For example, the prickly pear cactus, which is adapted for sandy soil, dry climates,
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 236 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
and bright sunlight, grows well in desert areas like the Sonoran Desert in northwest Mexico.
It would not thrive in wet, cool areas with a large amount of overcast (shady) weather, like
the U.S. states of Oregon or Washington.
The main components of a habitat are shelter, water, food, and space. A habitat is said
to have a suitable arrangement when it has the correct amount of all of these. Sometimes, a
habitat can meet some components of a suitable arrangement, but not all.
For example, a habitat for a puma could have the right amount of food (deer, porcupine,
rabbits, and rodents), water (a lake, river, or spring), and shelter (trees or dens on
the forest floor). The puma habitat would not have a suitable arrangement, however, if it
lacks enough space for this large predator to establish its own territory. An animal might lose
this component of habitat—space—when humans start building homes and businesses,
pushing an animal into an area too small for it to survive.
Space
The amount of space an organism needs to thrive varies widely from species to
species. For example, the common carpenter ant needs only a few square inches for an
entire colony to develop tunnels, find food, and complete all the activities it needs to survive.
In contrast, cougars are very solitary, territorial animals that need a large amount of space.
Cougars can cover 455 square kilometers (175 square miles) of land tohunt and find a mate.
A cougar could not survive in the same amount of space that a carpenter ant needs.
Plants need space, too. Coast redwood trees, like the ones in Redwood National Park
in the U.S. state of California, can reach more than 4.5 meters (15 feet) in diameter and 106
meters (350 feet) in height. A tree that massive would not have enough space to grow and
thrive in a typical community park or yard.
Space is not the same as range; the range of an animal is the part of the world it
inhabits. Grassland, for example, is the habitat of the giraffe, but the animal’s range is
central, eastern, and southern Africa.
Food
The availability of food is a crucial part of a habitat’s suitable arrangement. For
example, in the northern part of the U.S. state of Minnesota, black bears eat mostly plants,
like clover, dandelions, and blueberries. If there were a drought, plants would become scarce.
Even though the habitat would still have space (large forest), shelter (caves, forest floor),
water (streams and lakes), and some food, it wouldn’t have enough to eat. It would no longer
be a suitable arrangement.
Too much food can also disrupt a habitat. Algae are a microscopic aquatic organism
that makes its own food through the process of photosynthesis. Nutrients like phosphorous
contribute to the spread of algae. When a fresh water habitat has a sharp increase in
phosphorous, algae “blooms,” or reproduces quickly. Algae also die very quickly, and
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 237 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
the decaying algae produce an algal bloom. The algal bloom can discolour the water, turning
it green, red, or brown. Algal blooms can also absorb oxygen from the water, destroying the
habitat of organisms like fish and plants. Excess nutrients for algae can destroy the
habitat’s food chain.
Water
Water is essential to all forms of life. Every habitat must have some form of a water
supply. Some organisms need a lot of water, while others need very little. For
example, dromedary camels are known for their ability to carry goods and people for long
distances without needing much water. Dromedary camels, which have one hump, can travel
161 kilometers (100 miles) without a drink of water. Even with very little access to water in a
hot, dry climate, dromedary camels have a suitable arrangement in northern Africa and the
Arabian Peninsula.
Cattails, on the other hand, are plants that grow best in wet areas, like marshes
and swamps. Dense colonies of these tall, spiky plants grow directly in the mud beneath
lakes, stream banks, and even neighbourhood ponds. A cattail habitat’s suitable arrangement
depends on water. Imagine a pond at the bottom of a dirt-covered cliff. If enough loose dirt
slid down into the pond, it could fill up the pond and absorb the water, not leaving enough for
the cattails to grow.
Shelter
An organism’s shelter protects it from predators and weather. Shelter also provides a
space for eating, sleeping, hunting, and raising a family. Shelters come in many forms. A
single tree, for example, can provide sheltered habitats for many different organisms. For a
cater pillar, shelter might be the underside of a leaf. For a mushroom fungus, shelter might be
the cool, damp area near tree roots. For a bald eagle, shelter may be a high perch to make a
nest and watch for food.
Plants and animals interact with each other in the environment. They also interact
with the environment itself. The plants and animals depend on each other.
Animals and humans depend on plants. Animals need food, protection and shelter. In
human terms, it is food, clothing and shelter.
Some people use plants and plant material as decoration to make them attractive.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 238 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Animals and humans depend on other animals. In the food chain, some animals eat
other animals and use them for food. Humans also use animals as sources of food and
clothing.
This so can be seen that the same habitat for both the plant and animals remains sustainable
with each other’s support, association and thorough interdependence.
Q.2 What is the most basic difference between a plant and an animal?
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
____________
13.9 CONCLUSION
It is so concluded that all the biotic components and abiotic components and even the
biotic components themselves depend upon each other for sustaining their lives. With time
everything changes, but the quality of adaption, competitiveness and natural selections of
environment makes this world to go on with time. The differences in the habitats and
vegetations makes different areas in the world in which very diverse kind of plants and
animals flourish helping each other on the way of survival altogether.
13.10 SUMMARY
The biosphere is a life supporting layer which surrounds the Earth and makes plant
and animal life possible without any protective device.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 239 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The biosphere consists of the entire living organism (the biotic component), energy
(the energy component) and the physical environment (the abiotic component) and
there are continuous interactions between the living organisms and the physical
environment and among the living organisms themselves.
The abiotic or inorganic or physical components of the biosphere or the ecosystem
represents physical environment of the whole biosphere or part thereof. This
component, on an average, includes the lithosphere, the atmosphere and the
hydrosphere.
The lithosphere accounts for about 29% of the total surface area of the globe. The
landforms of various sizes as mentioned above provide a variety of habitat for the
plants and animals.
Soil system is also called as the biological factory or laboratory because the
processes of creation of nutrients, their consumption and their return are confined to
soils.
The atmosphere is a significant component of the biospheric ecosystem because it
provides all the gases necessary for the sustenance of all life forms of the biosphere.
It also filters the incoming solar radiation and thus prevents the ultraviolet solar
radiation waves to reach the Earth’s surface and hence protects it from becoming too
hot.
. Water plays a very important role in the circulation of nutrients in the various
components of the ecosystems and it makes biogeochemical cycles effective in the
biosphere.
Biotic or organic elements of the biosphere consist of three sub-systems- (i) plant
system, (ii) animal system including man and (iii) micro-organisms.
Of these three sub-systems plants are the most important because plants alone
produce organic matters which are used by animals including micro-organisms either
directly or indirectly.
Social grouping of plant species is called plant community and plants are basic unit of
this community.
All the plants that grow in an area form its vegetation, the character of which depends
not just on the different species present but on the relative proportions in which their
members are represented.
On a functional basis, the biotic or organic components of the biosphere ecosystem
are divided into two broad divisions:
The Autotrophic Component-which represents plants.
The Heterotrophic Component-which includes those animals which depend
upon autotrophic green plants for their food.
Saprophytes are those animals which live on organic compounds in the solution form
derived from dead plants and animals.
Parasites are those animals which depend upon other living organisms for food and
life.
Holozonicanimals are those who take their food through their mouths. All the big
animals like elephants, cows, camels, lions, etc. are included in this category.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 240 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Micro-organisms are also known as decomposers because these decompose the dead
plants and animals and other organic matter in different forms.
A habitat is an ecological or environmental area that is inhabited by a particular
species of animal, plant, or other type of organism. The term typically refers to the
zone in which the organism lives and where it can find food, shelter, protection and
mates for reproduction. It is the natural environment in which an organism lives, or
the physical environment that surrounds a species population.
The development of different species of plant community of a given region takes
place through the process of adaptation, competition and natural selection.
The most important variations between plants and animals are related to their
mobility and stability. Almost all plants are static at their places except a few floating
aquatic plants which move to some extent under the influence of water movement
whereas animals (both land and water animals) are very much mobile.
13.11 GLOSSARY
Biogeography: The study of biosphere consisting of abiotic (land, soils, air, water, energy,
etc.) and biotic (plants, animals and micro-organisms) components is called biogeography.
Biosphere: It is a life-supporting layer which surrounds the Earth and makes plants and
animal life possible without any protective device. The biosphere consists of abiotic, energy
and biotic components.
Biotic Component: They are the organic components of the biospheric ecosystem comprise
plants, animals and micro-organisms.
Consumers: They are the heterotrophic organisms of the biospheric ecosystem which
includes animals including man, which are further divided into primary consumers or
herbivores, secondary consumers as carnivores.
Decomposers: They are the micro-organisms living in the soils which decompose and
consume dead plants and animals and are also called deterivores.
Holozonic: They are those animals who take their food through their mouths. All the big
animals like elephants, cows, camels, lions, etc.
Parasites: They are those animals which depend upon other living organisms for food and
life.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 241 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Primary Producers: Plants are primary producers because they produce their own food
though the process of photosynthesis. They are also called autotrophs or phototrophs.
Plant Community: The social groupings of plant species, of which plant is the fundamental
basic unit.
Saprophytes: Those animals which live on organic compounds in the solution form derived
from dead plants and animals.
13.13 REFERENCES
1. The Columbia Encyclopedia, Sixth Edition. Columbia University Press. 2004.
2. Hogan, C. Benito (2010). "Abiotic factor". Encyclopedia of Earth.Washington,D.C.:
National Council for Science and the Environment
3. "Abiotic Components".Department of Biodiversity and Conservation Biology, University
of the Western Cape.
UNIT 13 - ELEMENTS OF BIOSPHERE, HABITAT AND PLANT-ANIMAL ASSOCIATION Page 242 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
14.1 OBJECTIVES
14.2 INTRODUCTION
14.3 ECOLOGY AND ECOSYSTEM: MEANING AND CONCEPT
14.4 ECOLOGICAL PRINCIPLES
14.5 PROPERTIES OF ECOSYSTEM
14.6 TYPE OF ECOSYSTEMS
14.7 FUNCTIONING OF ECOSYSTEMS
14.8 CONCLUSION
14.9 SUMMARY
14.10 GLOSSARY
14.11 ANSWERS TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
14.12 REFERENCES
14.13 SUGGESTED READINGS
14.14 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
14.1 OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter, you will be able:
14.2 INTRODUCTION
Why are there so many living organisms on Earth, and so many different species?
How do the characteristics of the non-living environment, such as soil quality and water
salinity, help determine which organisms thrive in particular areas? These questions are
central to the study of ecosystems— communities of living organisms in particular places
and the chemical and physical factors that influence them. Here we will learn how scientists
study ecosystems to predict how they may change over time and respond to human impacts.
The term ecology has been derived from ‘oecology’, made by two Greek words
‘oikos’ means house or dwelling as habitat and ‘logos’ meaning the study of;by a German
biologist Ernst Haeckel in 1869, to understand the relationship between organisms and their
environment. It may be pointed out that Darwin’s concepts of the ‘evolution of species’
through natural selection involving interactions between biological species and habitat was
the key stone of the formulation of the various terms and concepts of inter-relationship
between organisms and their physical environment in one way or the other. The following
sentences of Haeckel throw light on various aspects of oecology:
organic surroundings, and above all their friendly and hostile relations with such animals
and plants as they come into direct or indirect contact with, or in shot with all the involved
interdependences that Darwin designated as the condition of the struggle for existence.
Though this termed was coined in 1869, but the concept of organism and environment
relationship is a very old one. In a simple term ecology can be stated as that science which
studies, interrelationships between abiotic and biotic components of the biosphere on one
hand, and among biotic component on the other hand. However, along with ecology comes
another term, i.e., ecosystem. The term ecosystem was first used by A.G. Tansley in 1935
who defined ecosystem as:
According to Tansely the ecosystem comprises of two major parts viz. biome (the
whole complex of plants and animals of a particular spatial unit) and habitat (physical
environment) and thus:
‘all parts of such an ecosystem-organic and inorganic, biome and habitat, may be regarded
as interacting factors which in a mature ecosystem , are in approximate equilibrium, it is
through their interactions that the whole system is maintained.’
‘A functioning interacting system composed of one or more living organisms and their
effective environment, both physical and biological.’
Figure 14.1
An Illustration of an Ecosystem
Ecologists study all these interactions in order to understand the abundance and
diversity of life within Earth's ecosystems—in other words, why there are so many plants and
animals, and why there are so many different types of plants and animals. To answer these
questions they may use field measurements, such as counting and observing the behavior of
species in their habitats; laboratory experiments that analyze processes such as predation
rates in controlled settings; or field experiments, such as testing how plants grow in their
natural setting but with different levels of light, water, and other inputs. Applied ecology uses
information about these relationships to address issues such as developing effective
vaccination strategies, managing fisheries without over-harvesting, designing land and
marine conservation reserves for threatened species, and modeling how natural ecosystems
may respond to global climate change.
function, we can improve our ability to predict how they will respond to changes in the
environment. But since living organisms in ecosystems are connected in complex
relationships, it is not always easy to anticipate how a step such as introducing a new species
will affect the rest of an ecosystem.
Q.1 What are regarded as the basic unit of ecology and why?
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
____________
1. Ecosystem of any given space-time unit represents the sum of all living organisms
and physical environment.
2. It is composed of three basic components viz. energy, biotic (biome) and abiotic
(habitat) components.
3. It occupies certain well defined area of earth-space ship (spatial distribution).
4. It is viewed in terms on time unit (temporal dimension).
5. There are complex sets of interactions between biotic and abiotic components
(including energy component) on the one hand and between and among the organisms
on the other hand.
6. In an open system which is characterized by continuous input and output of matter
and energy.
7. It tends to be in relatively stable equilibrium unless there is disturbance in one or
more controlling factors (limiting factors).
8. It is powered by energy of various sorts but the solar energy is the most significant.
9. It is a functional unit wherein the biotic components (plants, animals including man
and micro-organisms) and abiotic components (physical environment including
energy component) are intimately related to each other through a series of large-scale
cyclic mechanisms viz. energy flow, water cycle, biogeochemical cycle, mineral
cycle, sediment cycle, etc.
10. Ecosystem has its own productivity which is the process of building organic matter
based on the availability and amount of energy passing through the ecosystem. The
productivity refers to the rate of growth of organic matter in the areal unit per time-
unit.
11. Ecosystems have scale dimensions, i.e., it varies in spatial coverage. It may be as
small as a cowshed, a tree or even a part of a tree having certain micro-organisms.
The largest unit is the whole biosphere. Thus, the ecosystems may be divided into
several orders on the basis of spatial dimension. Hence, it is clear that:
‘the ecosystem is a convenient scale at which to consider plants and animals and
their interaction because it is more localized and thus more specific than the
ii. Aquatic Ecosystems: The aquatic ecosystems are subdivided into two
broad categories:
a. Freshwater Ecosystems
River Ecosystems
Lake Ecosystems
Pond and Tank Ecosystems
Marsh and Bog Ecosystems
b. Marine Ecosystems
Ocean Surface Ecosystems
Open Ocean Ecosystems
Coastal Estuarine Ecosystems
Ocean Bottom Ecosystems
Coral Reef Ecosystems
Thus, on the basis of above gradient profiles and associated ecoclines the following
types of ecosystems in the aforesaid four situations may be identified:
i. From mountains with relatively more moisture to the areas of increasing aridity:
a. Mesophytic Forest Ecosystem
b. Oak-Hickkory Forest Ecosystem
c. Oak Woodland Ecosystem
d. Prairie Ecosystem
e. Dry Grassland Ecosystem
f. Desert Ecosystem
ii. From the areas of high moisture (equatorial areas) to the areas of lowest moisture
(desert):
a. Tropical Rainforest Ecosystem
b. Ever-green Seasonal Deciduous Forest Ecosystem
c. Thorn Forest Ecosystem
UNIT 14 –ECOLOGY AND ECOSYSTEM Page 250 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
i. Continental Ecosystems
ii. Marine or Oceanic Ecosystems.
The spatial scales may be brought down from a continent to a single biotic life (plant
or animal).
But this classification is highly controversial and debatable because there are a lot of
variations in opinions regarding the concept of system stability. For example, if the stability
is defined by frequency of fluctuations of species population, stability has been reported to
increase with succession whereas if stability of an ecosystem is defined in terms of time to be
taken for a community to return to its former condition, stability may actually decrease
through time.
The energy pattern and flow are governed by the first and second law of
thermodynamics. The first law of thermodynamics states that in any system of constant
mass, energy is neither created nor destroyed but it can be transferred from one type to
another type (example, electrical energy can be converted into mechanical energy). In terms
of ecosystem the energy flow or input in a system is balanced by energy outflow. The
second law of thermodynamics states that when work is done, energy is dissipated and the
work is done when one form of energy is transformed into another form. In the context of
ecosystem there is dissipation of energy from each transfer point (tropic level) and thus the
dissipated or lost energy is not again available to the ecosystem.
Solar radiation is the basic input of energy entering the ecosystem. The radiant solar
energy is received by the green plants. Most of the received solar energy is converted into
heat energy and is lost from the ecosystem to the atmosphere through plant communities.
Only a small portion of radiant solar energy is used by plants to make food through the
process of photosynthesis. Thus, green plants transform a part of solar energy into food
energy or chemical energy which is used by the green plants to develop their tissues and thus
store d in the primary producers or autotrophs at the bottom of the trophic levels. The
chemical energy stored at trophic level one becomes the source of energy t the herbivores at
trophic level two of the food chain. Some portion of energy is lost from trophic level one
through respiration and some portion is transferred to plant-eating (herbivores) animals at
trophic level two. The transfer of energy from trohic level one (green plants) to trophic level
two (herbivores) is performed through the intake of organic tissues (which contain potential
chemical energy) of green plants by the herbivores. Thus the chemical energy consumed by
herbivores helps in the building of their own tissues and is stored at trophuc level two and
becomes the source of energy for carnivores at trophic level three. A substantial portion of
chemical energy is released by carnivores at trophic level three through respiration because
more energy is required for the work to be done by the carnivores at trophic level three
(building of tissues, growing, movement, etc.).
Figure 14.2
An Example of Energy Flow in Ecosystem
Some portion of potential chemical energy is transferred from trophic level three to trophic
level four or top trophic level represented by omnivores (those animals which eat both plants
and animals, man is the most important example of omnivores). The animals at trophic level
four mainly man also take energy from trophic levels one and two. Again some portion of
energy is released by omnivores through respiration. The remaining stored chemical energy
in plants and animals is transferred to decomposers when they (plants and animals) become
dead. The decomposers release substantial amount of energy through respiration to the
atmosphere. It may be pointed out that at each trophic level the available potential chemical
energy to be transferred to the next tropic level decreases as more energy is released through
respiration to the atmosphere from each trophic level. Respiration means the chemical
breakdown of food in the body and thus respiration releases heat which is transferred to the
atmosphere.
Based on the above statement it may be summarized in the words of P. A. Furley and W. W.
Newey:
‘Apart from the energy released to the atmosphere through respiration, the remaining energy
is transferred in successive cosnumer stages known as trophic (literally nourishment) levels
from autotrophs to heterotrophs. Ultimately, all the energy is passed on the deterivores, or
decomposer animals.’ -P. A. Furley and W. W. Newey, 1983
‘the materials that make up the biosphere are distributed and redistributed by means of an
infinite series of cyclic pathways motored by the continuous input of energy.’
The materials or nutrients involved in the circulation within an ecosystem are grouped
into three categories:
i. Macro elements- which are required in large quantities by the plants, e.g., oxygen,
hydrogen, carbon, etc.
ii. Minor or Micro elements- which are required by plants in relatively smaller amounts,
e.g., nitrogen, phosphorus, potassium, calcium, magnesium, sulphur, etc.
iii. Trace elements- plants require a very small amounts of about 100 elements, important
being iron, zinc, manganese, cobalt, etc.
Besides these inorganic chemical elements, there are organic materials as well which
comprise:
A few chemical elements act as organic catalysts or enzymes because they help
chemical reactions but seldom undergo chemical change themselves. Such chemical elements
are hydrogen, oxygen and nitrogen which belong to gaseous phase (that is they are found in
the atmosphere is gaseous state-atmospheric reservoir or pool) and phosphate, calcium or
sulphur which belong to sedimentary phase (that is they are found in weathered rocks and
soils-sedimentary reservoirs or pool).
Thus these elements, derived from atmospheric and sedimentary reservoirs, are
pooled into soils from where these are taken by plants in solution from through the process of
root osmosis. The plants then convert these elements into such forms which are easily used in
the development of plant tissues and plant growth by biochemical processes (generally
photosynthesis). Thus, the nutrients driven by energy flow pass into various components of
biotic communities through the process known as ‘biogeochemical cycles’. In a generalized
form the biogeochemical cycles include the uptake of nutrients or inorganic elements by the
plants through their roots in solution from the soils where these inorganic elements, derived
from sedimentary phase, are stored. The nutrients are transported to various trophic levels
through energy flow. Here the nutrients become organic matter and are stored in the biotic
reservoirs of organic phase.
Figure 14.3
The organic elements of plants and animals are released in a variety of ways:
i. Decomposition of leaf falls from the plants, dead plants and animals by decomposers
and their conversion into soluble inorganic form.
ii. Burning of vegetation by lightning, accidental forest fires or deliberate action of
man. The portions of organic matter on burning are released to the atmosphere and
these again fall down, under the impact of precipitation, on the ground and become
soluble inorganic form of element to join soil storage, while some portions in the
form of ashes are decomposed by bacterial activity and join soil storage.
iii. The waste materials released by animals are decomposed by bacteria and find their
way in soluble inorganic form of soil storage
Thus, biogeochemical cycles involve the movement and circulation of soluble inorganic
substances (nutrients) derived from sedimentary and atmospheric phases of inorganic
substances (the two basic components of inorganic phase) through biotic phase and finally
their return to inorganic state. The study of biogeochemical cycles may be approached on
two scales:
Q.1 Differentiate the types of ecosystems on the basis of source and level of energy.
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
____________________
Q.3 Explain the two laws on which the energy flow work in an ecosystem.
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________
_______________
14.8 CONCLUSION
It makes us clear that the environment, habitat or ecosystem we live in is not as
simple as it seems. It is much more complex all tied up together to perform specific functions
altogether which help the ecosystem or the ecology to flourish. Any type of disturbance
created in a small phase may result in a drastic change over time and affects almost all the
link-ups of the chain. This clarifies that everything is bounded to each other, hence, to
support it and conserve it is the very need of everyone on this planet.
14.9 SUMMARY
Ecology is a science that studies the interdependent, mutually reactive and inter
connected relationships between the organisms and their physical environment on one
hand and among the organisms on the other hand.
The term ecology has been derived from ‘oecology’, made by two Greek words
‘oikos’ means house or dwelling as habitat and ‘logos’ meaning the study of.
Ecosystem is ‘A particular category of physical systems, consisting of organisms and
inorganic components in a relatively stable equilibrium, open and of various sizes and
kinds.’
The term ecosystem was first used by A.G. Tansley in 1935.
Ecosystems are regarded as the basic units of ecology by many ecologists because
they are complex, interdependent and highly organized systems and because they are
basic building blocks of biosphere.
By learning how ecosystems function, we can improve our ability to predict how they
will respond to changes in the environment.
The nutrients driven by energy flow pass into various components of biotic
communities through the process known as ‘biogeochemical cycles’.
A sere represents the development of a series of sequential successions starting from
primary succession and culminating into the last succession in a sere as ‘climax’ or
‘climatic climax’ which is the most stable situation of an ecosystem.
14.10 GLOSSARY
Biogeochemical cycle: The circulation and movement of soluble organic matter (nutrients)
derived from sedimentary and atmospheric phases and reservoirs through organic phase of
various biotic components and finally their return to inorganic phase is collectively called
biogeochemical cycles.
Ecological Productivity: refers to the rate of growth of organic matter per unit area per unit
time in a given natural ecosystem.
Food Chain: It is a sequence of energy transfer from the lower trophic levels to the higher
trophic levels in a natural ecosystem.
Gross Primary Production:It is the total amount of energy produced by the autotrophs at
trophic level one.
Net Primary Production: The amount of energy or organic matter fixed or stored at trophic
level one is called net primary ecological production, which excludes the amount of energy
from gross primary production which is lost through respiration by the autotrophs. Thus, net
primary production is gross primary production minus the energy lost through respiration.
Sere: A sere represents the development of a series of sequential successions starting from
primary succession and culminating into the last succession in a sere as ‘climax’ or ‘climatic
climax’ which is the most stable situation of an ecosystem.
Ans.1 Ecosystems are regarded as the basic units of ecology by many ecologists because
they are complex, interdependent and highly organized systems and because they are
basic building blocks of biosphere.
Ans.2 By learning how ecosystems function, we can improve our ability to predict how
they will respond to changes in the environment.
Law I: In any system of constant mass, energy is neither created nor destroyed but it
can be transferred from one type to another type. The energy flow or input in a
system is balanced by energy outflow.
Law II: When work is done, energy is dissipated and the work is done when one
form of energy is transformed into another form.
14.12 REFERENCES
1. Wilson, E. O., 1992, The Diversity of Life, Cambridge, Harvard University Press.
2. World Resources, 1998-1999, joint publication by the World Resource Institute (WRI),
UNEP, UNDP and the World Bank, Oxford University Press, 1998.
3. Leith, Helmut and R. H. Whittakar, (eds.), 1995, The Primary Production of Biosphere,
New York, Springer-Velag.
4. Peters, R. L. and T. E. Lovjoy, (eds.), Global Warming and Biological Diversity, New
Haveen, Yale University Press.
4. Strahler, A., 1996, Physical Geography, New York, John Wiley & Sons.
15.1 OBJECTIVES
15.2 INTRODUCTION
15.3 BIO-DIVERSITY: MEANING AND CONCEPT
15.4 DISTRIBUTION OF BIODIVERSITY
15.5 BIODIVERSITY DEPLETION AND ITS CAUSES
15.5.1 HABITAT DESTRUCTION
15.5.2 INTRODUCED AND INVASIVE SPECIES
15.5.3 GENETIC POLLUTION
15.5.4 OVER EXPLOITATION
15.5.5 HYBRIDIZATION, GENETIC POLLUTION/
EROSION AND FOOD SECURITY
15.5.6 CLIMATE CHANGE
15.5.7 HUMAN OVERPOPULATION
15.6 CONSERVATION
15.7 PROTECTION AND RESTORATION TECHNIQUES
15.8 CONCLUSION
15.9 SUMMARY
15.10 GLOSSARY
15.11 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
15.12 REFERENCES
15.13 SUGGESTED READINGS
15.14 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 262 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
15.1 OBJECTIVES
After studying this unit, you should be able to:
Understand the concept of Biodiversity and Define genetic, species and ecosystem
diversity.
Describe the hot-spots and threats to biodiversity.
Differentiate In-situ and Ex-situ conservation of biodiversity
15.2 INTRODUCTION
Biodiversity or biological diversity is the foundation of life on the earth. It is crucial
for the functioning of ecosystem which provides us with products and services without which
we couldn’t live. Biodiversity is extremely complex, dynamic and varied like other features
of the earth. Its innumerable plants, animals and microbes physically and chemically unite
the atmosphere, geosphere and hydrosphere into one environmental system which makes it
possible for millions of species, including people, to exist.
The increasing interest in biodiversity is a result of concern regarding species
extinction, depletion of genetic diversity and disruption in the atmosphere, water supplies,
fisheries and forests.
1. ‘Biodiversity is the full variety of the biosphere. All the species of living organism, including
plants, animals and microorganism. Biodiversity also includes the genetic variability within
species and the biotic communities in which they interacts’. ( Joseph Kerski and Simon
Ross,2005)
2. ‘A term describing the variety of species, both flora and fauna, contained within an
ecosystem’. ( John Small and Michael Withesick, 1995)
3. ‘The variability among living organism from all sources, including, “inner alia”, terrestrial,
marine and other aquatic ecosystem and the ecological complexes of which they are part: this
includes diversity within species, between species and of ecosystem’. ( United Nations Earth
Submit, 1992)
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 263 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The Biodiversity is abbreviated form of Biological Diversity. The term first coined by
Walter G. Rosen in 1986. As a concept, it has aggravated the debate and understanding
among the general public and academician alike. A lot has been discussed on the subject
since its first appearance at the National Forum on Biodiversity in September, 1986. But
what is biodiversity, what threatens it, why is it important and what are we geographers
doing to better understand it?
The Biodiversity is defined as the variety of life on Earth, it includes all organisms, species,
and populations; the genetic variation among these; and their complex assemblages of
communities and ecosystems.
Further it also refers to the interrelatedness of genes, species, and ecosystems and in turn,
their interactions with the environment.
Types of Biodiversity
The expression of biodiversity is the biological resources (genes, species, organisms,
ecosystems) and ecological processes of which they are part. Biodiversity is therefore
considered at 3 major levels: genetic, species and ecosystem diversity.
1. Genetic Diversity: This is the variety of genetic information contained in all of the
individual plants, animals and microorganisms occurring within populations of species.
Simply it is the variation of genes within all the different genes contained in all the living
species, including individual plants, animals, fungi, microorganisms and populations.
2. Species Diversity: This is the variety of species or the living organisms. Species
Richness - This refers to the total count/number of species in a defined area. Various
indices are used including the Mangalet index and Menhink index. Species Abundance -
This refers to the relative numbers among species. If all the species have the same equal
abundance, this means that the variation is high hence high diversity, however if the one
species is represented by 96 individuals, whilst the rest are represented by 1 species
each, this is low diversity. Taxonomic or phylogenetic diversity - This considers the
genetic relationships between the different groups of species. The measures are based on
analysis, resulting into a hierarchical classification representing the phylogenetic
evolution of the taxa concerned. Is all the different species, as well as the differences
within and between different species?
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 264 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Importance of Biodiversity
The value and importance of biodiversity are viewed in terms of benefits we get directly or
indirectly from biological communities comprising plants, animals and micro-organism.
Biodiversity provides a variety of environmental services through its species and ecosystem
that are essential at the global, regional and local level. The production of oxygen, reduction
of carbon dioxide, maintaining the water cycle, and protecting soil are some important
services. The world now acknowledges that the loss of biodiversity contributes to global
climate changes.
1. Direct Use Value: refers to the assignment of value to those ecological products
which are directly harvested from plants and animals such as food, seeds, timber,
skins, furs etc.
2. Indirect Use Value: is assigned to those ecological resources which are intangible and
not directly exploited and consumed, such as sight-seeing, bird watching, animal
watching (eco-tourism) etc. the other items of indirect use of biodiversity include
ecological services such as purification of air and water, moderation of weather and
climate, absorption of emission of carbon dioxide from anthropogenic sources,
regulation of hydrological cycle, creation and maintenance of soils and enrichment of
soil fertility etc.
Biodiversity is not evenly distributed; rather it varies greatly across the globe as well
as within regions. The spatial distribution of the organisms, species, and populations depends
on a number of factors and their complex temporal relations. The major factors which affect
the biodiversity of the region include the climate, altitude, soils, presence of other species etc.
Different regions on the planet have specific sets of environmental conditions, which results
in differences in predominant vegetation.
Generally, there is an increase in biodiversity from the poles to the tropics. Thus,
locations at lower latitudes have more species than localities at higher latitudes. This is often
referred to as the latitudinal gradients in species diversity. Even though terrestrial
biodiversity declines from the equator to the poles, some studies claims that this
characteristic is unverified in aquatic ecosystem, especially in marine ecosystem. Species
residing in different regions are characterized by specific adaptations that allow success
under the particular set of environmental conditions of the region. Regions can be broadly
divided into terrestrial biomes and aquatic ecosystems
The Biome is abbreviation of Biological Home. The environmentalists are not
unanimous over the universal definition as well as classification of biome. A Biome is a large
geographical area of distinctive plant and animal groups, which are adapted to that particular
environment. Here, all the biota has the minimum common characteristics and all the areas of
biomes are characterized by more or less uniform environmental conditions. Although, a
biome includes both plant and animal communities but a biome is usually identified and
named on the basis of its dominant vegetation, which normally constitutes the bulk of the
biomass. These vegetations are most obvious and conspicuous visible component of the
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 265 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
landscape. Biomass is the total weight of all living organisms’ viz. plants and animals, found
in the biome. A biome is not an ecosystem. If you take a closer look, you will notice that
different plants or animals in a biome have similar adaptations that make it possible for them
to exist in that area. There are many major biomes on earth.
Biome
Tropical Forest
Taiga Forest Biome Arctic Tundra Biome
Biome
Temperate
Desert Biome
Grassland Biome
The Mediterranean
Biome
Warm Temperate
Biome
Figure 15.1
Terrestrial Biomes
Terrestrial biomes are distinguished primarily by their predominant vegetation, and
are mainly determined by temperature and rainfall. There is a close relationship between the
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 266 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
world distributional patterns of plants and animal species and the climatic types of the world.
Thus, based on this relationship the terrestrial biomes have been divided into 3 major biome
types:
Figure 15.2
Among these, the Tropical Evergreen Rain Forest Biome is encompassing largest
biodiversity and being discussed in detail in following section:
Tropical Evergreen Rain Forest Biome: The tropical rainforests are primarily located
in the tropics, a band around the equator from 23.5oN to 23.5oS. Tropical rainforests are
found in the world’s hottest and wettest areas. Tropical rainforests are characterized in two
words: warm and wet. Mean monthly temperatures exceed 18 °C (64 °F) during all months
of the year. Average annual rainfall is no less than 168 cm (66 in) and can exceed 1,000 cm
(390 in) although it typically lies between 175 cm (69 in) and 200 cm (79 in).
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 267 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The tropical rainforest is earth’s most complex biome in terms of both structure and
species diversity. Tropical forests contain 70% of the world’s vascular plants, 30% of all bird
species and 90% of all invertebrates. The reason is that the tropical forest occurs under
optimal growing conditions: abundant precipitation and year round warmth. Climates where
tropical rain forests develop (in Walter’s equatorial climate zone) are always warm and
receive at least 200 cm of precipitation throughout the year, with no less than 10 cm during
any single month. These conditions prevail in three important regions within the tropics
(Figure 15.2). First, the Amazon and Orinoco basins of South America, along with additional
areas in Central America and along the Atlantic coast of Brazil, constitute the Neotropical
rain forest. Second, the area from southernmost West Africa and extending eastward through
the Congo River basin makes up the African rain forest (with an added area on the eastern
side of the island of Madagascar). Third, the Indo-Malayan rain forest covers parts of
Southeast Asia (Vietnam, Thailand, and the Malay Peninsula); the islands between Asia and
Australia, including the Philippines, Borneo, and New Guinea; and the Queensland coast of
Australia. The tropical rain forest climate often exhibits two peaks of rainfall centered on the
equinoxes, corresponding to the periods when the intertropical convergence lies over the
equator. Rain forest soils are typically old and deeply weathered oxisols. Because they are
relatively devoid of humus and clay, they take on the reddish color of aluminum and iron
oxides and retain nutrients poorly.
In spite of the low nutrient status of the soils, rain forest vegetation is dominated by a
continuous canopy of tall evergreen trees rising to 30–40 m. Occasional emergent trees rise
above the canopy to heights of 55 m or so. Because water stress on emergent trees is great
due to their height and exposure, they are often deciduous, even in a mostly evergreen rain
forest. Tropical rain forests typically have several understory layers beneath the canopy,
containing smaller trees, shrubs, and herbs, but these are usually quite sparse because so little
light penetrates the canopy. Climbing lianas, or woody vines, and epiphytes, plants that grow
on the branches of other plants and are not rooted in soil, are prominent in the forest canopy
itself. Species diversity is higher than anywhere else on earth. Per unit of area, the biological
productivity of tropical rain forests exceeds that of any other terrestrial biome, and their
standing biomass exceeds that of all other biomes except temperate rain forests. Because of
the continuously high temperatures and abundant moisture, plant litter decomposes quickly,
and the vegetation immediately takes up the released nutrients. This rapid nutrient cycling
supports the high productivity of the rain forest, but it also makes the rain forest ecosystem
extremely vulnerable to disturbance. When tropical rain forests are cut and burned, many of
the nutrients are carted off in logs or go up in smoke. The vulnerable soils erode rapidly and
fill the streams with silt. In many cases, the environment degrades rapidly and the landscape
becomes unproductive.
The tropical rainforest has dense vegetation. The combination of heat and moisture
make this biome as perfect environment for a great variety of plants and animal species. A
tropical rainforest is typically divided into four main layers, each with different plants and
animals adapted for life in that particular area: the emergent, canopy, understory and forest
floor layers.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 268 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The emergent layer contains a small number of very large trees called emergent, which
grow above the general canopy, reaching heights of 45–55 m, although on occasion a few
species will grow to 70–80 m tall. They need to be able to withstand the hot temperatures and
strong winds that occur above the canopy in some areas. Most of them are hard wood trees
like ebony, Mahogany, rose wood, sandalwood, cinchona, etc. The canopy layer contains
the majority of the largest trees, typically 30–45 m tall. The densest areas of biodiversity are
found in the forest canopy, a more or less continuous cover of foliage formed by adjacent
treetops. The canopy, by some estimates, is home to 50 percent of all plant species,
suggesting that perhaps half of all life on Earth could be found there. Epiphytic plants attach
to trunks and branches, and obtain water and minerals from rain and debris that collects on
the supporting plants. The most important plant of this group is palm trees.
Sunlight
Emergent
Canopy
Under canopy
Forest Floor
Figure 15.3
The under canopy layer lies between the canopy and the forest floor. The under
canopy (or understory) is home to a number of birds, snakes and lizards, as well as predators
such as jaguars, boa constrictors and leopards. The leaves are much larger at this level. Insect
life is also abundant.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 269 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
greatest diversity in this zone, with over 500 species of birds recorded at single tropical
localities of restricted extent. Characteristic groups include pigeons, parrots, hummingbirds,
hornbills, toucans, ovenbirds, antbirds, cotingas, pittas, birds-of-paradise, babblers, bulbuls,
and tanagers. Lizards, snakes, and frogs also exhibit their greatest diversity in the rain forest,
including many groups restricted to it. Caecilians are a major amphibian group restricted to
the tropics, mostly in forested areas. With so much water available, there is also a
tremendous diversity of aquatic animals in this zone with alligators, tactless, fishes, frogs,
Hippopotamus etc., although the temperate-to-tropical diversity gradient is not as extreme as
in most terrestrial groups.
Over geological times the tropics have had a more stable climate than the temperate
zones. In tropics, therefore, local species continued to live there itself, whereas in
temperate they tend to disperse to other areas.
Tropical communities are older than temperate ones and, therefore, there has been
more time for them to evolve. This could are allowed them greater degree of
specialization and local adaptation to occur.
Warm temperature and high humidity in most tropical areas provide favorable
conditions for many species that are unable to survive in temperate areas.
In tropics, there may be greater pressure from pests, parasites and diseases. This does
not allow any single species to dominate and thus there is opportunity for many
species to co-exist. On the contrary in temperate zones there is reduced pest pressure
due to cold, and there is one or a few dominating species that excludes many other
species.
Among plants, rates of outcrossing appear to be higher in tropics. Higher rates of
outcrossing may lead to higher level of genetic variability.
Tropical areas receive more solar energy over the year. Thus tropical communities
are more productive or greater resource base that can support a wider range of
species.
Temperate grasslands are composed of a rich mix of grasses and forbs and underlain
by some of the world’s most fertile soils. Temperate grasslands are located north of the
Tropic of' cancer and south of the Tropic of Capricorn to up to 50 o- 55o North and South.
Grasslands are found on every continent except Antarctica and have local names. The major
temperate grassland include the ‘steppes’ of' Eurasia, ‘prairies’ of North America, the
'pampas' of South America, ‘veld’ of Africa, and the ‘downs’ of Australia.
Temperatures in this biome vary greatly between summer and winter. The summers
are hot and the winters are cold, it’s surprising how hot the grassland summers can get!
Sometimes the temperature is more than 100°F (37.8°C) while the winter temperature can be
as low as -15°C. Rain in the temperate grasslands usually occurs in the late spring and early
summer. The yearly average is about 20 - 35 inches (55 - 95 cm), but much of this falls as
snow in the winter. Grasses are the dominant vegetation. Trees and large shrubs are largely
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 270 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
absent. Seasonal drought, occasional fires and grazing by large mammals all prevent woody
shrubs and trees from becoming established. A few trees such as cottonwoods, oaks and
willows grow in river valleys, and a few hundred species of flowers grow among the grasses.
The various species of grasses include purple needle grass, blue grama, buffalo grass, and
galleta. Flowers include asters, blazing stars, coneflowers, goldenrods, sunflowers, clovers,
psoraleas, and wild indigos.
All grasslands share a lack of shelter from predators, and an abundance of grass for
food; therefore, grassland animal populations are similar throughout the world. The dominant
vertebrates in grasslands are herbivorous or plant-eating grazers called ungulates. Ungulates
are mammals with hoofs, like horses and deer. Their long legs help them run fast to escape
grassland predators.
Figure 15.4
The temperate grassland fauna is very low in diversity, especially in comparison with
the tropical grasslands. In North America the dominant herbivores are bison Bison bison) and
pronghorn (the sole member of the Nearctic endemic family, Antilocapridae). Rodent
herbivores include the pocket gopher (another Nearctic endemic), ground squirrels, and the
prairie dog. Carnivores include coyote (actually an omnivore), badger, and the federally
endangered black-footed ferret, the last two members of the weasel family. Birds include
grouses, meadowlarks, quails, sparrows, hawks and owls. On the Russian steppes the fauna
formerly included wisent (Bison bonasus), tarpan or wild horse, and saiga antelope, among
others. Mole rats, fossorial members of one of the two mammal families endemic to the
Palearctic, are conspicuous by virtue their many mounds. Polecats and other members of the
weasel family are among the larger, extant carnivores.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 271 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The Arctic tundra is the biome that lies between the edge of the taiga (or boreal
forest), or tree line, and the permanent ice caps closer to the North Pole or the Arctic Ocean.
Often thought of as a barren and somewhat rocky biome, the tundra surrounds the pole and is
the dominant biome in the Arctic and Subarctic regions. The word “tundra” comes from a
word used by the Sami people of northwestern Russia that means “barren land” or “treeless
land.” The tundra is the world’s youngest biome, having formed about 10,000 years ago at
the end of the last ice age.
Figure 15.5
The climate of the Arctic is largely determined by the relatively low solar angles with respect
to the earth. Differences in photoperiod between summer and winter become more extreme
toward the north. Beyond the Arctic Circle, the sun remains above the horizon at midnight on
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 272 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
midsummer’s day and remains below the horizon at midday on midwinter’s day. The arctic is
known for its cold, desert-like conditions. The growing season ranges from 50 to 60 days.
The average winter temperature is -34° C (-30° F), but the average summer temperature is 3-
12° C (37-54° F) which enables this biome to sustain life. Rainfall may vary in different
regions of the arctic. Yearly precipitation, including melting snow, is 15 to 25 cm (6 to 10
inches). Soil is formed slowly. A layer of permanently frozen subsoil called permafrost
exists, consisting mostly of gravel and finer material. The permafrost itself can reach
between 300 to 1,500 feet deep. The permafrost severely hinders makes plant growth in the
tundra. When water saturates the upper surface, bogs and ponds may form, providing
moisture for plants. There are no deep root systems in the vegetation of the arctic tundra;
however, there are still a wide variety of plants that are able to resist the cold climate. There
are about 1,700 kinds of plants in the arctic and subarctic, and these include low shrubs,
sedges, reindeer mosses, liverworts, and grasses, 400 varieties of flowers, crustose and
foliose lichen.
All of the plants are adapted to sweeping winds and disturbances of the soil. Plants
are short and group together to resist the cold temperatures and are protected by the snow
during the winter. They can carry out photosynthesis at low temperatures and low light
intensities. The growing seasons are short and most plants reproduce by budding and division
rather than sexually by flowering. The fauna in the arctic is also diverse; the herbivorous
mammals include lemmings, voles, caribou, arctic hares and squirrels etc.; the Carnivorous
mammals include arctic foxes, wolves, and polar bears etc.; migratory birds include ravens,
snow buntings, falcons, loons, sandpipers, terns, snow birds, and various species of gulls etc.;
the insects include mosquitoes, flies, moths, grasshoppers, black flies and arctic bumble bees
etc.; among fishes cod, flatfish, salmon, etc. The trout animals are adapted to handle long,
cold winters and to breed and raise young quickly in the summer. Animals such as mammals
and birds also have additional insulation from fat. Many animals hibernate during the winter
because food is not abundant. Another alternative is to migrate south in the winter, like birds
do. Reptiles and amphibians are few or absent because of the extremely cold temperatures.
Because of constant immigration and emigration, the population continually oscillates.
Aquatic Biome
Water is the common link among the five biomes and it makes up the largest part of
the biosphere, covering nearly 75% of the Earth’s surface. Aquatic regions house numerous
species of plants and animals, both large and small. In fact, this is where life began billions of
years ago when amino acids first started to come together. Although water temperatures can
vary widely, aquatic areas tend to be more humid and the air temperature on the cooler side.
The aquatic biome can be broken down into two basic regions, freshwater (i.e., ponds and
rivers) and marine (i.e., oceans and estuaries). We are discussing here the marine region of
aquatic biome. Marine regions cover about three fourths of the Earth’s surface and include
oceans, coral reefs, and estuaries. Marine algae supply much of the world’s oxygen supply
and take in a huge amount of atmospheric carbon dioxide. The evaporation of the seawater
provides rainwater for the land.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 273 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The largest of all the ecosystems, oceans are very large bodies of water that dominate
the Earth’s surface. Like ponds and lakes, the ocean regions are separated into separate
zones: intertidal, pelagic, abyssal, and benthic. All four zones have a great diversity of
species. Some say that the ocean contains the richest diversity of species even though it
contains fewer species than there are on land. The intertidal zone is where the ocean meets
the land—sometimes it is submerged and at other times exposed, as waves and tides come in
and out. Because of this, the communities are constantly changing. On rocky coasts, the zone
is stratified vertically. Where only the highest tides reach, there are only a few species of
algae and mollusks. In those areas usually submerged during high tide, there is a more
diverse array of algae and small animals, such as herbivorous snails, crabs, sea stars, and
small fishes. At the bottom of the intertidal zone, which is only exposed during the lowest
tides, many invertebrates, fishes, and seaweed can be found. The intertidal zone on sandier
shores is not as stratified as in the rocky areas. Waves keep mud and sand constantly moving,
thus very few algae and plants can establish themselves—the fauna include worms, clams,
predatory crustaceans, crabs, and shorebirds.
The pelagic zone includes those waters further from the land, basically the open
ocean. The pelagic zone is generally cold though it is hard to give a general temperature
range since, just like ponds and lakes, there is thermal stratification with a constant mixing of
warm and cold ocean currents. The flora in the pelagic zone include surface seaweeds. The
fauna include many species of fish and some mammals, such as whales and dolphins. Many
feed on the abundant plankton.
The benthic zone is the area below the pelagic zone, but does not include the very
deepest parts of the ocean (see abyssal zone below). The bottom of the zone consists of sand,
slit, and/or dead organisms. Here temperature decreases as depth increases toward the abyssal
zone, since light cannot penetrate through the deeper water. Flora are represented primarily
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 274 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
by seaweed while the fauna, since it is very nutrient rich, include all sorts of bacteria, fungi,
sponges, sea anemones, worms, sea stars, and fishes.
The deep ocean is the abyssal zone. The water in this region is very cold (around 3°
C), highly pressured, high in oxygen content, but low in nutritional content. The abyssal zone
supports many species of invertebrates and fishes. Mid-ocean ridges (spreading zones
between tectonic plates), often with hydrothermal vents, are found in the abyssal zones along
the ocean floors. Chemosynthetic bacteria thrive near these vents because of the large
amounts of hydrogen sulfide and other minerals they emit. These bacteria are thus the start of
the food web as they are eaten by invertebrates and fishes.
Coral reefs are widely distributed in warm shallow waters. They can be found as
barriers along continents (e.g., the Great Barrier Reef off Australia), fringing islands, and
atolls. Naturally, the dominant organisms in coral reefs are corals. Corals are interesting since
they consist of both algae (zooanthellae) and tissues of animal polyp. Since reef waters tend
to be nutritionally poor, corals obtain nutrients through the algae via photosynthesis and also
by extending tentacles to obtain plankton from the water. Besides corals, the fauna include
several species of microorganisms, invertebrates, fishes, sea urchins, octopuses, and sea stars.
Estuaries are areas where freshwater streams or rivers merge with the ocean. This mixing of
waters with such different salt concentrations creates a very interesting and unique
ecosystem. Microflora like algae, and macroflora, such as seaweeds, marsh grasses, and
mangrove trees (only in the tropics), can be found here. Estuaries support a diverse fauna,
including a variety of worms, oysters, crabs, and waterfowl.
At its simplest level, diversity can be defined as the number of species found in a
community, a measure is known as species richness. Many methods of calculating diversity
have been propped that combine these two types of information. Mathematically indices of
biodiversity have also been developed to connate species diversity at different geographical
scales as follows.
1. Alpha Diversity: this refers to number of species in a single community. This diversity
comes closest to the popular concepts of species richness and can be used to compare
the number of species in different ecosystem types.
2. Beta Diversity: this refers to the degree to which species composition changes along
environmental gradients. Beta diversity is high for example, if the species composition
of mass communities changes at successively higher elevations on a mountain slope,
but it low if the same species occupy the whole mountain side.
3. Gamma Diversity: this applies to larger geographical scales and defined as “the rate at
which additional species are encountered as geographical replacements within a habitat
type in different localities. Thus gamma diversity is a species turnover rate with
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 275 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Biodiversity Hotspot
The term ‘biodiversity hotspot’ was first coined and used by Nornam Myers, a British
ecologist, in the year 1998. He defined biodiversity hotspot as those areas which have rich
biological communities including plants, animals and microorganism wherein endemic
species predominate. He identified 10 such very rich biodiversity areas i.e. tropical rainforest
biomes.
The regions or areas having richest biodiversity are called ‘biodiversity hotspot’ or
‘mega-diversity regions’. The hotspot of biodiversity are, in fact, such areas which are
characteristics by high level of biological diversity and large percentage of endemic species
such as Amazonia, Malaysian Peninsula, New Zealand, Madagascar, South Africa, North-
eastern Australia, Western Ghats of India, Philippines, Tropical Andes, Eastern Himalaya,
Mediterranean region etc. in all, about 34 hot spot of rich biodiversity have been identified in
the world of which 3 hot spots are found in India e.g. (1) Western Ghats, (2) North-Eastern
India, and (3) Himalayas.
According to Mora and Colleagues, the total number of terrestrial species is estimated
to be around 8.7 million, while the number of oceanic species is much lower, estimated at 2.2
million.
According to the Global Taxonomy, initiatives and the European Distributed Institute
of Taxonomy the total number of species for some phyla may be much higher than what is
shown in table 15.2.
10-30 million insects; (of some 0.9 million we know today)
5-10 million bacteria
1.5 million fungi;
1 million mites
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 276 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Taxonomists are aware that their work in finding and describing new species is
incomplete. Whatever the number, the plants biodiversity represents an amazing and diverse
storehouse of biological wealth.
Biodiversity of India
India is one of the twelve mega-biodiversity countries. Each of the ten biogeographic
zones of the country has characteristics biota, and broadly represents similar climatic
conditions and constitutes the habitat for diverse species of flora and fauna. Based on a
survey of about two-third of the geographical area of the country, the Ministry of Forest and
Environment reported that India have at present about 45,000 plants and 77,000 of animals
species representing about 7 percent of the world flora and 6.5 percent of the global
biodiversity.
India has 350 different mammals (rated the eighth highest in the world), 1,200 species of
birds (eighth in the world), 453 species of reptiles. These includes, especially, high species
diversity of ferns (1,022 species) and orchids (1,082 species). India has 50,000 known
species of insects, including 13,000 butterflies and moths. It is estimated that the number of
known species could be several times higher.
It is estimated that 18 percent of Indian plants are endemic to the country and found
nowhere else in the world. Among the plants species, the flowering plants have much higher
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 277 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
degree endemism, a third of these are not found elsewhere in the world. Among amphibians
found in India, 62 percent are unique to this country.
India is also considered one of the world’s eight centers of origin of cultivated plants.
It has 51 species of cereals and millets, 104 species of fruits, 27 species of spices and
condiments, 55 species of vegetables and pulses, 24 species of fibre crops, 12 species of
oilseeds and various wild strains of tea, coffee, tobacco and sugar cane. India also has
significant indigenous livestock diversity, with 27 breeds of cattle, 40 breeds of sheep and 22
breeds of goats
Among the 34 hotspot of the world, three Indian biodiversity hotspot extend to
neighboring countries. In eastern Himalayas, numerous primitive angiosperm families as
magnoliaceae and Winteraceae with primitive genera like Magnolia and Betula are found.
Asian Elephants, Indian tigers and lion-tailed macaque are found in the Western Ghats.
The Himalayas and Western Ghats are the two Indian mountain biodiversity global
hotspot. These both show rich and unique biodiversity in terms of rich species endemism.
The richness and uniqueness of biodiversity in Himalayan hotspot 15.4.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 278 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
the international community that a system should be put in place to slow or halt the process
of extinction. All the species are the integral part of ecosystem and extinction of some
species diminishes the well-being of the remaining species, including human being. The
concern about biological diversity is the shrinking genetic pool. It is estimated that tropical
forests contain at least 50 percent and perhaps, 90 percent of the world’s species. According
to an estimated, 20-75 species are becoming extinct each day because of deforestation in the
tropics.
Before the appearance of economic man on this planet earth species extinction was
caused only by natural processes but now anthropogenic processes of species extinction has
outplayed natural process. For example, the rate of extinction of species has increased
phenomenally after 1850 due to increased human activities, the average rate of extinction
was two to three species per decade between 1600 and 1850 but the thereafter the rate
increased to 1,000 species per decade. As per estimates of Paul Ehrlich, one third to two third
of all species currently existing on this planet earth may become extinct by 2050.
The World Conservation Monitoring Centre has evaluated and described the threat to
about 88,000 plants and 2,000 animal species in its series of Red Data Book. However, there
are also species of fish (343), amphibians (50), reptiles (170), birds (1,037), and mammals
(497).
Economic Factors
Habitat
Destructio Land use
change
Biodiversit Climate
Pollution
y Depletion
Unsustainable
Invasive Alien Natural Resource
Species Use
Demographic Institutional
Factors Factors
Direct Causes
Underlying Causes
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 279 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Figure No 15.9: Loss of biodiversity with continued agricultural expansion, pollution, and Climate
change and infrastructure development
The major direct causes of human-induced biodiversity loss are the fragmentation,
degradation or loss of habitats the over-exploitation of natural resources; pollution of air and
water; the introduction of non-native (alien, or exotic) species and climate change-induced
biodiversity loss; these factors being inextricably linked with some or all of the other direct
causes and in turn are driven by underlying causes.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 280 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
the clearing of natural vegetation for agriculture or road construction, which divides
previously continuous habitats. Larger remnants, and remnants that are close to other
remnants, are less affected by fragmentation. Small fragments of habitat can only support
small populations, which tend to be more vulnerable to extinction. Moreover, habitat
along the edge of a fragment has a different climate and favors different species to the
interior. Small fragments are therefore unfavorable for those species that require interior
habitat, and they may lead to the extinction of those species. Species that are specialized
to particular habitats and those whose dispersal abilities are weak suffer from
fragmentation more than generalist species with good dispersal ability. Fragmentation
affects all biomes, but especially forests and major freshwater systems. More than 40,000
large dams and hundreds of thousands of smaller barriers plug up the world's rivers,
altering water temperatures, sediment loads, seasonal flow patterns, and other river
characteristics to which native fish are adapted. Levees disconnect rivers from their
floodplains, eliminating backwaters and wetlands that are important fish spawning
grounds. Engineering projects alter river inflows, and agricultural and industrial pollution
of waterways further reduces fish habitat.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 281 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Most water pollution is the result of the introduction of various substances into water
bodies that have negative effects on ecosystems. In most modern industrial societies industry
is the greatest source of pollution, accounting for more than half the volume of all water
pollution and for the most deadly pollutants. Thousands of manufacturing facilities use huge
quantities of freshwater to carry away wastes of many kinds. The waste-bearing water, or
effluent, is discharged into streams, lakes, or oceans, which in turn disperse the polluting
substances. Water pollution has, among other consequences, the tendency to cause long-term
modifications of biodiversity. Eutrophication is one of the most noticeable long-term
alterations. This phenomenon occurs within aquatic environments that are fed only little new
water: lakes, ponds, slow rivers, river mouths. Some techniques, such as phyto-remediation,
have been implemented in order to limit eutrophication.
Coastal waters and zonesare the most biologically diverse marine environments; this
applies to the water column, the shoreline and the seabed. These are also the areas in
which spilled oil naturally tends to accumulate29. Taking this into consideration, one can
easily see why large and very visible damage occurs to coastal zones in case an oil spill
reaches the shoreline. Seabirds breeding and feeding in coastal areas are faced with a
high rate of mortality. The same applies to various mammal species although their
mortality rates are usually lower. Benthic organisms are usually heavily damaged, as are
fish spawning areas and coastal and seabed vegetation. Human assets, such as
aquaculture installations, tourism and leisure facilities but also infrastructure and
industrial installations are affected in the short and medium term. On a more general
level, this might even lead to an interference of work and social life.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 282 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
In agriculture and animal husbandry, the Green Revolution popularized the use of
conventional hybridization to increase yield. Often hybridized breeds originated in developed
countries and were further hybridized with local varieties in the developing world to create
high yield strains resistant to local climate and diseases. Local governments and industry
have been pushing hybridization. Formerly huge gene pools of various wild and indigenous
breeds have collapsed causing widespread genetic erosion and genetic pollution. This has
resulted in loss of genetic diversity and biodiversity as a whole. Genetic erosion coupled with
genetic pollution may be destroying unique genotypes, thereby creating a hidden crisis which
could result in a severe threat to our food security. Diverse genetic material could cease to
exist which would impact our ability to further hybridize food crops and livestock against
more resistant diseases and climatic changes.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 283 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Changes in climate throughout our planet's history have, of course, altered life on Earth in the
long run ecosystems have come and gone and species routinely go extinct. But rapid,
manmade climate change speeds up the process, without affording ecosystems and species
the time to adapt. For example, rising ocean temperatures and diminishing Arctic sea ice
affects marine biodiversity and can shift vegetation zones, having global
implications.Climate change is a rapidly increasing stress on ecosystems and can exacerbate
the effects of other stresses, including habitat fragmentation, loss and conversion, over-
exploitation, invasive alien species, and pollution. Overall, climate is a major factor in the
distribution of species across the globe; climate change forces them to adjust. But many are
not able to cope, causing them to die out.
Climate change poses a major threat to the Arctic Ocean because it will dramatically
affect its specific characteristics in turn affecting its fauna. In the Coral Triangle area,
activities such as deforestation contribute to the emission of gases which stimulate climate
change. Climate change is perhaps one of the main threats to biodiversity in the Coral
Triangle. Although other factors have been mentioned, such as sedimentation, pollution and
changes in salinity, climate change is most widely reported as the cause of coral bleaching.
But also from other areas it is reported that that climate change affects the habitat quality and
population dynamics of several species. Further, desertification may increase in some other
areas and as a consequence some species could also become more vulnerable to extinction.
Climate change has also been implicated in the decline of amphibians in tropical montane
forests.
The world's population has more than tripled in the 20th Century, and continued growth is
assured over the next 50 years, especially in the developing countries. Humankind's
burgeoning numbers have an increasingly voracious appetite: people use or destroy about 40
percent of the net primary productivity of terrestrial and aquatic plants. At the present pace,
the Earth's renewable resources are rapidly being depleted; the probable doubling of the
world's population over the next 50 years will greatly increase these pressures. The issue of
population is not only a matter of numbers, but also of patterns and levels of resource
consumption. The average resident of an industrialized nation uses 15 times as much paper,
10 times as much steel, and 12 times as much fuel as a person in a developing country.
Population growth and increasing resource consumption affect biodiversity in two ways: they
create pressure to convert wildlife habitat into agricultural and urban land, and they produce
wastes that pollute habitat and poison wildlife. These trends can be offset by stabilizing
populations, using resources more efficiently, recycling, and controlling pollution.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 284 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
15.6 CONSERVATION
Why to conserve Biodiversity?
Biodiversity has an intrinsic value that is worth protecting regardless of its value to
humans. The argument for conservation of biodiversity often emphasizes the need to
facilitate continued evolution. As humans are and were part of nature, they benefited from
the evolutionary process. The tenet that humans are part of nature questions whether humans
should endanger their own milieu and the process from which they stem. While intrinsic
arguments for protection of biodiversity are compelling, it is ultimately arguments of human
benefit that pragmatic conservationists find most appealing: as humans, we are inextricably
and wholly dependent on this diversity of living things for survival. Biodiversity,
encompassing genetic diversity, species, populations, communities and ecosystems, and
landscapes and regions, provides countless benefits to humans at all these scales Biodiversity
performs a number of ecological services for humankind that have economic, aesthetic or
recreational value.
Biodiversity Conservation
A. In-situ conservation: The conservation of ecosystems, natural habitats and the
maintenance of viable species of plants and animals in their natural surroundings are
known as in-situ conservation. Biodiversity of plant and animal species are preserved in-
situ by setting up of protected areas like National Parks and Wildlife Sanctuaries. They
include avariety of ecosystems and habitats. Some have been created in order to protect
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 285 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
highly endangered species of wild plants and animals found nowhere else in the world.
As a result, the population of the great Indian bustard, tiger, lion, elephant, crocodile etc.,
has increased.
Biosphere reserves cover very large areas, often more than 5000 km2. They are used to
protect species for a long time.
A national park is an area dedicated for the conservation of wildlife along with its
environment. It is usually a small reserve covering an area of about 100 to 500 square
kilometers. Within biosphere reserves, one or more national parks may also exist.
A wild sanctuary is an area which is reserved for the conservation of animals only while a
gene sanctuary is an area where plants are conserved.
B. Ex-situ conservation: The conservation of plant and animal species outside their
natural habitat is known as ex-situ conservation. The endangered species (wild plants or
animals) which have reached a point of extinction in their natural habitat are transferred
to other favourable habitat to ensure their survival. Therefore, ex-situ conservation, areas
are established outside its natural habitat in a carefully controlled situation. This leads to
the establishment of botanical garden for plants or a zoological park for animals. There is
also another form of preserving a plant by preserving its germ plasma in a gene bank so
that it can be used if needed in future. However the most important step of a successful
breeding program is the reintroduction of a species into its original wild habitat.
Somatic tissue can be stored for short periods of time in vitro for short periods of
time. This is done in a light and temperature controlled environment that regulates the growth
of cells. As a ex situ conservation technique tissue culture is primary used for clonal
propagation of vegetative tissue or immature seeds. This allows for the proliferation of clonal
plants from a relatively small amount of parent tissue.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 286 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
C. Inter situ conservation is opening a "third front" in the battle to save the biodiversity.
The basic idea is to conserve rare species by reintroducing them to sites where they once
grew, but have been eliminated in recent decades or centuries by human agencies such as,
here in Hawaii, the highly destructive impact of introduced goats, pigs, and rats. The inter
situ approach is spreading rapidly to various places as a very effective method of
biodiversity conservation.
A protected area is, therefore, defined as ‘an area of land especially dedicated to the
protection and maintenance of biological diversity, and managed through legal or other
effective means’ (IUCN).
Protected areas can be established in many ways. The two most common mechanism
are, government action (often at a national level, but also regionally or locally) and purchase
of land carried out by private conservation organizations. The IUCN has developed the
following systems of classification for protected areas that range from minimal to intensive
allowed use of the habitat by man: scientific reserves and strict natural reserves, national
parks, national monuments and landmarks, managed wildlife sanctuaries and nature reserves,
protected landscape, national biotic areas and multiple use management areas etc.
Attempt to determine international priorities and global hotspots very often overlap
considerably. There is general agreement on the need for enhanced conservation efforts in the
following areas of the world.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 287 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Red List
The IUCN Red List of Threatened Species (also known as the IUCN Red List or Red
Data List or Red Data Book), founded in 1964, is the world's most comprehensive inventory
of the global conservation status of biological species.A Red Data Book of International
Union for the Conservation of Nature (IUCN) contains lists of species whose continued
existence is threatened. Species are classified into different categories of perceived risk. Each
Red Data Book usually deals with a specific group of animals or plants. These are now being
published in many different countries and provide useful information on the threat status of
the species.
Under the IUCN Red list the species are classified into nine categories. The Criterion
based on various parameters such as rate of decline, population size, area of geographic
distribution, and degree of population and distribution fragmentation.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 288 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
The Convention was opened for signature at the Earth Summit in Rio de Janeiro on 5
June 1992 and entered into force on 29 December 1993.
Germplasm Banks
Germplasm bank also called gene banks are established for ex-situ conservation of
species. Such gene bank include botanical gardens, animal zoos, genetic resource centres,
culture collections etc. in plant species seeds, pollen grains, vegetable propagative parts,
tissues etc. are collected and stored in such germplasm banks. Several international
organizations could take up the task of ex-situ conversation through establishment of such
gene banks. One such major international group is CGIAR (Constructive Group on
International Agricultural Research) supporting a network of a number of international
agricultural research centres dealing with important crop plants. These research centres could
manage ex-situ collection of nearly 600,000 crop gene pools. A network of gene banks to
conserve a variety of medicinal and aromatic plants has also been established by the G-15
countries (Argentina, Algeria, Brazil, Egypt, India, Malaysia, Mexico, Peru, Nigeria,
Malaysia etc.) this network would ensure conservation of seeds, embryos, pollen and
cultured tissues of important plants species.
Legal protection of Species and Habitat
CASE STUDY
Orissa – Olive Ridley Turtles
Every year at Gahirmatha and two other sites on the Orissa coast, hundreds of thousands of Olive Ridley
turtles congregate on the beach, between December and April, for mass nesting. This was the largest
nesting site for the Olive Ridleys in the world. In 1999 by the end of March it was estimated that around
200,000 turtles had nested at the Gahirmatha beach. Marine biologists believe that only one out of every
1000 eggs actually matures into an adult.
There are severe threats to these nesting sites. Shrinking nesting sites, construction of roads and
buildings close to these rookeries, and other infrastructure development projects hamper nesting. Trawler
fishing is another large threat to the turtles. After its ‘discovery’ in 1974, the beach was notified as a
Sanctuary (the Bhitarkanaika Sanctuary) and was closed for hunting. Recognising the threats to turtles
from fishing by large trawlers, the Orissa Marine Fisheries Regulation Act was passed in 1982. This Act
prohibits trawling within 10 km of the coastline throughout the state and makes it mandatory for all
trawlers to use Turtle Excluder Devices (TEDs). In 2001, the State Government of Orissa declared that a
five month period between January to May should constitute a no-fishing season for a distance of 20 km
from the coastline.
Apart from these initiatives, Operation Kachhapa is being coordinated by the Wildlife Protection
Society of India, Delhi and Wildlife Society of Orissa with many local NGOs as partners. The Orissa
Forest Department, WII, Dehra Dun and the Coast Guard are also involved in the Project.
There are international agreements for the protection of species. The single most
important treaty protecting species at international level is the convention on international
Trade in Endangered Species (CITES) established in 1973 in association with UNDP. The
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 289 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
treaty is currently endorsed by 118 countries. CITES established lists of species whose
international trade is to be controlled.
There are also international agreements for the protection of habitat. Three of the
most important conventions are the Ramsar Convention on Wetlands of International
Importance (1971) especially as Waterfowl Habitat; the convention concerning the protection
of the World Cultural and Natural Heritage (1984) and the UNESCO Biosphere Research
Programme. Legal and administrative measures thus includes: Strict control on habitat,
extraction for trade and industry, total ban on collection of endangered species and
maintenance of germplasm pool.
Public Programme
These include:
involving educational institutions
training for scientific skills
awareness about importance of local plant resources, potential uses and their
sustainable use
Knowledge about value added products derived from plants.
Active participation of people through co-operatives, voluntary organization, mahila
mandals and nature club.
Forests and wildlife
This Act was adopted to protect and conserve forests. The Act restricts the powers of the
state in respect of de-reservation of forests and use of forestland for non-forest purposes
includes clearing any forestland for cultivation of cash crops, plantation crops, horticulture or
any purpose other than re-afforestation.
The WPA (Wildlife Protection Act), 1972, provides for protection to listed species of flora
and fauna and establishes a network of ecologically-important protected areas. The WPA
empowers the central and state governments to declare any area a wildlife sanctuary, national
park or closed area. There is a blanket ban on carrying out any industrial activity inside these
protected areas. It provides for authorities to administer and implement the Act; regulate the
hunting of wild animals; protect specified plants, sanctuaries, national parks and closed areas;
restrict trade or commerce in wild animals or animal articles; and miscellaneous matters. The
Act prohibits hunting of animals except with permission of authorized officer when an
animal has become dangerous to human life or property or so disabled or diseased as to be
beyond recovery (WWF-India, 1999). The near-total prohibition on hunting was made more
effective by the Amendment Act of 1991.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 290 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
3) Biosphere Reserve
Biosphere reserves are areas of terrestrial and coastal ecosystems promoting solutions to
reconcile the conservation of biodiversity with its sustainable use. They are internationally
recognized, nominated by national governments and remain under sovereign jurisdiction of
the states where they are located. Biosphere reserves serve in some ways as 'living
laboratories' for testing out and demonstrating integrated management of land, water and
biodiversity.
Seven of the seventeen biosphere reserves are a part of the World Network of
Biosphere reserves, based on the UNESCO Man and the Biosphere (MAB).
Programme list. Namely, Nilgiri, Gulf of Mannar, Sundrbans, Nanda Devi, Nokrek,
Pachmarhi, and Similipal Biosphere Reserves
15.8 CONCLUSION
After explaining all the aspects of biodiversity it can be said that biodiversity is
combined diversity of all the levels of biological diversification. And it is not evenly
distributed across the planet but shows a rather uneven distribution, certain ecosystems and
regions contain far more species than others. Tropical rainforest, coral reefs, the deep sea,
and large tropical lakes appear to be the most species rich ecosystems on the planet. But with
growing population and exploitation of resources causing threats to habitats and reduction in
species. Based on degree of threat face by the species, species are categories into different
conservation categories.
15.9 SUMMARY
Biodiversity is the variation of living organism and occurs at three level: genetic, species and
community. It includes not only the number of type at each level but also their function and
structure. Unique and rare representatives at each level are given special emphasis by
managers because of their vulnerability to being lost and the resulting threat of a decrease in
biodiversity.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 291 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
15.10 GLOSSARY
i. Biodiversity: simply means variety of living species of organism of both plants and
animals in an ecosystem having certain specific environmental conditions.
ii. Biodiversity Hotspot: are defined as those areas which have rich biological
communities including plants and animals wherein endemic species predominate.
iii. Species Extinction: extinction of species is a biological process of complete
elimination of a species of biological community from natural habitat as well as from
cultivation or captivity as zoos and protected areas.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 292 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Q. 6. How much mass extinction of species are there on records since the origin and
diversification of life on earth? How is the present episode different? What is the result of
loss of biodiversity in a region?
Ans. There were 5 episodes of mass extinction of species. The present sixth episode is in
progress. The current rates of extinction are estimated to be faster than the pre-human times
because of our activities. It is estimated to be faster 100-1000 times. General loss is:
(a) Decline to plant production.
(b) Lowered resistance to environmental disturbances such as droughts.
(c) Increased variability in certain ecosystem processes.
Q. 7. Briefly give the views regarding the reasons for conserving biodiversity.
Ans. There are the following views:
(a) Narrowly utilitarian: We humans derive countless direct economic benefits from nature.
Such as food, medicines and many more utility things.
Nations with rich biodiversity can expect to reap enormous benefits from the increasing
resources put into bioprospecting.
(b) Broadly utilitarian: It says that biodiversity plays a major role in many ecosystem
services that nature provides. There are many intangible benefits that we derive from nature,
including aesthetic pleasures.
(c) Ethical values: All living beings that share this planet have equal right to live as do
humans. We must realize that every species has an intrinsic value, even if we do not have any
current economic value. We have to maintain the biological legacy in good order for future
generations.
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 293 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Q. 9. Among the ecosystem services are control of floods and soil erosion. How is this
achieved by the biotic components of the ecosystem?
Ans. Control of floods and soil erosion are done by preserving the forests. There must be a
balance between the plants and animals to maintain the biodiversity.
15.12 REFERENCES
1. Heywood VH, ed. 1995. Global Biodiversity Assessment. Cambridge (UK):
Cambridge University Press.
2. Heywood, V.H., and R.T. Watson, Eds., 1995: Global biodiversity assessment.
Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 1140 pp. [Global; Biodiversity]
3. Levin, S. A. 2001. Encyclopedia of Biodiversity. Vol. 1 – 5. Academic Press.
4. Mayr, Ernst (1963). Animal Species and Evolution. Cambridge: Belknap Press of
HarvardUniversity Press.797pp.
5. R.H. Whittaker. 1972. Evolution and measurement of species diversity. Taxon,
21:213_251
6. M. Jnr. Hunter. 2002. Fundamentals of Conservation Biology. Second Edition.
Blackwell
Science, Massachusetts, U.S.A.
7. L.A. Nielsen R.L. Knight Meffe, G.K. and D.A. Schenborn. 2002. Ecosystem
management: adaptive, community-based conservation. Island Press, Washington,
D.C.,
8. Borang, A. 2004. Birds of Arunachal Pradesh in North East India – the check list
anddistribution in protected areas (unpublished). Forest Zoology Division, SFRI,
Itanagar.
9. Tripathi, R S and Barik, S K (2003) National Biodiversity Strategy and Action
PlanReport for Northeast India. Ministry of Environment and Forests, New Delhi.
10. Mao, A. A., Singh, K. P. and Hajra, P. K. 2001. Rhododendron. In: Floristic
diversityand Conservation Strategies in India. Vol. IV (eds. K. P. Singh and N. P.
Singh), pp.2167-2202. Botanical Survey of India, Kolkata.
11. Williams, P. H. and Humphries, C. J. 1996. Comparing character diversity among
biotas. Biodiversity. A biology of number and differences. (ed. Gatson, K. J.).
Blackwell Science, Oxford U.K., pp. 54-76.
12. Alkemade, R., M. van Oorschot, L. Miles, C. Nellemann, M. Bakkenes, and B. ten
Brink. 2009. GLOBIO3: A Framework to Investigate Options for Reducing Global
Terrestrial Biodiversity Loss. Ecosystems 12:374-390.
13. Peter M.Vitoasek, Paul R.Ehrlich.Anne H.Ehrlich et al., "Human Appropriation of
the Products of Photosynthesis," BioScience, Vol. 36, No. 6 (1986), pp. 368-373.
14. Millennium Ecosystem Assessment, 2005. Ecosystems and Human Well-being:
Biodiversity Synthesis. World Resources Institute, Washington, DC. Copyright ©
2005 World Resources Institute
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 294 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
Long Questions
1. Biodiversity has various benefits to mankind. Discuss.
2. Explain the causes of biodiversity loss in detail.
Hints: Manmade & natural.
3. Discuss various threats and causes of loss of biodiversity in detail.
4. What are Hot spots of biodiversity?
5. Write three reasons for maximum biodiversity in tropical rain forest.
6. What are sacred groves? Where are they found in India? Name any four. What is their
characteristic feature?
UNIT 15 - BIO -DIVERSITY AND ITS DEPLETION Page 295 of Page 313
B.A./B.Sc. GE-101 UTTARAKHAND OPEN UNIVERSITY
16.1 OBJECTIVES
16.2 INTRODUCTION
16.3 BIOTIC RESOURCES: MEANING AND CONCEPT
16.4 PROTECTION, MANAGEMENT AND CONSERVATION
16.5 APPROACHES TO BIOTIC RESOURCE
16.5.1 SURVEY OF BIOLOGICAL RESOURCES
16.5.2 EVALUATION OF BIOLOGICAL RESOURCES
16.5.3 PRESERVATION AND CONSERVATION OF
BIOLOGICAL RESOURCES
16.6 BIOLOGICAL RESOURCES CONSERVATION IN INDIA
16.7 CONCLUSION
16.8 SUMMARY
16.9 GLOSSARY
16.10 ANSWER TO CHECK YOUR PROGRESS
16.11 REFERENCES
16.12 SUGGESTED READINGS
16.13 TERMINAL QUESTIONS
16.1 OBJECTIVES
The prime objective of this unit is to make you understand the concept and the
importance of biotic resources. In recent time it has been noticed that the natural resources
are getting depleted at an alarming rate and thus causing lots of concerns like depletion of
biodiversity, ecosystem, and natural resources like coal, petroleum etc. which are very useful
for our survival. Long term impact like climate change is also related to it. After studying this
unit you will be able to:
16.2 INTRODUCTION
Natural resources are highly valued because human beings are dependent on them to
fulfill their fundamental needs that changes with time. While natural resources are distributed
throughout the world, specific resources often require particular conditions and so not all
natural resources are spread equally. Consequently, nations trade their natural resources to
make certain that their needs can be fulfilled.
In simple term, natural resources are material and constituent formed within
environment or any matter or energy that are resulting from environment, used by living
things that humans use for food, fuel, clothing, and shelter. These comprise of water, soil,
minerals, vegetation, animals, air, and sunlight. People require resources to survive and
succeed. Everything which happens naturally on earth are natural resources that is minerals,
land, water, soil, wind that can be used in many ways by human being. It can be explained by
several environmentalist scholars that a natural resources is any kind of substance in its
natural form which is needed by humans.
The general classifications of natural resources are minerals for example as gold and
tin and energy resources such as coal and oil. The air, forests and oceans can also be
categorized as natural resources. Theoretical studies have documented that land and water are
the natural resources, which include biological resources, such as flower, trees, birds, wild
animals, fish etc., mineral resources, such as metals, oil, coal, building stones and sand, and
other resources, like air, sunshine and climate (UNEP, 1987). Natural Resources are used to
make food fuel and raw materials for the production of finished goods (Adriaanse, 1993).
Natural resources change in value over time, depending on what a society most needs or
considers most valuable.
Our earth is a storehouse of variety of resources. For instance land, water, air,
minerals etc. all are important physical or abiotic resources and wildlife, vegetation, fisheries
etc. are biological or biotic resources. Even fossil fuels such as coal, petrol, natural gas
formed by decaying of plants and other organic matters are biotic resources.
Besides the known resources, our earth has many such materials, which due to lack of
our knowledge and technology are not yet utilized. Such materials are not called a resource,
till we start utilizing those material. For instance, wind has always been there, may be from
the inception of the earth. However wind as a resource for generating electricity was
developed much later with advancement of technology.
Natural resources are further classified on the basis of their origin, renewability, level of
development and distribution.
Natural Resources
On the basis of Origin natural resources are called biotic or abiotic resources:
Biotic resources: It comprises of all living organisms in our environment, which has life and
is useful to us. Plants, animals, birds, forest products, marine organisms, fishes, coal, natural
oil etc. are all biotic resources. Coal, natural oil is non-renewable biotic resources. Biotic
resources are part of the biosphere.
Abiotic resources: It comprises of all the non-living elements, which are useful to us. For
instance land, air, water, minerals etc.
On the basis of renewability natural resources are defined as renewable and non-
renewable:
Renewable resource: Those resources, which can be utilized again and again and get
replenished within our life time, are renewable resources such as water, forests, sunlight etc.
Renewable resources get replenished naturally. Renewable resources such as sunlight, wind,
water provides green energy. Utilization of renewable energy promotes sustainability.
Though these resources are renewable but wastage or misuse of these resources can affect its
distribution and availability.
Non-renewable resources: These resources can get exhausted with over exploitation. These
resources take million years to replenish, hence are called non-renewable, e.g. coal, natural
oil, gas etc. Nonrenewable resources have limited supply and these resources takes longer
time period to replenish naturally. Fossil fuels, nuclear fuel are example of non-renewable
natural resources derived from the earth. For faster industrialization and growth humans have
been over utilizing fossil fuels, faster than earth’s capacity to replenish these resources within
our life time.
Thus for sustainable development and growth fossil fuels need to be judiciously used
and dependency on renewable sources of energy need to be increased.
On the basis of level of development natural resources are defined as potential and
actual resource
Potential Resource are those resource, which are not yet fully realized but have the potential
to be used in the future. The quantity and distribution of such resources are not yet known.
For instance many places in India may have petroleum deposits, till those deposits are
utilized, it is potential resource.
Actual resources are those resources, which we are utilizing and we know about their actual
distribution. The quantity of these resources is known. For instance, oil deposits in Middle
East countries.
On the basis of distribution, natural resources are defined as localized and ubiquitous.
Localized resources are found specific to some area and not everywhere. For instance,
copper, iron etc. are found in some areas.
Ubiquitous resources are present everywhere for instance land, water, air are found
everywhere, which are very important resource.
From animals we not only get food but they are useful for other services as well
hence are important biotic resource. For instance some animals like horse, cattle, and goat are
used for transport, some for agricultural purposes like cow; bull etc. cow dung is also very
good quality manure. Some animals and birds work as scavengers and help maintain the
ecosystem by getting rid of dead matters such as pig, vulture, jackal etc.
Micro-organisms are also important biotic resource. Microorganisms are food for
some animals and also act as decomposers and maintain balance in the ecosystem. Some
bacteria’s are also used for medicinal purposes. Hence are important biotic resources.
The varied distribution of natural resources is marked by physical and climatic conditions.
Not all countries have adequate distribution of all the important resources. Hence countries,
which have rich deposits of some important resources export additional quantity to other
countries and import those resources that they lack.
Resource rich regions, areas and countries attract more population. Since ages it has
been noticed that people settle near deposits of mineral and natural resources. Such as near
water bodies, near alluvial soil, near rich cover of vegetation’s etc. people settle earlier and
then move to other parts. Thus Asia, Europe and North America, which have rich deposits of
variety of resources have more population than Australia, Africa and South America. Even
within a country or state people migrate to such location where natural resources are found in
abundance. Often economic activities are associated with the available resource of the region.
For instance, in India Punjab, Haryana, UP have large cultivable lands conducive for
agricultural, hence in these state agriculture contributes greatly to the state’s economy.
Distribution of natural resources in India: India is one of the Asian countries blessed with
immense variety of resources both biotic and abiotic resources. Such as mineral deposits,
tropical weather conditions, fertile soil, marine resources and presence of many rivers and
water bodies. However the challenge is uneven distribution of resources and over exhaustion
of resources by rapidly growing population.
Northern plain of India is very productive here rice, wheat, maize, sugarcane, jute,
etc. are grown in huge quantity. India’s relief and climatic condition has supported varied
forest type thus tropical forest, mangrove, alpine forest etc. are found across India. Besides,
India has many national parks, wildlife sanctuaries, which are home to variety of plants,
animals and birds. India has about 75,000 variety of animal species and have 1200 variety of
species. India’s majestic elephants are mainly found in Assam, Karnataka and Kerala jungles
and lions in Gir forest in Gujarat. The one horned rhinos are found mainly in Assam. India
has wide variety of livestock’s as well. About 57% of world’s buffaloes are found in India.
India has long coastline which has many marine organism and many rivers where more than
1800 variety of fish species are found. The given map shows the distribution of resources in
India.
As per estimates in 2010, India had approximately about 125 Million metric tons of
crude oil reserves; most of it is found in Mumbai High. India also has about 1,437 billion
cubic meters of natural gas reserves. Mumbai high complex has maximum production of
natural gas followed by onshore fields in Andhra Pradesh, Assam, and Gujarat states. Coal is
attained from states like Orissa, Chhattisgarh, Andhra Pradesh, Madhya Pradesh, west
Bengal, Meghalaya and Tamil Nadu. Minerals such as copper, iron ore, bauxite, limestone,
mica, etc. are also found across the country. India produces about 7% of world’s production
of iron ore. Jharkhand, Orissa, Chhattisgarh, Karnataka. Maharashtra, Goa and Andhra
Pradesh produces maximum of India’s iron ore. India’s stock of livestock and their
contribution in improving economic status of rural population is also immense. Besides,
India’s climatic conditions favor agricultural and horticultural activities on large scale.
Natural resources are found across the world, however there are still some countries
which have more deposits of important resources than others.
In Asia, the southeast countries are major producers of palm oil, rubber, tin,
petroleum and even tropical fruits such as Papaya, Mango and Pineapple. India is the largest
producer of mango in the world. Countries like Indonesia and Thailand are world’s major
pineapple producing nations. West Asian countries like Iran, Iraq, UAE, Qatar and Saudi
Arabia have rich deposits of natural oil. Siberia in Russia has rich deposit of natural gas and
coal. China also has high quality coal reserve. Country like Kyrgyzstan has rich deposit of
Uranium ore. India and Indonesia have rich deposit of good quality iron ore.
Countries like China, Malaysia and Indonesia also have large forested lands. In fact
China majorly exports wooden products and paper. Indonesia and Malaysia are major timber
producing countries.
China’s estimated total forest area is about 175 million hectares mainly concentrated
in southwest, southeast and northeast region. It also has an extensive grassland. China’s
cultivable land is mainly distributed in North and northeast China, Sichuan basin, Pearl River
Delta etc. China has immense stock of mineral resources. There are many proven reserves in
china including metallic, non-metallic and energy mineral resources. China has rich deposit
of coal but natural gas and petroleum is comparatively less in proportion. Western and
northern region has huge deposit of coal. China’s metallic mineral resources covering large
reserves are mainly tin, tungsten, rare earth and antimony. China is one of the few countries
in the world with huge non -metallic deposits. China also has large quantity of marine
resources mainly concentrated in the offshore waters. Many Asian countries including China,
Myanmar, India, Japan, Indonesia, and Philippines are also major producers of fish in the
world.
Australia has many mineral deposits. It has huge coal deposits, even more in quantity
than its own requirement, hence additional coal is generally exported to countries like Japan,
Taiwan, and Korea, which lacks it. Sydney and Bowen basin are two major sites of coal
reserves. Besides, minerals like bauxite, iron ore, gold, copper, diamond, lead, zinc and
mineral sands deposits are also found in large quantity mainly in Western Australia and
Queensland. Australia has huge deposits of uranium, which it export to many countries in the
world for nuclear power. Its reserves of natural gas are mainly found in western and central
part of the country. Australia’s huge land and fertile soil supports agriculture and its huge
forests provide good quality wood and many other services to the nation and its economy.
Many African countries have rich deposits of minerals such as gold, diamond,
copper, bauxite, uranium, petroleum, titanium, silver etc. However, due to use of old
technology most potential mineral resource base are un-exploited. Many mineral bases are
found in central and southern Africa. South Africa, Egypt, Zimbabwe have rich deposit of
gold and diamond is found in central and South African region. Further, the tropical climatic
conditions in Africa supports growth of wide variety of plants and trees.
Europe also has major deposits of natural gas and oil in Norway, Netherlands,
Germany and
United Kingdom and mineral deposits are spread across the continent. Spain has huge
deposits of coal, uranium, potash etc. France has many mines containing coal, gypsum, iron
ore and zinc. Western European countries has many manufacturing minerals sites as well.
Such as Belgium has huge silica sand deposits. Eastern and northern European countries also
have many natural resources. Europe’s Mediterranean and marine coastal climates favor
growth of variety of agricultural products such as wheat, potatoes, olives, rapeseeds, grapes
etc. In fact, Italy, Greece and Spain are the world’s top three producers of olives and Spain,
France and Italy produces maximum grapes in the world, which is used for wind productions
South America has huge deposits of Iron ore and copper. Chile is world’s major
copper exporter. Oil and natural gas are majorly found in Venezuela’s El Tigre region and
Lake Maracaibo. South America has plentiful of freshwater which support growth of
fisheries.
North America’s fertile soil and freshwater and tropical climatic conditions
particularly in the southern part and temperate climatic conditions helps in growth of variety
of agricultural products; such as apple, peach, corn, wheat etc. Besides, North America also
has rich mineral deposits such as coal, nickel, bauxite, and iron ore. USA and Canada have
large deposits of oil and natural gas as well.
Most countries are blessed with abundance of natural resources and rich ecological
diversity. However over excessive population and economic growth threatens the regions
rich stock of resources. People of these countries need to understand the value and
importance of the natural resources. If the natural resources are maintained and sustainably
utilized, most countries would achieve their developmental goals fast.
Exercise A:
Make a list of 10 biotic and 10 abiotic natural resources that you and your family
require daily.
Practice Question
Q1. Define resource?
Q2. What is the difference between potential and actual resource?
Q3. Which state of India has maximum number of one Horne Rhinos?
Thus, natural resources,both biotic and abiotic, renewable and non-renewable needs
maintenance. Non-renewable resources such as fossil fuel are known to get exhausted with
over utilization. However post industrial revolution fossil fuels have been utilized extensively
as a source of energy/electricity. The industrialized countries to achieve their growth over
utilized the fossil fuels followed by the developing countries. As the fossil fuel takes million
years to replenish, conserving these resources is very essential. The renewable resources like
forest, water etc. though get renewed but over exploitation and wastages can cause immense
damages. Hence protection and conservation of both biotic and abiotic resources is of utmost
importance.
In the last few decades the concern about the natural resources have increased
because of growing awareness and knowledge about the limited resources. The growing
difficulties to avail clean air and water, and other important resources are making people
realize the importance of conservation of resources. If the resources are not conserved our
future generation will have nothing to survive. Hence, there is a need of sustainable
development.
Even biotic resources, which are mostly renewable needs protection from damages and need
to be conserved. Protection and conservation of natural resources is must for sustainable
development of the earth. The 1987 Brundtland commission report suggested about
integration of natural resources protection and management along with economic
development. In 1992 in Rio, Brazil Agenda 21 on environment and development and
sustainable management of forest were adopted by 178 countries.
Protecting the natural resources is necessary for community sustainability. As we humans are
depleting our resources, we only need to protect it from further damages. Protection of
species including plants and animals involves protection of their community, their ecosystem
and their habitat. Natural resource management involves protecting our land, water, air,
forest, wild life etc. Natural resource management involves protecting the quality and
quantity of the resources for present as well as future generation. Natural resource can be
maintained by sustainable and judicious usage of resources.
Resource like water is essential for living organisms, though 71% of the earth is covered with
water, less than 1% is only usable fresh water. With growing population, demand for water
consumption is also increasing. Hence, conserving and protecting this natural resource is
very essential. Protection of surface and ground water from pollution and contamination and
limiting wastage of water is important.
Forest another important resource though renewable needs to be conserved, as it takes about
10 to 15 years to replenish. Forest maintains ecology, control soil erosion, air pollution,
conserve water and support food chain and web. Thus forest depletion should be controlled.
If trees are fell for developmental purposes, then the same should be compensated with
afforestation at other places and deforestation should be avoided.
Fossil fuels though non-renewable and increases pollution it is one of the most essential
resource for development as we get energy from these fuels. Fossil fuels usages cannot be
completely replaced, because for faster industrialization, fuels like natural oil, gas and coal
will be used. However dependence on fossil fuels can be reduced with usage of alternative
source of energy such as solar energy, hydro energy, geo thermal energy, wind energy etc.
These sources of energy are renewable as well as cause less pollution. The energy through
theses alternative sources though is comparatively less productive than fossil fuels, these
renewable sources of energy should be used more to preserve the fossil fuels for future.
Air is the most important resource for survival of living organisms including humans,
birds animals etc. Birds and animals get oxygen from air and plants get CO2 for survival. But
due to excessive burning of fossil fuels the air quality is getting deteriorated. Quality of the
air can be maintained by using renewable sources of energy.
Wildlife, marine life, birds and other biotic resources are equally important, different
kind of species maintains biodiversity, which is essential for creating sustainability and
ecological balance. Rich biodiversity conserve the ecosystem and protect the environment.
All resources are important and to conserve them. Three simple R’s of conservation
are:
Reduction of wastages: we need to reduce the wastage of resources by limiting their usage.
Resources saved are a way of earning more resource. For example switching off of lights
when not required, using public transport as much as possible etc. are ways of reducing
usages and wastages of resources.
There are various approach to natural resource management including both biotic and
abiotic resources. Biotic resource management usually have the following approaches such
as:
Adaptive approach is a way of managing resources and learning about the same. In
this approach the stakeholders directly influences the decision for conservation and their
learning. Recognizing the stakeholders’ interests and involvement is important for learning
based management.
Biological resources surveys are undertaken to identify the types of organisms that
exist in a given area. The data gathered is generally used for monitoring endangered species,
evaluating conservation priorities of an organism and bioprospecting. Despite the importance
of survey, there is no set rule for performing surveys as goals, time, area and available
resources varies from place to place. The survey goal is very important to ensure the result in
usable for conservation of biological community.
Standardization is a basic survey step, in this sampling for survey is kept consistent.
Generally data is collected by different surveyors from different areas. So standardization of
sampling ensures, differences between different areas are significant. Another way of
standardization is by identifying the species correctly by experts.
Scale used for a survey depends on the goals of the project. The scale need to be
appropriate to the organism to be surveyed. Such as large scale is needed for organisms or
animals, which acquire larger habitat
The need for conservation is arising because of over exploitation of the resources by
humans for personal need and greed. The destruction of plants and animal species is not only
impacting biodiversity but also impacting the potential resources for humans in the form of
food, medicines, economic values etc. The extinction of animals and plants impact the
functioning of an ecosystem, which can impact human welfare and the economy. Human
factors such as habitat destructions, fragmentation, over exploitation of species due to fishing
and hunting, competitions, pollutions, ecosystem destruction and predation by invasive
species are some of the factors responsible for destruction of biological resources.
Exercise B:
Practice Question
Q4. What are the three basic approaches to biotic resource management?
Q5. Define biodiversity?
Q6. Give two examples of in-situ conservation?
Ex situ Conservation method preserves the biological resources and their diversity
outside their natural habitat. For instance, seed bank, zoo, botanical garden etc. are home
away from home. Ex situ conservation provides research opportunities on biological
resources. Ex situ conservation methods complement in- situ conservation. Reintroduction of
plants and animals to their natural habitat from ex-situ conservation centres helps to rebuild
the community of the endangered species.
Measures have been taken nationally and globally to conserve biological resources. In
India various steps and policies have been defined to conserve biological resources. India’
about 4.2% of land is demarcated as protected areas for in situ conservation of species.
In India, many acts are there to conserve natural resources. In article 48(a) and 51(g)
of Indian constitution environment protection concept is clearly mentioned. India has many
acts such as Environment Act 1986, Forest (Conservation) Act, 1980, Wildlife (Protection)
Act 1972 and Wildlife (Protection) Amendment Act 1991. These acts are meant to conserve
the environment and biological resources. Besides, Indian states have their own laws to
protect natural resources.
India has over 80 national parks to protect and conserve plants and animals in their
natural habitats. Corbett National park was first established in 1936. Inside national parks
human habitation is not allowed. India has 18 biosphere reserves, where locals are allowed to
live and perform their traditional activities but no hunting or other activities are allowed.
Some of the biosphere reserves demarcated by Indian government are Nilgiri (Kamataka,
Kerala, Tamil Nadu), Nanda Devi (Uttar Pradesh), Sundarbans (West Bengal), Great Nicobar
(Andaman & Nicobar Islands), Nokrek (Meghalaya), etc. India has about 537 wildlife
sanctuaries for protection of birds and animals. Out of which 49 are tiger reserves meant for
conservation of tiger. Besides the in-situ conservation methods, India has many ex-situ
conservation sites for conservation of species. Many seed banks, botanical garden, zoological
gardens are there to protect plants and animals outside their natural habitat.
16.7 CONCLUSION
To conclude, it can be said that ever growing population and economic developments
put excessive pressure on the natural resources. The natural resources renewable or non-
renewable need to be conserved. Non-renewable resources like fossil fuels once extracted
and used takes millions of years to replenish. Resources like water, forests etc. even though
renewable need to be judiciously used and wastages should be avoided. The demand for
resources is increasing faster than nature’s capacity to meet all demands, hence judicious
usages is required. Biological resource conservation maintains biodiversity. Biodiversity is
required for maintaining ecological balance. Biological conservation protects species from
getting extinct and thus maintains the food chain and food web. Conservation is a way of
recognizing the dynamic nature of biological communities and letting them grow, change and
evolve naturally. Reducing total dependency on natural resources is a way of conserving
resources. Nationally and globally many resolutions have been passed to protect both biotic
and abiotic resource. Apart from acts and laws public awareness is very important for
conservation. Everyone need to realizes the value of natural resources and our dependence on
them, then only the resources can be conserved.
16.8 SUMMARY
In this unit on conservation of biotic resources, you learnt in detail about all the natural
resources, concept of biotic resources; their different types and distribution in the world.
Protection, management and conservation of natural resources have also been explained in
detail here. The three simple R’s of conservation reduce, reuse and recycling have been
simply described. Detail description of different approaches to biotic resource conservation is
given in this unit. Surveying techniques including field survey; different steps of surveying
such as standardization, sampling effort, scale, monitoring and frequency of survey have all
been explained in detail. Evaluation of survey result, preservation and conservation methods
including in situ and ex situ conservation have been covered in this module. Also,
conservation of biological resources in India have been elaborated here.
16.9 GLOSSARY
Biodiversity: variety of plants and animals
Biosphere: is the sphere of the earth where life grows and survives
Ecosystem: an area where interrelation between biotic and abiotic factors support life.
Humus: it is dark color organic manure found in soil formed by decaying of plants and
animals
Ans:2 Standardization is a basic survey step, in this sampling for survey is kept consistent.
As data is generally collected by different surveyors from different areas. So standardization
of sampling ensures, differences between different areas are significant.
Ans:3 Nanda Devi (Uttar Pradesh), Sundarbans (West Bengal) and Nokrek (Meghalaya) are
three of the 18 biosphere reserves in India.
Ans:1 Resource is anything that satisfy our needs and wants. Any material which we can
utilize or is useful to us, we call it a resource.
Ans:2 Potential Resource are those resource, which are not yet fully realized but have the
potential to be used in the future. The quantity and distribution of such resources are not yet
known.
Actual resources are those resources, which we are utilizing and we know about their actual
distribution.
Ans. 3: One Horne Rhinos are found maximum in the state of Assam in India.
3. Integrated resource management approach through this approach the multiple aspect
of natural resources meet the goals of the direct users and producers. This approach
focuses on sustainability.
Ans. 5: Biodiversity is the variety of plants and animals. Biodiversity is required for healthy
ecological balance.
Ans. 6: National parks and wildlife sanctuaries are two examples of in-situ conservation
method.
16.11 REFERENCES
1. Bernhardt, T “Biological surveys”, Quebec Biodiversity Website, Redpath Museum.
2. http://redpath-museum.mcgill.ca/Qbp/2.About%20Biodiversity/surveys.htm
http://www.sonoma-
county.org/agcomm/pdf/biological_resource_study_or_assessment_guidelines.pdf
5. MapsofIndia.com. www.mapsofindia.com/india-natural-resources
8. http://www.esf.org/fileadmin/Public_documents/Publications/seambor.pdf
9. Raven,P,H “A biological survey for the nation”, National Academy Press, Washington
DC, 1993.
10. Sharaky, A,M “Mineral Resources and Exploration in Africa” Department of Natural
Resources Institute of African Research and Studies, Cairo University, Egypt.
13. www.vigyanprasar.gov.in/Radioserials/Conserving_Biodiversity2.pdf
http://www.sustainable.org/environment
15. Young, A “Land Resources: Now and for the Future”, Cambridge University Press.
Ans:1 The three R’s of conservation are Reduce, Reuse and Recycle. Reduce the
unnecessary usages and wastages of resources to conserve. Reuse the resource as much as
possible before discarding. Recycle the discarded product into something new and usable.